Add "set print symbol-loading on|off".
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2008
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
53 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
54 @end ifset
55 Version @value{GDBVN}.
56
57 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
58 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
59 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
60
61 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
62 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
63 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
64 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
65 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
66 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
67
68 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
69 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
70 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
71 @end ifinfo
72
73 @titlepage
74 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
75 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
76 @sp 1
77 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
78 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
81 @end ifset
82 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
83 @page
84 @tex
85 {\parskip=0pt
86 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
87 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89 }
90 @end tex
91
92 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
93 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
94 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
95 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96 @sp 2
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
103 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
104 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
105 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
106 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
107 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
108
109 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
110 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
111 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
112 @page
113 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
114 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
115 software in general. We will miss him.
116 @end titlepage
117 @page
118
119 @ifnottex
120 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
121
122 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
123
124 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
125
126 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
127 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
128 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
129 @end ifset
130 Version @value{GDBVN}.
131
132 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
133
134 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
135 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
136 software in general. We will miss him.
137
138 @menu
139 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
140 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
141
142 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
143 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
144 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
145 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
146 * Stack:: Examining the stack
147 * Source:: Examining source files
148 * Data:: Examining data
149 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
150 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
151 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
152
153 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
154
155 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
156 * Altering:: Altering execution
157 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
158 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
159 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
160 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
161 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
162 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
163 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
164 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
165 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
166 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
167 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
168
169 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
170
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
173 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
174 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
175 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
176 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
177 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
178 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
179 @value{GDBN}
180 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
181 how you can copy and share GDB
182 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
183 * Index:: Index
184 @end menu
185
186 @end ifnottex
187
188 @contents
189
190 @node Summary
191 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
192
193 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
194 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
195 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
196
197 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
198 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
199
200 @itemize @bullet
201 @item
202 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
203
204 @item
205 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
206
207 @item
208 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
209
210 @item
211 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
212 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
213 @end itemize
214
215 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
216 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
217 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
218
219 @cindex Modula-2
220 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
221 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
222
223 @cindex Pascal
224 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
225 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
226 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
227 syntax.
228
229 @cindex Fortran
230 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
231 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
232 underscore.
233
234 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
235 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
236
237 @menu
238 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
239 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
240 @end menu
241
242 @node Free Software
243 @unnumberedsec Free Software
244
245 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
246 General Public License
247 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
248 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
249 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
250 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
251 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
252 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
253
254 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
255 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
256 from anyone else.
257
258 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
259
260 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
261 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
262 include with the free software. Many of our most important
263 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
264 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
265 when an important free software package does not come with a free
266 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
267 gaps today.
268
269 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
270 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
271 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
272 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
273 them from the free software world.
274
275 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
276 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
277 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
278 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
279 contract to make it non-free.
280
281 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
282 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
283 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
284 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
285 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
286 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
287 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
288
289 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
290 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
291 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
292 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
293
294 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
295 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
296 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
297 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
298 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
299 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
300 community.
301
302 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
303 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
304 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
305 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
306 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
307 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
308 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
309 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
310 of the manual.
311
312 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
313 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
314 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
315 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
316 manual to replace it.
317
318 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
319 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
320 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
321 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
322 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
323 the free software community.
324
325 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
326 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
327 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
328 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
329 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
330 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
331 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
332 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
333 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
334
335 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
336 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
337 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
338 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
339 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
340 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
341 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
342 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
343
344 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
345 published by other publishers, at
346 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
347
348 @node Contributors
349 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
350
351 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
352 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
353 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
354 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
355 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
356 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
357 blow-by-blow account.
358
359 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
360
361 @quotation
362 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
363 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
364 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
365 @end quotation
366
367 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
368 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
369 releases:
370 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
371 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
372 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
373 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
374 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
375 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
376 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
377 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
378 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
379
380 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
381 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
382
383 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
384 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
385 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
386 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
387 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
388
389 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
390 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
391 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
392
393 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
394 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
395
396 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
397
398 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
399 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
400 support.
401 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
402 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
403 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
404 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
405 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
406 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
407 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
408 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
409 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
410 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
411 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
412 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
413 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
414 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
415 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
416 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
417
418 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
419
420 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
421 libraries.
422
423 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
424 about several machine instruction sets.
425
426 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
427 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
428 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
429 and RDI targets, respectively.
430
431 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
432 command-line editing and command history.
433
434 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
435 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
436
437 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
438 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
439 symbols.
440
441 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
442 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
443
444 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
445
446 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
447 processors.
448
449 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
450
451 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
452
453 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
454
455 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
456 watchpoints.
457
458 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
459
460 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
461
462 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
463 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
464
465 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
466 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
467 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
468 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
469 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
470 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
471 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
472
473 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
474 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
475
476 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
477 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
478 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
479 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
480 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
481 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
482 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
483 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
484 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
485 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
486 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
487 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
488 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
489 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
490 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
491
492 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
493 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
494
495 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
496 Hat.
497
498 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
499 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
500 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
501 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
502 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
503 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
504
505 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
506 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
507 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
508 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
509 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
510 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
511 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
512 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
513 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
514 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
515 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
516 Weigand.
517
518 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
519 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
520 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
521 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
522
523 @node Sample Session
524 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
525
526 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
527 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
528 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
529
530 @iftex
531 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
532 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
533 @end iftex
534
535 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
536 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
537
538 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
539 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
540 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
541 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
542 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
543 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
544 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
545 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
546 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
547
548 @smallexample
549 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
550 $ @b{./m4}
551 @b{define(foo,0000)}
552
553 @b{foo}
554 0000
555 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
556
557 @b{bar}
558 0000
559 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
560
561 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
562 @b{baz}
563 @b{Ctrl-d}
564 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
565 @end smallexample
566
567 @noindent
568 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
569
570 @smallexample
571 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
572 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
573 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
574 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
575 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
576 the conditions.
577 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
578 for details.
579
580 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
581 (@value{GDBP})
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
586 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
587 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
588 that examples fit in this manual.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
592 @end smallexample
593
594 @noindent
595 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
596 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
597 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
598 @code{break} command.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
602 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
607 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
608 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
609
610 @smallexample
611 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
612 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
613 @b{define(foo,0000)}
614
615 @b{foo}
616 0000
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
621 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
622 context where it stops.
623
624 @smallexample
625 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
626
627 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
628 at builtin.c:879
629 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
634 the next line of the current function.
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
639 : nil,
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
644 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
645 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
646 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
647
648 @smallexample
649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
650 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
651 at input.c:530
652 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
657 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
658 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
659 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
660 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
661 stack frame for each active subroutine.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
665 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
666 at input.c:530
667 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
668 at builtin.c:882
669 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
670 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
671 at macro.c:71
672 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
673 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
678 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
679 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
680
681 @smallexample
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
683 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
685 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
686 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
689 : xstrdup(rq);
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
691 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
696 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
697 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
698 (@code{print}) to see their values.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
702 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
704 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
709 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
710 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
714 533 xfree(rquote);
715 534
716 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
717 : xstrdup (lq);
718 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
719 : xstrdup (rq);
720 537
721 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
722 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
723 540 @}
724 541
725 542 void
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
730 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
731
732 @smallexample
733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
734 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
736 540 @}
737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
738 $3 = 9
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
740 $4 = 7
741 @end smallexample
742
743 @noindent
744 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
745 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
746 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
747 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
748 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
749 assignments.
750
751 @smallexample
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
753 $5 = 7
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
755 $6 = 9
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
760 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
761 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
762 example that caused trouble initially:
763
764 @smallexample
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
766 Continuing.
767
768 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
769
770 baz
771 0000
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
776 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
777 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
778
779 @smallexample
780 @b{Ctrl-d}
781 Program exited normally.
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
786 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
787 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
788
789 @smallexample
790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
791 @end smallexample
792
793 @node Invocation
794 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
795
796 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
797 The essentials are:
798 @itemize @bullet
799 @item
800 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
801 @item
802 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
803 @end itemize
804
805 @menu
806 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
807 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
808 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
809 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
810 @end menu
811
812 @node Invoking GDB
813 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
814
815 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
816 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
817
818 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
819 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
820
821 The command-line options described here are designed
822 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
823 options may effectively be unavailable.
824
825 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
826 specifying an executable program:
827
828 @smallexample
829 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
830 @end smallexample
831
832 @noindent
833 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
834 specified:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
838 @end smallexample
839
840 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
841 to debug a running process:
842
843 @smallexample
844 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
845 @end smallexample
846
847 @noindent
848 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
849 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
850
851 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
852 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
853 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
854 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
855 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
856
857 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
858 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
859 option processing.
860 @smallexample
861 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
862 @end smallexample
863 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
864 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
865
866 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
867 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} -silent
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
875 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
876
877 @noindent
878 Type
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} -help
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
886 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
887
888 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
889 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
890 @samp{-x} option is used.
891
892
893 @menu
894 * File Options:: Choosing files
895 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
896 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
897 @end menu
898
899 @node File Options
900 @subsection Choosing Files
901
902 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
903 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
904 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
905 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
906 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
907 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
908 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
909 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
910 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
911 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
912 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
913 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
914 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
915
916 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
917 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
918 argument and ignore it.
919
920 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
921 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
922 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
923 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
924 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
925
926 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
927 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
928 @c it.
929
930 @table @code
931 @item -symbols @var{file}
932 @itemx -s @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--symbols}
934 @cindex @code{-s}
935 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
936
937 @item -exec @var{file}
938 @itemx -e @var{file}
939 @cindex @code{--exec}
940 @cindex @code{-e}
941 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
942 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
943
944 @item -se @var{file}
945 @cindex @code{--se}
946 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
947 file.
948
949 @item -core @var{file}
950 @itemx -c @var{file}
951 @cindex @code{--core}
952 @cindex @code{-c}
953 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
954
955 @item -pid @var{number}
956 @itemx -p @var{number}
957 @cindex @code{--pid}
958 @cindex @code{-p}
959 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
960
961 @item -command @var{file}
962 @itemx -x @var{file}
963 @cindex @code{--command}
964 @cindex @code{-x}
965 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
966 Files,, Command files}.
967
968 @item -eval-command @var{command}
969 @itemx -ex @var{command}
970 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
971 @cindex @code{-ex}
972 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
973
974 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
975 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
976
977 @smallexample
978 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
979 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
980 @end smallexample
981
982 @item -directory @var{directory}
983 @itemx -d @var{directory}
984 @cindex @code{--directory}
985 @cindex @code{-d}
986 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
987
988 @item -r
989 @itemx -readnow
990 @cindex @code{--readnow}
991 @cindex @code{-r}
992 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
993 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
994 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
995
996 @end table
997
998 @node Mode Options
999 @subsection Choosing Modes
1000
1001 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1002 batch mode or quiet mode.
1003
1004 @table @code
1005 @item -nx
1006 @itemx -n
1007 @cindex @code{--nx}
1008 @cindex @code{-n}
1009 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1010 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1011 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1012 Files}.
1013
1014 @item -quiet
1015 @itemx -silent
1016 @itemx -q
1017 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1018 @cindex @code{--silent}
1019 @cindex @code{-q}
1020 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1021 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1022
1023 @item -batch
1024 @cindex @code{--batch}
1025 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1026 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1027 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1028 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1029 in the command files.
1030
1031 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1032 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1033 make this more useful, the message
1034
1035 @smallexample
1036 Program exited normally.
1037 @end smallexample
1038
1039 @noindent
1040 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1041 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1042 mode.
1043
1044 @item -batch-silent
1045 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1046 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1047 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1048 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1049 for an interactive session.
1050
1051 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1052 messages, for example.
1053
1054 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1055 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1056
1057 @item -return-child-result
1058 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1059 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1060 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1061
1062 @itemize @bullet
1063 @item
1064 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1065 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1066 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1067 @item
1068 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1069 @item
1070 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1071 the exit code will be -1.
1072 @end itemize
1073
1074 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1075 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1076 interface.
1077
1078 @item -nowindows
1079 @itemx -nw
1080 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1081 @cindex @code{-nw}
1082 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1083 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1084 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1085
1086 @item -windows
1087 @itemx -w
1088 @cindex @code{--windows}
1089 @cindex @code{-w}
1090 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1091 used if possible.
1092
1093 @item -cd @var{directory}
1094 @cindex @code{--cd}
1095 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1096 instead of the current directory.
1097
1098 @item -fullname
1099 @itemx -f
1100 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1101 @cindex @code{-f}
1102 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1103 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1104 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1105 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1106 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1107 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1108 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1109 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1110 frame.
1111
1112 @item -epoch
1113 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1114 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1115 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1116 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1117 separate window.
1118
1119 @item -annotate @var{level}
1120 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1121 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1122 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1123 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1124 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1125 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1126 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1127 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1128 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1129
1130 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1131 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1132
1133 @item --args
1134 @cindex @code{--args}
1135 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1136 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1137 This option stops option processing.
1138
1139 @item -baud @var{bps}
1140 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1141 @cindex @code{--baud}
1142 @cindex @code{-b}
1143 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1144 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1145
1146 @item -l @var{timeout}
1147 @cindex @code{-l}
1148 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1149 for remote debugging.
1150
1151 @item -tty @var{device}
1152 @itemx -t @var{device}
1153 @cindex @code{--tty}
1154 @cindex @code{-t}
1155 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1156 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1157
1158 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1159 @item -tui
1160 @cindex @code{--tui}
1161 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1162 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1163 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1164 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1165 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1166 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1167 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1168
1169 @c @item -xdb
1170 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1171 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1172 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1173 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1174 @c systems.
1175
1176 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1177 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1178 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1179 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1180 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1181 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1182
1183 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1184 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1185 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1186 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1187 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1188 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1189
1190 @item -write
1191 @cindex @code{--write}
1192 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1193 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1194 (@pxref{Patching}).
1195
1196 @item -statistics
1197 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1198 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1199 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1200
1201 @item -version
1202 @cindex @code{--version}
1203 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1204 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1205
1206 @end table
1207
1208 @node Startup
1209 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1210 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1211
1212 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1213
1214 @enumerate
1215 @item
1216 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1217 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1218
1219 @item
1220 @cindex init file
1221 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1222 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1223 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1224 that file.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Processes command line options and operands.
1228
1229 @item
1230 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1231 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1232 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1233 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1234 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1235 @value{GDBN}.
1236
1237 @item
1238 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1239 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1240
1241 @item
1242 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1243 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1244 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1245 @end enumerate
1246
1247 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1248 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1249 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1250 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1251 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1252 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1253
1254 @cindex init file name
1255 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1256 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1257 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1258 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1259 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1260 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1261 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1262 the file to the standard name.
1263
1264
1265 @node Quitting GDB
1266 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1267 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1268 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1269
1270 @table @code
1271 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1272 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1273 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1274 @itemx q
1275 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1276 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1277 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1278 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1279 error code.
1280 @end table
1281
1282 @cindex interrupt
1283 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1284 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1285 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1286 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1287 until a time when it is safe.
1288
1289 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1290 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1291 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1292
1293 @node Shell Commands
1294 @section Shell Commands
1295
1296 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1297 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1298 just use the @code{shell} command.
1299
1300 @table @code
1301 @kindex shell
1302 @cindex shell escape
1303 @item shell @var{command string}
1304 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1305 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1306 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1307 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1308 @end table
1309
1310 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1311 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1312 @value{GDBN}:
1313
1314 @table @code
1315 @kindex make
1316 @cindex calling make
1317 @item make @var{make-args}
1318 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1319 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1320 @end table
1321
1322 @node Logging Output
1323 @section Logging Output
1324 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1325 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1326
1327 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1328 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1329
1330 @table @code
1331 @kindex set logging
1332 @item set logging on
1333 Enable logging.
1334 @item set logging off
1335 Disable logging.
1336 @cindex logging file name
1337 @item set logging file @var{file}
1338 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1339 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1340 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1341 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1342 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1343 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1344 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1345 @kindex show logging
1346 @item show logging
1347 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1348 @end table
1349
1350 @node Commands
1351 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1352
1353 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1354 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1355 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1356 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1357 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1358
1359 @menu
1360 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1361 * Completion:: Command completion
1362 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1363 @end menu
1364
1365 @node Command Syntax
1366 @section Command Syntax
1367
1368 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1369 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1370 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1371 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1372 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1373 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1374
1375 @cindex abbreviation
1376 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1377 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1378 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1379 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1380 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1381 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1382 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1383
1384 @cindex repeating commands
1385 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1386 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1387 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1388 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1389 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1390 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1391 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1392
1393 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1394 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1395 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1396
1397 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1398 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1399 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1400 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1401 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1402
1403 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1404 @cindex comment
1405 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1406 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1407 Files,,Command Files}).
1408
1409 @cindex repeating command sequences
1410 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1411 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1412 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1413 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1414 for editing.
1415
1416 @node Completion
1417 @section Command Completion
1418
1419 @cindex completion
1420 @cindex word completion
1421 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1422 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1423 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1424 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1425
1426 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1427 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1428 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1429 enter it). For example, if you type
1430
1431 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1432 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1433 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1434 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1435 @smallexample
1436 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1437 @end smallexample
1438
1439 @noindent
1440 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1441 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1442
1443 @smallexample
1444 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1445 @end smallexample
1446
1447 @noindent
1448 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1449 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1450 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1451 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1452 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1453 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1454
1455 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1456 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1457 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1458 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1459 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1460 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1461 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1462 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1463 example:
1464
1465 @smallexample
1466 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1467 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1468 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1469 make_abs_section make_function_type
1470 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1471 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1472 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1473 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1474 @end smallexample
1475
1476 @noindent
1477 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1478 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1479 command.
1480
1481 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1482 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1483 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1484 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1485 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1486
1487 @cindex quotes in commands
1488 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1489 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1490 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1491 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1492 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1493 @value{GDBN} commands.
1494
1495 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1496 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1497 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1498 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1499 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1500 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1501 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1502 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1503 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1504 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1505 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1506
1507 @smallexample
1508 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1509 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1511 @end smallexample
1512
1513 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1514 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1515 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1516 place:
1517
1518 @smallexample
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1520 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1522 @end smallexample
1523
1524 @noindent
1525 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1526 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1527 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1528
1529 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1530 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1531 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1532 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1533
1534 @cindex completion of structure field names
1535 @cindex structure field name completion
1536 @cindex completion of union field names
1537 @cindex union field name completion
1538 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1539 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1540 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1541 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1542 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1543 left-hand-side:
1544
1545 @smallexample
1546 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1547 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1548 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1549 @end smallexample
1550
1551 @noindent
1552 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1553 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1554 follows:
1555
1556 @smallexample
1557 struct ui_file
1558 @{
1559 int *magic;
1560 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1561 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1562 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1563 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1564 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1565 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1566 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1567 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1568 void *to_data;
1569 @}
1570 @end smallexample
1571
1572
1573 @node Help
1574 @section Getting Help
1575 @cindex online documentation
1576 @kindex help
1577
1578 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1579 using the command @code{help}.
1580
1581 @table @code
1582 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1583 @item help
1584 @itemx h
1585 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1586 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1587
1588 @smallexample
1589 (@value{GDBP}) help
1590 List of classes of commands:
1591
1592 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1593 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1594 data -- Examining data
1595 files -- Specifying and examining files
1596 internals -- Maintenance commands
1597 obscure -- Obscure features
1598 running -- Running the program
1599 stack -- Examining the stack
1600 status -- Status inquiries
1601 support -- Support facilities
1602 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1603 stopping the program
1604 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1605
1606 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1607 commands in that class.
1608 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1609 documentation.
1610 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1611 (@value{GDBP})
1612 @end smallexample
1613 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1614
1615 @item help @var{class}
1616 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1617 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1618 help display for the class @code{status}:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1622 Status inquiries.
1623
1624 List of commands:
1625
1626 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1627 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1628 info -- Generic command for showing things
1629 about the program being debugged
1630 show -- Generic command for showing things
1631 about the debugger
1632
1633 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1634 documentation.
1635 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1636 (@value{GDBP})
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @item help @var{command}
1640 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1641 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1642
1643 @kindex apropos
1644 @item apropos @var{args}
1645 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1646 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1647 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1648
1649 @smallexample
1650 apropos reload
1651 @end smallexample
1652
1653 @noindent
1654 results in:
1655
1656 @smallexample
1657 @c @group
1658 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1659 multiple times in one run
1660 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1661 multiple times in one run
1662 @c @end group
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @kindex complete
1666 @item complete @var{args}
1667 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1668 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1669 command you want completed. For example:
1670
1671 @smallexample
1672 complete i
1673 @end smallexample
1674
1675 @noindent results in:
1676
1677 @smallexample
1678 @group
1679 if
1680 ignore
1681 info
1682 inspect
1683 @end group
1684 @end smallexample
1685
1686 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1687 @end table
1688
1689 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1690 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1691 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1692 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1693 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1694 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1695
1696 @c @group
1697 @table @code
1698 @kindex info
1699 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1700 @item info
1701 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1702 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1703 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1704 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1705 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1706 @w{@code{help info}}.
1707
1708 @kindex set
1709 @item set
1710 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1711 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1712 @code{set prompt $}.
1713
1714 @kindex show
1715 @item show
1716 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1717 @value{GDBN} itself.
1718 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1719 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1720 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1721 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1722
1723 @kindex info set
1724 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1725 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1726 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1727 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1728 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1729 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1730 @end table
1731 @c @end group
1732
1733 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1734 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1735
1736 @table @code
1737 @kindex show version
1738 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1739 @item show version
1740 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1741 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1742 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1743 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1744 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1745 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1746 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1747 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1748 @value{GDBN}.
1749
1750 @kindex show copying
1751 @kindex info copying
1752 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1753 @item show copying
1754 @itemx info copying
1755 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1756
1757 @kindex show warranty
1758 @kindex info warranty
1759 @item show warranty
1760 @itemx info warranty
1761 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1762 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1763
1764 @end table
1765
1766 @node Running
1767 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1768
1769 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1770 debugging information when you compile it.
1771
1772 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1773 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1774 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1775 kill a child process.
1776
1777 @menu
1778 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1779 * Starting:: Starting your program
1780 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1781 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1782
1783 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1784 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1785 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1786 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1787
1788 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1789 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1790 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1791 @end menu
1792
1793 @node Compilation
1794 @section Compiling for Debugging
1795
1796 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1797 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1798 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1799 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1800 and addresses in the executable code.
1801
1802 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1803 the compiler.
1804
1805 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1806 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1807 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1808 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1809 executables containing debugging information.
1810
1811 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1812 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1813 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1814 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1815 in pushing your luck.
1816
1817 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1818 @cindex debugging optimized code
1819 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1820 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1821 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1822 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1823 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1824 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1825
1826 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1827 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1828 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1829 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1830 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1831
1832 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1833 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1834 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1835
1836 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1837 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1838 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1839 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1840 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1841 provides macro information if you specify the options
1842 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1843 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1844 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1845 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1846 @option{-g} alone.
1847
1848 @need 2000
1849 @node Starting
1850 @section Starting your Program
1851 @cindex starting
1852 @cindex running
1853
1854 @table @code
1855 @kindex run
1856 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1857 @item run
1858 @itemx r
1859 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1860 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1861 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1862 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1863 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1864
1865 @end table
1866
1867 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1868 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1869 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1870 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1871 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1872 message like this one:
1873
1874 @smallexample
1875 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1876 Try "help target" or "continue".
1877 @end smallexample
1878
1879 @noindent
1880 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1881 first (@pxref{load}).
1882
1883 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1884 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1885 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1886 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1887 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1888 divided into four categories:
1889
1890 @table @asis
1891 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1892 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1893 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1894 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1895 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1896 the arguments.
1897 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1898 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1899 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1900
1901 @item The @emph{environment.}
1902 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1903 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1904 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1905 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1906
1907 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1908 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1909 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1910 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1911
1912 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1913 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1914 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1915 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1916 set a different device for your program.
1917 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1918
1919 @cindex pipes
1920 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1921 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1922 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1923 wrong program.
1924 @end table
1925
1926 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1927 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1928 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1929 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1930 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1931
1932 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1933 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1934 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1935 your current breakpoints.
1936
1937 @table @code
1938 @kindex start
1939 @item start
1940 @cindex run to main procedure
1941 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1942 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1943 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1944 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1945 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1946 procedure, depending on the language used.
1947
1948 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1949 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1950 the @samp{run} command.
1951
1952 @cindex elaboration phase
1953 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1954 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1955 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1956 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1957 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1958 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1959 will remain to halt execution.
1960
1961 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1962 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1963 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1964 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1965 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1966
1967 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1968 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1969 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1970 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1971 elaboration code before running your program.
1972
1973 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1974 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1975 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1976 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1977 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1978 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1979 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1980 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1981 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1982 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1983 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1984
1985 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1986 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1987 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1988 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1989
1990 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1991 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1992 environment:
1993
1994 @smallexample
1995 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1996 (@value{GDBP}) run
1997 @end smallexample
1998
1999 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2000 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2001
2002 @kindex set disable-randomization
2003 @item set disable-randomization
2004 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2005 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2006 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2007 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2008 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2009
2010 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2011 behavior using
2012
2013 @smallexample
2014 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2015 @end smallexample
2016
2017 @item set disable-randomization off
2018 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2019 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2020 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2021 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2022 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2023 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2024
2025 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2026 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2027 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2028 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2029 a code at its expected addresses.
2030
2031 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2032 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2033 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2034 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2035 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2036 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2037 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2038 a randomly chosen address.
2039
2040 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2041 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2042 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2043 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2044 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2045
2046 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2047 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2048
2049 @item show disable-randomization
2050 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2051 the virtual address space of the started program.
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 @node Arguments
2056 @section Your Program's Arguments
2057
2058 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2059 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2060 @code{run} command.
2061 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2062 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2063 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2064 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2065 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2066
2067 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2068 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2069 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2070 the program, not by the shell.
2071
2072 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2073 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2074
2075 @table @code
2076 @kindex set args
2077 @item set args
2078 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2079 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2080 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2081 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2082 it again without arguments.
2083
2084 @kindex show args
2085 @item show args
2086 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2087 @end table
2088
2089 @node Environment
2090 @section Your Program's Environment
2091
2092 @cindex environment (of your program)
2093 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2094 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2095 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2096 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2097 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2098 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2099 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2100
2101 @table @code
2102 @kindex path
2103 @item path @var{directory}
2104 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2105 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2106 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2107 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2108 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2109 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2110 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2111
2112 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2113 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2114 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2115 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2116 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2117 @var{directory} to the search path.
2118 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2119 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2120
2121 @kindex show paths
2122 @item show paths
2123 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2124 environment variable).
2125
2126 @kindex show environment
2127 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2128 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2129 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2130 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2131 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2132
2133 @kindex set environment
2134 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2135 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2136 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2137 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2138 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2139 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2140 null value.
2141 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2142 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2143
2144 For example, this command:
2145
2146 @smallexample
2147 set env USER = foo
2148 @end smallexample
2149
2150 @noindent
2151 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2152 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2153 are not actually required.)
2154
2155 @kindex unset environment
2156 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2157 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2158 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2159 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2160 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2161 @end table
2162
2163 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2164 the shell indicated
2165 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2166 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2167 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2168 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2169 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2170 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2171 @file{.profile}.
2172
2173 @node Working Directory
2174 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2175
2176 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2177 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2178 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2179 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2180 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2181 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2182
2183 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2184 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2185 Specify Files}.
2186
2187 @table @code
2188 @kindex cd
2189 @cindex change working directory
2190 @item cd @var{directory}
2191 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2192
2193 @kindex pwd
2194 @item pwd
2195 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2196 @end table
2197
2198 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2199 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2200 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2201 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2202 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2203 current working directory of the debuggee.
2204
2205 @node Input/Output
2206 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2207
2208 @cindex redirection
2209 @cindex i/o
2210 @cindex terminal
2211 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2212 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2213 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2214 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2215 running your program.
2216
2217 @table @code
2218 @kindex info terminal
2219 @item info terminal
2220 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2221 program is using.
2222 @end table
2223
2224 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2225 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2226
2227 @smallexample
2228 run > outfile
2229 @end smallexample
2230
2231 @noindent
2232 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2233
2234 @kindex tty
2235 @cindex controlling terminal
2236 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2237 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2238 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2239 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2240 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2241
2242 @smallexample
2243 tty /dev/ttyb
2244 @end smallexample
2245
2246 @noindent
2247 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2248 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2249 that as their controlling terminal.
2250
2251 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2252 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2253 terminal.
2254
2255 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2256 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2257 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2258 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2259
2260 @cindex inferior tty
2261 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2262 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2263 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2264 program.
2265
2266 @table @code
2267 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2268 @kindex set inferior-tty
2269 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2270
2271 @item show inferior-tty
2272 @kindex show inferior-tty
2273 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2274 @end table
2275
2276 @node Attach
2277 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2278 @kindex attach
2279 @cindex attach
2280
2281 @table @code
2282 @item attach @var{process-id}
2283 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2284 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2285 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2286 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2287 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2288
2289 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2290 executing the command.
2291 @end table
2292
2293 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2294 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2295 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2296 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2297
2298 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2299 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2300 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2301 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2302 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2303 Specify Files}.
2304
2305 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2306 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2307 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2308 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2309 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2310 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2311 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2312
2313 @table @code
2314 @kindex detach
2315 @item detach
2316 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2317 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2318 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2319 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2320 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2321 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2322 executing the command.
2323 @end table
2324
2325 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2326 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2327 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2328 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2329 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2330 Messages}).
2331
2332 @node Kill Process
2333 @section Killing the Child Process
2334
2335 @table @code
2336 @kindex kill
2337 @item kill
2338 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2339 @end table
2340
2341 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2342 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2343 is running.
2344
2345 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2346 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2347 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2348 outside the debugger.
2349
2350 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2351 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2352 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2353 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2354 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2355 breakpoint settings).
2356
2357 @node Threads
2358 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2359
2360 @cindex threads of execution
2361 @cindex multiple threads
2362 @cindex switching threads
2363 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2364 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2365 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2366 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2367 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2368 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2369 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2370
2371 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2372 programs:
2373
2374 @itemize @bullet
2375 @item automatic notification of new threads
2376 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2377 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2378 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2379 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2380 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2381 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2382 messages on thread start and exit.
2383 @end itemize
2384
2385 @quotation
2386 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2387 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2388 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2389 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2390 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2391 like this:
2392
2393 @smallexample
2394 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2395 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2396 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2397 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2398 @end smallexample
2399 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2400 @c doesn't support threads"?
2401 @end quotation
2402
2403 @cindex focus of debugging
2404 @cindex current thread
2405 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2406 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2407 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2408 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2409 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2410
2411 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2412 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2413 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2414 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2415 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2416 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2417 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2418 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2419 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2420 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2421
2422 @smallexample
2423 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2424 @end smallexample
2425
2426 @noindent
2427 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2428 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2429 further qualifier.
2430
2431 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2432 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2433 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2434 @c program?
2435 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2436 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2437 @c threads ab initio?
2438
2439 @cindex thread number
2440 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2441 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2442 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2443
2444 @table @code
2445 @kindex info threads
2446 @item info threads
2447 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2448 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2449
2450 @enumerate
2451 @item
2452 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2453
2454 @item
2455 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2456
2457 @item
2458 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2459 @end enumerate
2460
2461 @noindent
2462 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2463 indicates the current thread.
2464
2465 For example,
2466 @end table
2467 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2468
2469 @smallexample
2470 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2471 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2472 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2473 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2474 at threadtest.c:68
2475 @end smallexample
2476
2477 On HP-UX systems:
2478
2479 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2480 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2481 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2482 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2483 thread in your program.
2484
2485 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2486 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2487 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2488 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2489 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2490 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2491 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2492 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2493 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2494 HP-UX, you see
2495
2496 @smallexample
2497 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2498 @end smallexample
2499
2500 @noindent
2501 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2502
2503 @table @code
2504 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2505 @item info threads
2506 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2507 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2508
2509 @enumerate
2510 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2511
2512 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2513
2514 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2515 @end enumerate
2516
2517 @noindent
2518 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2519 indicates the current thread.
2520
2521 For example,
2522 @end table
2523 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2524
2525 @smallexample
2526 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2527 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2528 at quicksort.c:137
2529 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2530 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2531 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2532 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2533 @end smallexample
2534
2535 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2536 Solaris-specific command:
2537
2538 @table @code
2539 @item maint info sol-threads
2540 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2541 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2542 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2543 @end table
2544
2545 @table @code
2546 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2547 @item thread @var{threadno}
2548 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2549 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2550 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2551 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2552 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2553
2554 @smallexample
2555 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2556 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2557 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2558 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2559 @end smallexample
2560
2561 @noindent
2562 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2563 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2564 threads.
2565
2566 @kindex thread apply
2567 @cindex apply command to several threads
2568 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2569 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2570 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2571 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2572 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2573 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2574 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2575 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2576
2577 @kindex set print thread-events
2578 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2579 @item set print thread-events
2580 @itemx set print thread-events on
2581 @itemx set print thread-events off
2582 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2583 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2584 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2585 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2586 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2587
2588 @kindex show print thread-events
2589 @item show print thread-events
2590 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2591 have started and exited.
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @cindex automatic thread selection
2595 @cindex switching threads automatically
2596 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2597 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2598 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2599 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2600 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2601 thread.
2602
2603 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2604 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2605 programs with multiple threads.
2606
2607 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2608 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2609
2610 @node Processes
2611 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2612
2613 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2614 @cindex multiple processes
2615 @cindex processes, multiple
2616 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2617 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2618 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2619 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2620 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2621 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2622 will cause it to terminate.
2623
2624 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2625 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2626 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2627 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2628 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2629 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2630 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2631 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2632 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2633 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2634
2635 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2636 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2637 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2638 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2639
2640 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2641 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2642
2643 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2644 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2645
2646 @table @code
2647 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2648 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2649 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2650 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2651 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @item parent
2655 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2656 unimpeded. This is the default.
2657
2658 @item child
2659 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2660 unimpeded.
2661
2662 @end table
2663
2664 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2665 @item show follow-fork-mode
2666 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2670 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2671 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2672
2673 @table @code
2674 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2675 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2676 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2677 retain debugger control over them both.
2678
2679 @table @code
2680 @item on
2681 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2682 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2683 independently. This is the default.
2684
2685 @item off
2686 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2687 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2688 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2689 is held suspended.
2690
2691 @end table
2692
2693 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2694 @item show detach-on-fork
2695 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2696 @end table
2697
2698 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2699 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2700 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2701 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2702 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2703
2704 @table @code
2705 @kindex info forks
2706 @item info forks
2707 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2708 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2709 position (program counter) of the process.
2710
2711 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2712 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2713 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2714 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2715 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2716
2717 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2718 @item process @var{process-id}
2719 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2720 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2721 @samp{info forks}.
2722
2723 @end table
2724
2725 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2726 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2727 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2728 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2729
2730 @table @code
2731 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2732 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2733 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2734 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2735 allowed to run independently.
2736
2737 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2738 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2739 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2740 and remove it from the fork list.
2741
2742 @end table
2743
2744 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2745 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2746 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2747 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2748 the child process's @code{main}.
2749
2750 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2751 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2752
2753 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2754 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2755 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2756 argument.
2757
2758 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2759 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2760 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2761
2762 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2763 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2764
2765 @cindex checkpoint
2766 @cindex restart
2767 @cindex bookmark
2768 @cindex snapshot of a process
2769 @cindex rewind program state
2770
2771 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2772 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2773 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2774 later.
2775
2776 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2777 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2778 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2779 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2780 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2781
2782 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2783 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2784 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2785 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2786 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2787 start again from there.
2788
2789 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2790 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2791
2792 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2793
2794 @table @code
2795 @kindex checkpoint
2796 @item checkpoint
2797 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2798 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2799 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2800
2801 @kindex info checkpoints
2802 @item info checkpoints
2803 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2804 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2805 listed:
2806
2807 @table @code
2808 @item Checkpoint ID
2809 @item Process ID
2810 @item Code Address
2811 @item Source line, or label
2812 @end table
2813
2814 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2815 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2816 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2817 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2818 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2819 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2820 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2821
2822 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2823 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2824 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2825 the debugger.
2826
2827 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2828 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2829 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2830
2831 @end table
2832
2833 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2834 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2835 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2836 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2837 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2838 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2839 previously read data can be read again.
2840
2841 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2842 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2843 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2844 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2845 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2846 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2847
2848 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2849 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2850 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2851 different execution path this time.
2852
2853 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2854 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2855 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2856 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2857 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2858 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2859 potentially pose a problem.
2860
2861 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2862
2863 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2864 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2865 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2866 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2867 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2868 next.
2869
2870 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2871 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2872 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2873 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2874 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2875
2876 @node Stopping
2877 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2878
2879 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2880 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2881 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2882
2883 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2884 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2885 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2886 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2887 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2888 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2889 explicitly request this information at any time.
2890
2891 @table @code
2892 @kindex info program
2893 @item info program
2894 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2895 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2896 @end table
2897
2898 @menu
2899 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2900 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2901 * Signals:: Signals
2902 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2903 @end menu
2904
2905 @node Breakpoints
2906 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2907
2908 @cindex breakpoints
2909 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2910 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2911 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2912 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2913 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2914 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2915 program.
2916
2917 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2918 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2919 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2920 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2921 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2922 call).
2923
2924 @cindex watchpoints
2925 @cindex data breakpoints
2926 @cindex memory tracing
2927 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2928 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2929 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2930 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2931 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2932 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2933 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2934 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2935 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2936 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2937 same commands.
2938
2939 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2940 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2941 Automatic Display}.
2942
2943 @cindex catchpoints
2944 @cindex breakpoint on events
2945 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2946 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2947 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2948 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2949 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2950 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2951 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2952
2953 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2954 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2955 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2956 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2957 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2958 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2959 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2960 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2961 enable it again.
2962
2963 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2964 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2965 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2966 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2967 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2968 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2969 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2970
2971 @menu
2972 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2973 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2974 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2975 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2976 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2977 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2978 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2979 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2980 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2981 @end menu
2982
2983 @node Set Breaks
2984 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2985
2986 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2987 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2988 @c
2989 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2990
2991 @kindex break
2992 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2993 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2994 @cindex latest breakpoint
2995 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2996 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2997 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2998 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2999 convenience variables.
3000
3001 @table @code
3002 @item break @var{location}
3003 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3004 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3005 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3006 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3007 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3008
3009 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3010 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3011 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3012 that situation.
3013
3014 @item break
3015 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3016 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3017 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3018 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3019 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3020 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3021 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3022 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3023 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3024 inside loops.
3025
3026 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3027 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3028 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3029 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3030 existed when your program stopped.
3031
3032 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3033 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3034 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3035 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3036 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3037 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3038 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3039
3040 @kindex tbreak
3041 @item tbreak @var{args}
3042 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3043 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3044 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3045 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3046
3047 @kindex hbreak
3048 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3049 @item hbreak @var{args}
3050 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3051 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3052 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3053 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3054 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3055 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3056 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3057 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3058 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3059 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3060 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3061 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3062 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3063 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3064 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3065 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3066 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3067 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3068
3069 @kindex thbreak
3070 @item thbreak @var{args}
3071 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3072 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3073 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3074 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3075 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3076 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3077 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3078 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3079
3080 @kindex rbreak
3081 @cindex regular expression
3082 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3083 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3084 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3085 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3086 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3087 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3088 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3089 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3090 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3091
3092 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3093 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3094 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3095 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3096 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3097 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3098
3099 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3100 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3101 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3102 classes.
3103
3104 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3105 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3106 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3107
3108 @smallexample
3109 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3110 @end smallexample
3111
3112 @kindex info breakpoints
3113 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3114 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3115 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3116 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3117 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3118 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3119 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3120 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3121
3122 @table @emph
3123 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3124 @item Type
3125 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3126 @item Disposition
3127 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3128 @item Enabled or Disabled
3129 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3130 that are not enabled.
3131 @item Address
3132 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3133 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3134 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3135 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3136 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3137 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3138 @item What
3139 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3140 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3141 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3142 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3143 @end table
3144
3145 @noindent
3146 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3147 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3148 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3149 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3150 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3151 valid location.
3152
3153 @noindent
3154 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3155 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3156 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3157 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3158 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3159
3160 @noindent
3161 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3162 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3163 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3164 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3165 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3166 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3167 @end table
3168
3169 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3170 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3171 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3172 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3173
3174 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3175 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3176 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3177 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3178
3179 @itemize @bullet
3180 @item
3181 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3182 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3183
3184 @item
3185 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3186 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3187
3188 @item
3189 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3190 several places where that function is inlined.
3191 @end itemize
3192
3193 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3194 the relevant locations@footnote{
3195 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3196 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3197 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3198 info with line numbers for them.}.
3199
3200 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3201 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3202 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3203 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3204 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3205 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3206 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3207
3208 For example:
3209
3210 @smallexample
3211 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3212 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3213 stop only if i==1
3214 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3215 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3216 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3217 @end smallexample
3218
3219 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3220 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3221 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3222 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3223 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3224 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3225 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3226 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3227 that belong to that breakpoint.
3228
3229 @cindex pending breakpoints
3230 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3231 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3232 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3233 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3234 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3235 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3236 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3237 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3238 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3239 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3240 is not yet resolved.
3241
3242 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3243 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3244 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3245 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3246 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3247 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3248
3249 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3250 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3251 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3252 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3253
3254 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3255 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3256 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3257
3258 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3259 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3260 address specification to an address:
3261
3262 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3263 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3264 @table @code
3265 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3266 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3267 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3268
3269 @item set breakpoint pending on
3270 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3271 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3272
3273 @item set breakpoint pending off
3274 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3275 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3276 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3277
3278 @item show breakpoint pending
3279 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3280 @end table
3281
3282 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3283 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3284 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3285
3286 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3287 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3288 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3289 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3290 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3291 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3292 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3293 breakpoints.
3294
3295 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3296
3297 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3298 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3299 @table @code
3300 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3301 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3302 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3303 breakpoint must be used.
3304
3305 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3306 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3307 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3308 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3309 @end table
3310
3311 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3312 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3313 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3314 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3315 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3316 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3317 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3318 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3319 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3320
3321 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3322 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3323 @table @code
3324 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3325 This is the default behaviour. All breakpoints, including newly added
3326 by the user, are inserted in the target only when the target is
3327 resumed. All breakpoints are removed from the target when it stops.
3328
3329 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3330 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3331 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3332 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3333 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3334 @end table
3335
3336 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3337 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3338 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3339 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3340 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3341 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3342 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3343 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3344
3345
3346 @node Set Watchpoints
3347 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3348
3349 @cindex setting watchpoints
3350 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3351 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3352 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3353 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3354 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3355
3356 @itemize @bullet
3357 @item
3358 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3359
3360 @item
3361 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3362 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3363 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3364
3365 @item
3366 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3367 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3368 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3369 @end itemize
3370
3371 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3372 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3373 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3374 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3375 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3376 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3377 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3378 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3379 the expression changes.
3380
3381 @cindex software watchpoints
3382 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3383 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3384 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3385 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3386 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3387 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3388 culprit.)
3389
3390 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3391 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3392 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex watch
3396 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3397 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3398 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3399 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3400 to watch the value of a single variable:
3401
3402 @smallexample
3403 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3404 @end smallexample
3405
3406 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3407 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3408 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3409 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3410 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3411 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3412
3413 @kindex rwatch
3414 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3415 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3416 by the program.
3417
3418 @kindex awatch
3419 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3420 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3421 or written into by the program.
3422
3423 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3424 @item info watchpoints
3425 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3426 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3427 @end table
3428
3429 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3430 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3431 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3432 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3433 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3434 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3435
3436 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3437 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3438 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3439 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3440 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3441 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3442 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3443 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3444
3445 @table @code
3446 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3447 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3448 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3449
3450 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3451 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3452 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3453 @end table
3454
3455 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3456 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3457 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3458
3459 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3460
3461 @smallexample
3462 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3463 @end smallexample
3464
3465 @noindent
3466 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3467
3468 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3469 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3470 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3471 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3472 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3473 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3474 will print a message like this:
3475
3476 @smallexample
3477 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3478 @end smallexample
3479
3480 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3481 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3482 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3483 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3484 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3485 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3486 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3487 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3488
3489 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3490 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3491 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3492 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3493 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3494 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3495
3496 @smallexample
3497 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3498 @end smallexample
3499
3500 @noindent
3501 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3502
3503 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3504 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3505 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3506 expression with separately allocated resources.
3507
3508 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3509 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3510 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3511
3512 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3513 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3514 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3515 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3516 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3517 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3518 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3519 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3520 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3521
3522 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3523 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3524 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3525 watched expression from every thread.
3526
3527 @quotation
3528 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3529 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3530 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3531 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3532 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3533 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3534 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3535 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3536 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3537 @end quotation
3538
3539 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3540
3541 @node Set Catchpoints
3542 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3543 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3544 @cindex exception handlers
3545 @cindex event handling
3546
3547 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3548 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3549 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3550
3551 @table @code
3552 @kindex catch
3553 @item catch @var{event}
3554 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3555 @table @code
3556 @item throw
3557 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3558 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3559
3560 @item catch
3561 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3562
3563 @item exception
3564 @cindex Ada exception catching
3565 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3566 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3567 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3568 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3569 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3570
3571 @item exception unhandled
3572 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3573
3574 @item assert
3575 A failed Ada assertion.
3576
3577 @item exec
3578 @cindex break on fork/exec
3579 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3580 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3581
3582 @item fork
3583 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3584 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3585
3586 @item vfork
3587 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3588 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3589
3590 @item load
3591 @itemx load @var{libname}
3592 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3593 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3594 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3595
3596 @item unload
3597 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3598 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3599 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3600 @end table
3601
3602 @item tcatch @var{event}
3603 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3604 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3605
3606 @end table
3607
3608 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3609
3610 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3611 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3612
3613 @itemize @bullet
3614 @item
3615 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3616 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3617 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3618 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3619 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3620 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3621 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3622 disabled within interactive calls.
3623
3624 @item
3625 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3626
3627 @item
3628 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3629 @end itemize
3630
3631 @cindex raise exceptions
3632 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3633 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3634 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3635 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3636 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3637 out where the exception was raised.
3638
3639 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3640 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3641 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3642 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3643
3644 @smallexample
3645 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3646 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3647 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3648 @end smallexample
3649
3650 @noindent
3651 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3652 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3653 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3654
3655 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3656 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3657 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3658 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3659 raised.
3660
3661
3662 @node Delete Breaks
3663 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3664
3665 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3666 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3667 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3668 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3669 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3670 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3671
3672 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3673 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3674 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3675 their breakpoint numbers.
3676
3677 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3678 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3679 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3680
3681 @table @code
3682 @kindex clear
3683 @item clear
3684 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3685 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3686 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3687 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3688
3689 @item clear @var{location}
3690 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3691 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3692 most useful ones are listed below:
3693
3694 @table @code
3695 @item clear @var{function}
3696 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3697 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3698
3699 @item clear @var{linenum}
3700 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3701 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3702 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3703 @end table
3704
3705 @cindex delete breakpoints
3706 @kindex delete
3707 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3708 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3709 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3710 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3711 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3712 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3713 @end table
3714
3715 @node Disabling
3716 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3717
3718 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3719 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3720 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3721 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3722 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3723
3724 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3725 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3726 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3727 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3728 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3729
3730 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3731 affects all of its locations.
3732
3733 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3734 states of enablement:
3735
3736 @itemize @bullet
3737 @item
3738 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3739 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3740 @item
3741 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3742 @item
3743 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3744 disabled.
3745 @item
3746 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3747 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3748 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3749 @end itemize
3750
3751 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3752 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3753
3754 @table @code
3755 @kindex disable
3756 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3757 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3758 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3759 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3760 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3761 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3762 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3763
3764 @kindex enable
3765 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3766 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3767 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3768
3769 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3770 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3771 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3772
3773 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3774 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3775 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3776 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3777 @end table
3778
3779 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3780 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3781 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3782 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3783 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3784 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3785 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3786 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3787 Stepping}.)
3788
3789 @node Conditions
3790 @subsection Break Conditions
3791 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3792 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3793
3794 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3795 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3796 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3797 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3798 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3799 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3800 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3801 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3802
3803 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3804 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3805 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3806 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3807 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3808
3809 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3810 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3811 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3812 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3813 one.
3814
3815 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3816 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3817 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3818 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3819 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3820 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3821 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3822 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3823 conditions for the
3824 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3825 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3826
3827 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3828 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3829 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3830 with the @code{condition} command.
3831
3832 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3833 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3834 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3835 catchpoint.
3836
3837 @table @code
3838 @kindex condition
3839 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3840 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3841 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3842 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3843 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3844 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3845 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3846 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3847 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3848 prints an error message:
3849
3850 @smallexample
3851 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3852 @end smallexample
3853
3854 @noindent
3855 @value{GDBN} does
3856 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3857 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3858 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3859
3860 @item condition @var{bnum}
3861 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3862 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3863 @end table
3864
3865 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3866 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3867 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3868 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3869 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3870 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3871 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3872 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3873 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3874 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3875 your program reaches it.
3876
3877 @table @code
3878 @kindex ignore
3879 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3880 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3881 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3882 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3883 takes no action.
3884
3885 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3886 a count of zero.
3887
3888 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3889 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3890 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3891 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3892
3893 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3894 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3895 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3896
3897 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3898 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3899 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3900 Variables}.
3901 @end table
3902
3903 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3904
3905
3906 @node Break Commands
3907 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3908
3909 @cindex breakpoint commands
3910 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3911 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3912 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3913 enable other breakpoints.
3914
3915 @table @code
3916 @kindex commands
3917 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3918 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3919 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3920 @itemx end
3921 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3922 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3923 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3924
3925 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3926 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3927
3928 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3929 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3930 recently encountered).
3931 @end table
3932
3933 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3934 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3935
3936 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3937 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3938 that resumes execution.
3939
3940 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3941 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3942 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3943 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3944 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3945
3946 @kindex silent
3947 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3948 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3949 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3950 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3951 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3952 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3953
3954 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3955 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3956 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3957
3958 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3959 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3960
3961 @smallexample
3962 break foo if x>0
3963 commands
3964 silent
3965 printf "x is %d\n",x
3966 cont
3967 end
3968 @end smallexample
3969
3970 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3971 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3972 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3973 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3974 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3975 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3976 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3977
3978 @smallexample
3979 break 403
3980 commands
3981 silent
3982 set x = y + 4
3983 cont
3984 end
3985 @end smallexample
3986
3987 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3988 @node Error in Breakpoints
3989 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3990 @c
3991 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3992 @c
3993 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3994 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3995 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3996 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3997
3998 @smallexample
3999 Cannot insert breakpoints.
4000 The same program may be running in another process.
4001 @end smallexample
4002
4003 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
4004
4005 @enumerate
4006 @item
4007 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
4008
4009 @item
4010 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
4011 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
4012 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
4013 Then start your program again.
4014
4015 @item
4016 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
4017 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
4018 to nonsharable executables.
4019 @end enumerate
4020 @c @end ifclear
4021
4022 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
4023 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
4024
4025 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4026 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4027 @smallexample
4028 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4029 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4030 @end smallexample
4031
4032 @noindent
4033 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4034 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4035 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4036
4037 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4038 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4039
4040 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4041 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4042 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4043
4044 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4045 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4046 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4047 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4048
4049 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4050 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4051 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4052 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4053 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4054 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4055 first in the bundle.
4056
4057 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4058 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4059 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4060 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4061 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4062 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4063 is hit.
4064
4065 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4066 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4067
4068 @smallexample
4069 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4070 @end smallexample
4071
4072 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4073 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4074 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4075 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4076 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4077 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4078 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4079 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4080
4081 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4082 adjusted breakpoints:
4083
4084 @smallexample
4085 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4086 to 0x00010410.
4087 @end smallexample
4088
4089 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4090 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4091 frequently than expected.
4092
4093 @node Continuing and Stepping
4094 @section Continuing and Stepping
4095
4096 @cindex stepping
4097 @cindex continuing
4098 @cindex resuming execution
4099 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4100 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4101 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4102 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4103 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4104 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4105 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4106 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4107
4108 @table @code
4109 @kindex continue
4110 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4111 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4112 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4113 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4114 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4115 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4116 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4117 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4118 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4119 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4120
4121 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4122 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4123 @code{continue} is ignored.
4124
4125 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4126 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4127 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4128 @code{continue}.
4129 @end table
4130
4131 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4132 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4133 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4134 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4135
4136 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4137 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4138 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4139 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4140 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4141 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4142
4143 @table @code
4144 @kindex step
4145 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4146 @item step
4147 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4148 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4149 abbreviated @code{s}.
4150
4151 @quotation
4152 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4153 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4154 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4155 @c distinction here.
4156 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4157 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4158 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4159 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4160 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4161 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4162 below.
4163 @end quotation
4164
4165 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4166 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4167 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4168 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4169 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4170 called within the line.
4171
4172 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4173 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4174 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4175 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4176 was any debugging information about the routine.
4177
4178 @item step @var{count}
4179 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4180 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4181 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4182
4183 @kindex next
4184 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4185 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4186 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4187 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4188 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4189 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4190 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4191 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4192
4193 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4194
4195
4196 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4197 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4198 @c
4199 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4200 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4201 @c function are executed without stopping.
4202
4203 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4204 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4205 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4206
4207 @kindex set step-mode
4208 @item set step-mode
4209 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4210 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4211 @itemx set step-mode on
4212 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4213 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4214 information rather than stepping over it.
4215
4216 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4217 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4218 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4219
4220 @item set step-mode off
4221 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4222 debug information. This is the default.
4223
4224 @item show step-mode
4225 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4226 source line debug information.
4227
4228 @kindex finish
4229 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4230 @item finish
4231 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4232 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4233 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4234
4235 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4236 ,Returning from a Function}).
4237
4238 @kindex until
4239 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4240 @cindex run until specified location
4241 @item until
4242 @itemx u
4243 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4244 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4245 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4246 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4247 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4248 than the address of the jump.
4249
4250 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4251 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4252 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4253 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4254 through the next iteration.
4255
4256 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4257 stack frame.
4258
4259 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4260 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4261 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4262 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4263 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4264
4265 @smallexample
4266 (@value{GDBP}) f
4267 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4268 206 expand_input();
4269 (@value{GDBP}) until
4270 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4271 @end smallexample
4272
4273 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4274 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4275 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4276 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4277 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4278 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4279 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4280
4281 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4282 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4283 argument.
4284
4285 @item until @var{location}
4286 @itemx u @var{location}
4287 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4288 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4289 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4290 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4291 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4292 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4293 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4294 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4295 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4296 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4297 invocations have returned.
4298
4299 @smallexample
4300 94 int factorial (int value)
4301 95 @{
4302 96 if (value > 1) @{
4303 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4304 98 @}
4305 99 return (value);
4306 100 @}
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309
4310 @kindex advance @var{location}
4311 @itemx advance @var{location}
4312 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4313 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4314 @ref{Specify Location}.
4315 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4316 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4317 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4318 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4319
4320
4321 @kindex stepi
4322 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4323 @item stepi
4324 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4325 @itemx si
4326 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4327
4328 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4329 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4330 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4331 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4332
4333 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4334
4335 @need 750
4336 @kindex nexti
4337 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4338 @item nexti
4339 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4340 @itemx ni
4341 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4342 proceed until the function returns.
4343
4344 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4345 @end table
4346
4347 @node Signals
4348 @section Signals
4349 @cindex signals
4350
4351 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4352 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4353 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4354 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4355 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4356 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4357 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4358 requested an alarm).
4359
4360 @cindex fatal signals
4361 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4362 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4363 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4364 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4365 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4366 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4367
4368 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4369 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4370 signal.
4371
4372 @cindex handling signals
4373 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4374 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4375 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4376 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4377 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4378
4379 @table @code
4380 @kindex info signals
4381 @kindex info handle
4382 @item info signals
4383 @itemx info handle
4384 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4385 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4386 the defined types of signals.
4387
4388 @item info signals @var{sig}
4389 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4390
4391 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4392
4393 @kindex handle
4394 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4395 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4396 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4397 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4398 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4399 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4400 say what change to make.
4401 @end table
4402
4403 @c @group
4404 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4405 Their full names are:
4406
4407 @table @code
4408 @item nostop
4409 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4410 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4411
4412 @item stop
4413 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4414 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4415
4416 @item print
4417 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4418
4419 @item noprint
4420 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4421 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4422
4423 @item pass
4424 @itemx noignore
4425 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4426 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4427 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4428
4429 @item nopass
4430 @itemx ignore
4431 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4432 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4433 @end table
4434 @c @end group
4435
4436 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4437 program until you
4438 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4439 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4440 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4441 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4442 program sees that signal when you continue.
4443
4444 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4445 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4446 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4447 erroneous signals.
4448
4449 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4450 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4451 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4452 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4453 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4454 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4455 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4456 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4457 Program a Signal}.
4458
4459 @node Thread Stops
4460 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4461
4462 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4463 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4464 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4465
4466 @table @code
4467 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4468 @cindex thread breakpoints
4469 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4470 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4471 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4472 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4473 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4474 specify some source line.
4475
4476 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4477 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4478 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4479 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4480 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4481
4482 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4483 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4484 program.
4485
4486 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4487 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4488 breakpoint condition, like this:
4489
4490 @smallexample
4491 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4492 @end smallexample
4493
4494 @end table
4495
4496 @cindex stopped threads
4497 @cindex threads, stopped
4498 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4499 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4500 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4501 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4502 underfoot.
4503
4504 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4505 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4506 @cindex premature return from system calls
4507 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4508 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4509 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4510 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4511 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4512 stop execution.
4513
4514 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4515 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4516 style anyways.
4517
4518 For example, do not write code like this:
4519
4520 @smallexample
4521 sleep (10);
4522 @end smallexample
4523
4524 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4525 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4526
4527 Instead, write this:
4528
4529 @smallexample
4530 int unslept = 10;
4531 while (unslept > 0)
4532 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4533 @end smallexample
4534
4535 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4536 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4537 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4538 @value{GDBN}.
4539
4540 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4541 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4542 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4543 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4544
4545 @cindex continuing threads
4546 @cindex threads, continuing
4547 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4548 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4549 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4550
4551 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4552 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4553 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4554 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4555 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4556 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4557 stops.
4558
4559 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4560 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4561 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4562 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4563
4564 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4565 thread to run.
4566
4567 @table @code
4568 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4569 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4570 @cindex lock scheduler
4571 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4572 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4573 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4574 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4575 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4576 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4577 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4578 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4579 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4580 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4581 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4582
4583 @item show scheduler-locking
4584 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4585 @end table
4586
4587
4588 @node Stack
4589 @chapter Examining the Stack
4590
4591 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4592 stopped and how it got there.
4593
4594 @cindex call stack
4595 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4596 is generated.
4597 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4598 the arguments of the call,
4599 and the local variables of the function being called.
4600 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4601 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4602 stack}.
4603
4604 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4605 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4606
4607 @cindex selected frame
4608 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4609 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4610 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4611 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4612 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4613 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4614
4615 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4616 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4617 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4618
4619 @menu
4620 * Frames:: Stack frames
4621 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4622 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4623 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4624
4625 @end menu
4626
4627 @node Frames
4628 @section Stack Frames
4629
4630 @cindex frame, definition
4631 @cindex stack frame
4632 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4633 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4634 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4635 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4636 which the function is executing.
4637
4638 @cindex initial frame
4639 @cindex outermost frame
4640 @cindex innermost frame
4641 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4642 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4643 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4644 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4645 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4646 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4647 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4648 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4649
4650 @cindex frame pointer
4651 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4652 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4653 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4654 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4655 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4656 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4657
4658 @cindex frame number
4659 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4660 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4661 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4662 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4663 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4664
4665 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4666 @c underflow problems.
4667 @cindex frameless execution
4668 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4669 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4670 @smallexample
4671 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4672 @end smallexample
4673 generates functions without a frame.)
4674 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4675 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4676 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4677 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4678 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4679 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4680 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4681
4682 @table @code
4683 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4684 @cindex current stack frame
4685 @item frame @var{args}
4686 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4687 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4688 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4689 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4690
4691 @kindex select-frame
4692 @cindex selecting frame silently
4693 @item select-frame
4694 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4695 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4696 @code{frame}.
4697 @end table
4698
4699 @node Backtrace
4700 @section Backtraces
4701
4702 @cindex traceback
4703 @cindex call stack traces
4704 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4705 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4706 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4707 stack.
4708
4709 @table @code
4710 @kindex backtrace
4711 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4712 @item backtrace
4713 @itemx bt
4714 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4715 frames in the stack.
4716
4717 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4718 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4719
4720 @item backtrace @var{n}
4721 @itemx bt @var{n}
4722 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4723
4724 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4725 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4726 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4727
4728 @item backtrace full
4729 @itemx bt full
4730 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4731 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4732 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4733 number of frames to print, as described above.
4734 @end table
4735
4736 @kindex where
4737 @kindex info stack
4738 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4739 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4740
4741 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4742 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4743 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4744 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4745 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4746 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4747 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4748 multi-threaded program.
4749
4750 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4751 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4752 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4753 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4754 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4755 line number.
4756
4757 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4758 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4759
4760 @smallexample
4761 @group
4762 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4763 at builtin.c:993
4764 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4765 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4766 at macro.c:71
4767 (More stack frames follow...)
4768 @end group
4769 @end smallexample
4770
4771 @noindent
4772 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4773 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4774 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4775
4776 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4777 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4778 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4779 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4780 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4781 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4782 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4783 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4784 such a backtrace might look like:
4785
4786 @smallexample
4787 @group
4788 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4789 at builtin.c:993
4790 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4791 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4792 at macro.c:71
4793 (More stack frames follow...)
4794 @end group
4795 @end smallexample
4796
4797 @noindent
4798 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4799 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4800
4801 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4802 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4803 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4804
4805 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4806 @cindex program entry point
4807 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4808 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4809 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4810 @code{main}@footnote{
4811 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4812 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4813 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4814 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4815 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4816 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4817
4818 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4819 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4820
4821 @table @code
4822 @item set backtrace past-main
4823 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4824 @kindex set backtrace
4825 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4826
4827 @item set backtrace past-main off
4828 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4829 default.
4830
4831 @item show backtrace past-main
4832 @kindex show backtrace
4833 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4834
4835 @item set backtrace past-entry
4836 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4837 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4838 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4839 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4840
4841 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4842 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4843 application. This is the default.
4844
4845 @item show backtrace past-entry
4846 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4847
4848 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4849 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4850 @cindex backtrace limit
4851 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4852 unlimited.
4853
4854 @item show backtrace limit
4855 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4856 @end table
4857
4858 @node Selection
4859 @section Selecting a Frame
4860
4861 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4862 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4863 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4864 of the stack frame just selected.
4865
4866 @table @code
4867 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4868 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4869 @item frame @var{n}
4870 @itemx f @var{n}
4871 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4872 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4873 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4874 @code{main}.
4875
4876 @item frame @var{addr}
4877 @itemx f @var{addr}
4878 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4879 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4880 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4881 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4882 switches between them.
4883
4884 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4885 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4886
4887 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4888 pointer and a program counter.
4889
4890 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4891 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4892
4893 @kindex up
4894 @item up @var{n}
4895 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4896 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4897 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4898
4899 @kindex down
4900 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4901 @item down @var{n}
4902 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4903 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4904 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4905 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4906 @end table
4907
4908 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4909 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4910 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4911 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4912
4913 @need 1000
4914 For example:
4915
4916 @smallexample
4917 @group
4918 (@value{GDBP}) up
4919 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4920 at env.c:10
4921 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4922 @end group
4923 @end smallexample
4924
4925 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4926 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4927 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4928 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4929 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4930 for details.
4931
4932 @table @code
4933 @kindex down-silently
4934 @kindex up-silently
4935 @item up-silently @var{n}
4936 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4937 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4938 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4939 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4940 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4941 distracting.
4942 @end table
4943
4944 @node Frame Info
4945 @section Information About a Frame
4946
4947 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4948 stack frame.
4949
4950 @table @code
4951 @item frame
4952 @itemx f
4953 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4954 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4955 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4956 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4957 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4958
4959 @kindex info frame
4960 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4961 @item info frame
4962 @itemx info f
4963 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4964 including:
4965
4966 @itemize @bullet
4967 @item
4968 the address of the frame
4969 @item
4970 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4971 @item
4972 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4973 @item
4974 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4975 @item
4976 the address of the frame's arguments
4977 @item
4978 the address of the frame's local variables
4979 @item
4980 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4981 @item
4982 which registers were saved in the frame
4983 @end itemize
4984
4985 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4986 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4987 the usual conventions.
4988
4989 @item info frame @var{addr}
4990 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4991 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4992 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4993 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4994 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4995 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4996
4997 @kindex info args
4998 @item info args
4999 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5000
5001 @item info locals
5002 @kindex info locals
5003 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5004 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5005 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5006
5007 @kindex info catch
5008 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5009 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5010 @item info catch
5011 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5012 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5013 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5014 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5015 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5016
5017 @end table
5018
5019
5020 @node Source
5021 @chapter Examining Source Files
5022
5023 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5024 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5025 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5026 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5027 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5028 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5029 source files by explicit command.
5030
5031 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5032 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5033 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5034
5035 @menu
5036 * List:: Printing source lines
5037 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5038 * Edit:: Editing source files
5039 * Search:: Searching source files
5040 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5041 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5042 @end menu
5043
5044 @node List
5045 @section Printing Source Lines
5046
5047 @kindex list
5048 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5049 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5050 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5051 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5052 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5053
5054 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5055
5056 @table @code
5057 @item list @var{linenum}
5058 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5059 current source file.
5060
5061 @item list @var{function}
5062 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5063 @var{function}.
5064
5065 @item list
5066 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5067 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5068 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5069 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5070 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5071
5072 @item list -
5073 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5074 @end table
5075
5076 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5077 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5078 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5079
5080 @table @code
5081 @kindex set listsize
5082 @item set listsize @var{count}
5083 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5084 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5085
5086 @kindex show listsize
5087 @item show listsize
5088 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5089 @end table
5090
5091 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5092 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5093 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5094 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5095 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5096
5097 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5098 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5099 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5100 to specify some source line.
5101
5102 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5103
5104 @table @code
5105 @item list @var{linespec}
5106 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5107
5108 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5109 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5110 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5111 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5112 the same source file as the first linespec.
5113
5114 @item list ,@var{last}
5115 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5116
5117 @item list @var{first},
5118 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5119
5120 @item list +
5121 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5122
5123 @item list -
5124 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5125
5126 @item list
5127 As described in the preceding table.
5128 @end table
5129
5130 @node Specify Location
5131 @section Specifying a Location
5132 @cindex specifying location
5133 @cindex linespec
5134
5135 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5136 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5137 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5138 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5139
5140 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5141 @value{GDBN} understands:
5142
5143 @table @code
5144 @item @var{linenum}
5145 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5146
5147 @item -@var{offset}
5148 @itemx +@var{offset}
5149 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5150 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5151 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5152 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5153 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5154 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5155 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5156 linespec.
5157
5158 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5159 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5160
5161 @item @var{function}
5162 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5163 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5164
5165 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5166 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5167 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5168 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5169 functions in different source files.
5170
5171 @item *@var{address}
5172 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5173 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5174 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5175 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5176 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5177 source files.
5178
5179 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5180 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5181 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5182 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5183 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5184 of @var{address}:
5185
5186 @table @code
5187 @item @var{expression}
5188 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5189
5190 @item @var{funcaddr}
5191 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5192 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5193 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5194 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5195 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5196 (although the Pascal form also works).
5197
5198 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5199 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5200
5201 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5202 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5203 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5204 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5205 functions with identical names in different source files.
5206 @end table
5207
5208 @end table
5209
5210
5211 @node Edit
5212 @section Editing Source Files
5213 @cindex editing source files
5214
5215 @kindex edit
5216 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5217 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5218 The editing program of your choice
5219 is invoked with the current line set to
5220 the active line in the program.
5221 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5222 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5223
5224 @table @code
5225 @item edit @var{location}
5226 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5227 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5228 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5229 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5230 command most commonly used:
5231
5232 @table @code
5233 @item edit @var{number}
5234 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5235
5236 @item edit @var{function}
5237 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5238 @end table
5239
5240 @end table
5241
5242 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5243 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5244 @footnote{
5245 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5246 following command-line syntax:
5247 @smallexample
5248 ex +@var{number} file
5249 @end smallexample
5250 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5251 the file where to start editing.}.
5252 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5253 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5254 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5255 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5256 @smallexample
5257 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5258 export EDITOR
5259 gdb @dots{}
5260 @end smallexample
5261 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5262 @smallexample
5263 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5264 gdb @dots{}
5265 @end smallexample
5266
5267 @node Search
5268 @section Searching Source Files
5269 @cindex searching source files
5270
5271 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5272 regular expression.
5273
5274 @table @code
5275 @kindex search
5276 @kindex forward-search
5277 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5278 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5279 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5280 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5281 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5282 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5283 @code{fo}.
5284
5285 @kindex reverse-search
5286 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5287 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5288 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5289 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5290 this command as @code{rev}.
5291 @end table
5292
5293 @node Source Path
5294 @section Specifying Source Directories
5295
5296 @cindex source path
5297 @cindex directories for source files
5298 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5299 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5300 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5301 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5302 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5303 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5304 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5305
5306 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5307 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5308 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5309 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5310 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5311 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5312 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5313 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5314 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5315 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5316 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5317
5318 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5319 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5320 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5321 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5322 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5323 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5324
5325 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5326 source files.
5327
5328 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5329 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5330 each line is in the file.
5331
5332 @kindex directory
5333 @kindex dir
5334 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5335 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5336 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5337
5338 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5339 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5340
5341 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5342 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5343 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5344 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5345 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5346 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5347 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5348 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5349 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5350 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5351 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5352 name to look up the sources.
5353
5354 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5355 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5356 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5357 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5358 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5359 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5360 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5361 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5362
5363 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5364 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5365 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5366 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5367 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5368 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5369 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5370
5371 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5372 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5373 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5374 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5375 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5376 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5377 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5378 command.
5379
5380 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5381 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5382 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5383 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5384 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5385 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5386 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5387
5388 @table @code
5389 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5390 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5391 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5392 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5393 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5394 part of absolute file names) or
5395 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5396 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5397
5398 @kindex cdir
5399 @kindex cwd
5400 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5401 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5402 @cindex compilation directory
5403 @cindex current directory
5404 @cindex working directory
5405 @cindex directory, current
5406 @cindex directory, compilation
5407 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5408 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5409 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5410 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5411 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5412 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5413
5414 @item directory
5415 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5416
5417 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5418 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5419
5420 @item show directories
5421 @kindex show directories
5422 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5423
5424 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5425 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5426 @kindex set substitute-path
5427 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5428 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5429 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5430
5431 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5432 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5433
5434 @smallexample
5435 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5436 @end smallexample
5437
5438 @noindent
5439 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5440 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5441 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5442
5443 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5444 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5445 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5446 the substitution.
5447
5448 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5449
5450 @smallexample
5451 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5452 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455 @noindent
5456 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5457 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5458 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5459 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5460
5461
5462 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5463 @kindex unset substitute-path
5464 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5465 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5466 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5467
5468 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5469
5470 @item show substitute-path [path]
5471 @kindex show substitute-path
5472 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5473 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5474
5475 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5476 rules.
5477
5478 @end table
5479
5480 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5481 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5482 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5483
5484 @enumerate
5485 @item
5486 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5487
5488 @item
5489 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5490 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5491 directories in one command.
5492 @end enumerate
5493
5494 @node Machine Code
5495 @section Source and Machine Code
5496 @cindex source line and its code address
5497
5498 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5499 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5500 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5501 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5502 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5503 well as hex.
5504
5505 @table @code
5506 @kindex info line
5507 @item info line @var{linespec}
5508 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5509 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5510 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5511 @end table
5512
5513 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5514 the object code for the first line of function
5515 @code{m4_changequote}:
5516
5517 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5518 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5519 @smallexample
5520 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5521 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5522 @end smallexample
5523
5524 @noindent
5525 @cindex code address and its source line
5526 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5527 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5528 @smallexample
5529 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5530 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5531 @end smallexample
5532
5533 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5534 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5535 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5536 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5537 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5538 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5539 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5540 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5541 Variables}).
5542
5543 @table @code
5544 @kindex disassemble
5545 @cindex assembly instructions
5546 @cindex instructions, assembly
5547 @cindex machine instructions
5548 @cindex listing machine instructions
5549 @item disassemble
5550 @itemx disassemble /m
5551 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5552 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5553 the @code{/m} modifier.
5554 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5555 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5556 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5557 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5558 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5559 @end table
5560
5561 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5562 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5563
5564 @smallexample
5565 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5566 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5567 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5568 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5569 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5570 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5571 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5572 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5573 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5574 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5575 End of assembler dump.
5576 @end smallexample
5577
5578 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5579
5580 @smallexample
5581 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5582 Dump of assembler code for function main:
5583 5 @{
5584 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
5585 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
5586 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
5587 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
5588 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
5589
5590 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
5591 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
5592 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
5593
5594 7 return 0;
5595 8 @}
5596 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
5597 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
5598 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
5599
5600 End of assembler dump.
5601 @end smallexample
5602
5603 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5604 mnemonics or other syntax.
5605
5606 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5607 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5608 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5609 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5610 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5611
5612 @table @code
5613 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5614 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5615 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5616 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5617 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5618 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5619
5620 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5621 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5622 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5623 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5624
5625 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5626 @item show disassembly-flavor
5627 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5628 @end table
5629
5630
5631 @node Data
5632 @chapter Examining Data
5633
5634 @cindex printing data
5635 @cindex examining data
5636 @kindex print
5637 @kindex inspect
5638 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5639 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5640 @c different window or something like that.
5641 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5642 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5643 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5644 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5645 Different Languages}).
5646
5647 @table @code
5648 @item print @var{expr}
5649 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5650 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5651 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5652 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5653 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5654 Formats}.
5655
5656 @item print
5657 @itemx print /@var{f}
5658 @cindex reprint the last value
5659 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5660 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5661 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5662 @end table
5663
5664 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5665 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5666 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5667
5668 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5669 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5670 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5671 Table}.
5672
5673 @menu
5674 * Expressions:: Expressions
5675 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
5676 * Variables:: Program variables
5677 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5678 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5679 * Memory:: Examining memory
5680 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5681 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5682 * Value History:: Value history
5683 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5684 * Registers:: Registers
5685 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5686 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5687 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5688 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5689 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5690 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5691 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5692 character set than GDB does
5693 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5694 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
5695 @end menu
5696
5697 @node Expressions
5698 @section Expressions
5699
5700 @cindex expressions
5701 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5702 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5703 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5704 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5705 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5706 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5707 @ref{Compilation}.
5708
5709 @cindex arrays in expressions
5710 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5711 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5712 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5713 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5714 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5715 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5716
5717 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5718 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5719 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5720 languages.
5721
5722 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5723 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5724
5725 @cindex casts, in expressions
5726 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5727 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5728 at that address in memory.
5729 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5730
5731 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5732 to programming languages:
5733
5734 @table @code
5735 @item @@
5736 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5737 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5738
5739 @item ::
5740 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5741 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5742
5743 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5744 @cindex type casting memory
5745 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5746 @cindex casts, to view memory
5747 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5748 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5749 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5750 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5751 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5752 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5753 @end table
5754
5755 @node Ambiguous Expressions
5756 @section Ambiguous Expressions
5757 @cindex ambiguous expressions
5758
5759 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
5760 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
5761 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
5762 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
5763 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
5764 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
5765 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
5766
5767 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
5768 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
5769 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
5770 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
5771 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
5772 as well.
5773
5774 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
5775 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
5776 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
5777 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
5778 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
5779 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
5780 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
5781 choices.
5782
5783 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
5784 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
5785 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
5786
5787 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
5788 @smallexample
5789 @group
5790 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
5791 [0] cancel
5792 [1] all
5793 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
5794 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
5795 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
5796 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
5797 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
5798 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
5799 > 2 4 6
5800 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
5801 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
5802 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
5803 Multiple breakpoints were set.
5804 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
5805 breakpoints.
5806 (@value{GDBP})
5807 @end group
5808 @end smallexample
5809
5810 @table @code
5811 @kindex set multiple-symbols
5812 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
5813 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
5814
5815 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
5816 is ambiguous.
5817
5818 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
5819 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
5820 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
5821 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
5822 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
5823 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
5824 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
5825 in the use of the menu.
5826
5827 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
5828 when an ambiguity is detected.
5829
5830 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
5831 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
5832
5833 @kindex show multiple-symbols
5834 @item show multiple-symbols
5835 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
5836 @end table
5837
5838 @node Variables
5839 @section Program Variables
5840
5841 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5842 in your program.
5843
5844 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5845 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5846
5847 @itemize @bullet
5848 @item
5849 global (or file-static)
5850 @end itemize
5851
5852 @noindent or
5853
5854 @itemize @bullet
5855 @item
5856 visible according to the scope rules of the
5857 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5858 @end itemize
5859
5860 @noindent This means that in the function
5861
5862 @smallexample
5863 foo (a)
5864 int a;
5865 @{
5866 bar (a);
5867 @{
5868 int b = test ();
5869 bar (b);
5870 @}
5871 @}
5872 @end smallexample
5873
5874 @noindent
5875 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5876 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5877 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5878 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5879
5880 @cindex variable name conflict
5881 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5882 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5883 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5884 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5885 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5886 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5887 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5888
5889 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5890 @ifnotinfo
5891 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5892 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5893 @end ifnotinfo
5894 @smallexample
5895 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5896 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5897 @end smallexample
5898
5899 @noindent
5900 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5901 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5902 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5903 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5904
5905 @smallexample
5906 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5907 @end smallexample
5908
5909 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5910 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5911 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5912 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5913 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5914 @c conflict?? --mew
5915
5916 @cindex wrong values
5917 @cindex variable values, wrong
5918 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5919 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5920 @quotation
5921 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5922 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5923 scope, and just before exit.
5924 @end quotation
5925 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5926 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5927 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5928 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5929 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5930 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5931 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5932 variable definitions may be gone.
5933
5934 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5935 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5936 when compiling.
5937
5938 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5939 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5940 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5941 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5942 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5943 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5944 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5945
5946 @smallexample
5947 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5948 @end smallexample
5949
5950 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5951 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5952 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5953 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5954 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5955 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5956 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5957 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5958 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5959 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5960 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5961
5962 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5963 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5964 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5965 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5966
5967 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5968 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5969 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5970 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5971 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5972 For program code
5973
5974 @smallexample
5975 char var0[] = "A";
5976 signed char var1[] = "A";
5977 @end smallexample
5978
5979 You get during debugging
5980 @smallexample
5981 (gdb) print var0
5982 $1 = "A"
5983 (gdb) print var1
5984 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5985 @end smallexample
5986
5987 @node Arrays
5988 @section Artificial Arrays
5989
5990 @cindex artificial array
5991 @cindex arrays
5992 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5993 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5994 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5995 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5996 program.
5997
5998 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5999 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6000 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6001 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6002 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6003 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6004 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6005 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6006 example. If a program says
6007
6008 @smallexample
6009 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6010 @end smallexample
6011
6012 @noindent
6013 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6014
6015 @smallexample
6016 p *array@@len
6017 @end smallexample
6018
6019 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6020 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6021 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6022 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6023 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6024
6025 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6026 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6027 The value need not be in memory:
6028 @smallexample
6029 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6030 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6031 @end smallexample
6032
6033 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6034 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6035 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6036 @smallexample
6037 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6038 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6039 @end smallexample
6040
6041 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6042 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6043 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6044 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6045 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6046 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6047 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6048 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6049 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6050 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6051
6052 @smallexample
6053 set $i = 0
6054 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6055 @key{RET}
6056 @key{RET}
6057 @dots{}
6058 @end smallexample
6059
6060 @node Output Formats
6061 @section Output Formats
6062
6063 @cindex formatted output
6064 @cindex output formats
6065 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6066 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6067 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6068 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6069 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6070
6071 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6072 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6073 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6074 letters supported are:
6075
6076 @table @code
6077 @item x
6078 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6079 hexadecimal.
6080
6081 @item d
6082 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6083
6084 @item u
6085 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6086
6087 @item o
6088 Print as integer in octal.
6089
6090 @item t
6091 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6092 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6093 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6094 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6095
6096 @item a
6097 @cindex unknown address, locating
6098 @cindex locate address
6099 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6100 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6101 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6102
6103 @smallexample
6104 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6105 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6106 @end smallexample
6107
6108 @noindent
6109 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6110 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6111
6112 @item c
6113 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6114 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6115 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6116 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6117
6118 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6119 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6120 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6121 data.
6122
6123 @item f
6124 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6125 using typical floating point syntax.
6126
6127 @item s
6128 @cindex printing strings
6129 @cindex printing byte arrays
6130 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6131 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6132 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6133 natural types.
6134
6135 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6136 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6137 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6138 array.
6139 @end table
6140
6141 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6142
6143 @smallexample
6144 p/x $pc
6145 @end smallexample
6146
6147 @noindent
6148 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6149 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6150
6151 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6152 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6153 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6154
6155 @node Memory
6156 @section Examining Memory
6157
6158 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6159 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6160
6161 @cindex examining memory
6162 @table @code
6163 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6164 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6165 @itemx x @var{addr}
6166 @itemx x
6167 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6168 @end table
6169
6170 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6171 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6172 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6173 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6174 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6175
6176 @table @r
6177 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6178 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6179 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6180 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6181 @c 4.1.2.
6182
6183 @item @var{f}, the display format
6184 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6185 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6186 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6187 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6188 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6189
6190 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6191 The unit size is any of
6192
6193 @table @code
6194 @item b
6195 Bytes.
6196 @item h
6197 Halfwords (two bytes).
6198 @item w
6199 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6200 @item g
6201 Giant words (eight bytes).
6202 @end table
6203
6204 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6205 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6206 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6207
6208 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6209 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6210 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6211 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6212 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6213 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6214 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6215 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6216 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6217 a value from memory).
6218 @end table
6219
6220 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6221 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6222 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6223 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6224 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6225
6226 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6227 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6228 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6229 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6230 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6231
6232 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6233 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6234 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6235 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6236 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6237 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6238 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6239 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6240 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6241
6242 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6243 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6244 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6245 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6246 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6247 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6248 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6249
6250 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6251 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6252 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6253 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6254 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6255 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6256 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6257 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6258 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6259
6260 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6261 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6262 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6263
6264 @cindex remote memory comparison
6265 @cindex verify remote memory image
6266 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6267 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6268 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6269 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6270 situations.
6271
6272 @table @code
6273 @kindex compare-sections
6274 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6275 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6276 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6277 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6278 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6279 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6280 remote request.
6281 @end table
6282
6283 @node Auto Display
6284 @section Automatic Display
6285 @cindex automatic display
6286 @cindex display of expressions
6287
6288 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6289 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6290 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6291 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6292 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6293 The automatic display looks like this:
6294
6295 @smallexample
6296 2: foo = 38
6297 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6298 @end smallexample
6299
6300 @noindent
6301 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6302 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6303 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6304 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6305 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6306 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6307
6308 @table @code
6309 @kindex display
6310 @item display @var{expr}
6311 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6312 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6313
6314 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6315
6316 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6317 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6318 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6319 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6320 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6321
6322 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6323 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6324 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6325 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6326 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6327 @end table
6328
6329 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6330 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6331 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6332
6333 @table @code
6334 @kindex delete display
6335 @kindex undisplay
6336 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6337 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6338 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6339
6340 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6341 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6342
6343 @kindex disable display
6344 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6345 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6346 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6347 enabled again later.
6348
6349 @kindex enable display
6350 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6351 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6352 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6353
6354 @item display
6355 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6356 done when your program stops.
6357
6358 @kindex info display
6359 @item info display
6360 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6361 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6362 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6363 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6364 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6365 @end table
6366
6367 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6368 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6369 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6370 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6371 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6372 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6373 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6374 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6375 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6376 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6377 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6378
6379 @node Print Settings
6380 @section Print Settings
6381
6382 @cindex format options
6383 @cindex print settings
6384 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6385 and symbols are printed.
6386
6387 @noindent
6388 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6389
6390 @table @code
6391 @kindex set print
6392 @item set print address
6393 @itemx set print address on
6394 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6395 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6396 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6397 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6398 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6399 @code{set print address on}:
6400
6401 @smallexample
6402 @group
6403 (@value{GDBP}) f
6404 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6405 at input.c:530
6406 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6407 @end group
6408 @end smallexample
6409
6410 @item set print address off
6411 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6412 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6413
6414 @smallexample
6415 @group
6416 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6417 (@value{GDBP}) f
6418 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6419 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6420 @end group
6421 @end smallexample
6422
6423 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6424 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6425 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6426 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6427
6428 @kindex show print
6429 @item show print address
6430 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6431 @end table
6432
6433 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6434 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6435 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6436 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6437 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6438 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6439 it prints a symbolic address:
6440
6441 @table @code
6442 @item set print symbol-filename on
6443 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6444 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6445 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6446 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6447
6448 @item set print symbol-filename off
6449 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6450 default.
6451
6452 @item show print symbol-filename
6453 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6454 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6455 @end table
6456
6457 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6458 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6459 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6460
6461 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6462 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6463
6464 @table @code
6465 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6466 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6467 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6468 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6469 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6470 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6471
6472 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6473 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6474 symbolic address.
6475 @end table
6476
6477 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6478 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6479 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6480 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6481 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6482 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6483 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6484 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6485
6486 @smallexample
6487 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6488 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6489 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6490 @end smallexample
6491
6492 @quotation
6493 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6494 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6495 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6496 @end quotation
6497
6498 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6499
6500 @table @code
6501 @item set print array
6502 @itemx set print array on
6503 @cindex pretty print arrays
6504 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6505 but uses more space. The default is off.
6506
6507 @item set print array off
6508 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6509
6510 @item show print array
6511 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6512 arrays.
6513
6514 @cindex print array indexes
6515 @item set print array-indexes
6516 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6517 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6518 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6519 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6520
6521 @item set print array-indexes off
6522 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6523
6524 @item show print array-indexes
6525 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6526 arrays.
6527
6528 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6529 @cindex number of array elements to print
6530 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6531 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6532 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6533 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6534 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6535 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6536 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6537
6538 @item show print elements
6539 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6540 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6541
6542 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6543 @cindex printing frame argument values
6544 @cindex print all frame argument values
6545 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6546 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6547 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6548 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6549 values are:
6550
6551 @table @code
6552 @item all
6553 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6554
6555 @item scalars
6556 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6557 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6558 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6559
6560 @smallexample
6561 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6562 at frame-args.c:23
6563 @end smallexample
6564
6565 @item none
6566 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6567 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6568
6569 @smallexample
6570 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6571 at frame-args.c:23
6572 @end smallexample
6573 @end table
6574
6575 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6576 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6577 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6578 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6579 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6580 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6581 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6582 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6583
6584 @item show print frame-arguments
6585 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6586
6587 @item set print repeats
6588 @cindex repeated array elements
6589 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6590 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6591 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6592 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6593 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6594 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6595 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6596
6597 @item show print repeats
6598 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6599 elements.
6600
6601 @item set print null-stop
6602 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6603 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6604 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6605 contain only short strings.
6606 The default is off.
6607
6608 @item show print null-stop
6609 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6610 @sc{null} character.
6611
6612 @item set print pretty on
6613 @cindex print structures in indented form
6614 @cindex indentation in structure display
6615 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6616 per line, like this:
6617
6618 @smallexample
6619 @group
6620 $1 = @{
6621 next = 0x0,
6622 flags = @{
6623 sweet = 1,
6624 sour = 1
6625 @},
6626 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6627 @}
6628 @end group
6629 @end smallexample
6630
6631 @item set print pretty off
6632 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6633
6634 @smallexample
6635 @group
6636 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6637 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6638 @end group
6639 @end smallexample
6640
6641 @noindent
6642 This is the default format.
6643
6644 @item show print pretty
6645 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6646
6647 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6648 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6649 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6650 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6651 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6652 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6653 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6654 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6655
6656 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6657 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6658 international character sets, and is the default.
6659
6660 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6661 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6662
6663 @item set print union on
6664 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6665 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6666 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6667
6668 @item set print union off
6669 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6670 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6671 instead.
6672
6673 @item show print union
6674 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6675 structures and other unions.
6676
6677 For example, given the declarations
6678
6679 @smallexample
6680 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6681 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6682 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6683 Bug_forms;
6684
6685 struct thing @{
6686 Species it;
6687 union @{
6688 Tree_forms tree;
6689 Bug_forms bug;
6690 @} form;
6691 @};
6692
6693 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6694 @end smallexample
6695
6696 @noindent
6697 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6698
6699 @smallexample
6700 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6701 @end smallexample
6702
6703 @noindent
6704 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6705
6706 @smallexample
6707 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6708 @end smallexample
6709
6710 @noindent
6711 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6712 and in Pascal.
6713 @end table
6714
6715 @need 1000
6716 @noindent
6717 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6718
6719 @table @code
6720 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6721 @item set print demangle
6722 @itemx set print demangle on
6723 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6724 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6725 linkage. The default is on.
6726
6727 @item show print demangle
6728 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6729
6730 @item set print asm-demangle
6731 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6732 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6733 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6734 The default is off.
6735
6736 @item show print asm-demangle
6737 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6738 or demangled form.
6739
6740 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6741 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6742 @kindex set demangle-style
6743 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6744 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6745 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6746
6747 @table @code
6748 @item auto
6749 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6750
6751 @item gnu
6752 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6753 This is the default.
6754
6755 @item hp
6756 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6757
6758 @item lucid
6759 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6760
6761 @item arm
6762 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6763 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6764 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6765 require further enhancement to permit that.
6766
6767 @end table
6768 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6769
6770 @item show demangle-style
6771 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6772
6773 @item set print object
6774 @itemx set print object on
6775 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6776 @cindex display derived types
6777 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6778 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6779 the virtual function table.
6780
6781 @item set print object off
6782 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6783 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6784
6785 @item show print object
6786 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6787
6788 @item set print static-members
6789 @itemx set print static-members on
6790 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6791 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6792
6793 @item set print static-members off
6794 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6795
6796 @item show print static-members
6797 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6798
6799 @item set print pascal_static-members
6800 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6801 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6802 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6803 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6804
6805 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6806 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6807
6808 @item show print pascal_static-members
6809 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6810
6811 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6812 @item set print vtbl
6813 @itemx set print vtbl on
6814 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6815 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6816 @cindex VTBL display
6817 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6818 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6819 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6820
6821 @item set print vtbl off
6822 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6823
6824 @item show print vtbl
6825 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6826 @end table
6827
6828 @node Value History
6829 @section Value History
6830
6831 @cindex value history
6832 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6833 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6834 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6835 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6836 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6837 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6838 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6839 symbol table.
6840
6841 @cindex @code{$}
6842 @cindex @code{$$}
6843 @cindex history number
6844 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6845 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6846 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6847 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6848 history number.
6849
6850 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6851 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6852 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6853 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6854 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6855 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6856 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6857
6858 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6859 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6860
6861 @smallexample
6862 p *$
6863 @end smallexample
6864
6865 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6866 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6867
6868 @smallexample
6869 p *$.next
6870 @end smallexample
6871
6872 @noindent
6873 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6874 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6875
6876 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6877 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6878
6879 @smallexample
6880 print x
6881 set x=5
6882 @end smallexample
6883
6884 @noindent
6885 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6886 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6887
6888 @table @code
6889 @kindex show values
6890 @item show values
6891 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6892 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6893 values} does not change the history.
6894
6895 @item show values @var{n}
6896 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6897
6898 @item show values +
6899 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6900 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6901 @end table
6902
6903 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6904 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6905
6906 @node Convenience Vars
6907 @section Convenience Variables
6908
6909 @cindex convenience variables
6910 @cindex user-defined variables
6911 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6912 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6913 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6914 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6915 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6916
6917 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6918 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6919 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6920 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6921 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6922
6923 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6924 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6925 For example:
6926
6927 @smallexample
6928 set $foo = *object_ptr
6929 @end smallexample
6930
6931 @noindent
6932 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6933 @code{object_ptr}.
6934
6935 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6936 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6937 value with another assignment at any time.
6938
6939 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6940 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6941 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6942 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6943
6944 @table @code
6945 @kindex show convenience
6946 @cindex show all user variables
6947 @item show convenience
6948 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6949 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6950
6951 @kindex init-if-undefined
6952 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6953 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6954 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6955 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6956 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6957 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6958 override default values used in a command script.
6959
6960 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6961 any side-effects do not occur.
6962 @end table
6963
6964 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6965 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6966 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6967
6968 @smallexample
6969 set $i = 0
6970 print bar[$i++]->contents
6971 @end smallexample
6972
6973 @noindent
6974 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6975
6976 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6977 values likely to be useful.
6978
6979 @table @code
6980 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6981 @item $_
6982 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6983 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6984 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6985 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6986 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6987 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6988 to the type of @code{$__}.
6989
6990 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6991 @item $__
6992 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6993 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6994 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6995
6996 @item $_exitcode
6997 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6998 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6999 the program being debugged terminates.
7000 @end table
7001
7002 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7003 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7004 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7005
7006 @node Registers
7007 @section Registers
7008
7009 @cindex registers
7010 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7011 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7012 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7013 your machine.
7014
7015 @table @code
7016 @kindex info registers
7017 @item info registers
7018 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7019 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7020
7021 @kindex info all-registers
7022 @cindex floating point registers
7023 @item info all-registers
7024 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7025 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7026
7027 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7028 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7029 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7030 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7031 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7032 @end table
7033
7034 @cindex stack pointer register
7035 @cindex program counter register
7036 @cindex process status register
7037 @cindex frame pointer register
7038 @cindex standard registers
7039 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7040 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7041 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7042 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7043 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7044 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7045 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7046 you could print the program counter in hex with
7047
7048 @smallexample
7049 p/x $pc
7050 @end smallexample
7051
7052 @noindent
7053 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7054
7055 @smallexample
7056 x/i $pc
7057 @end smallexample
7058
7059 @noindent
7060 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7061 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7062 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7063 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7064 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7065 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7066 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7067
7068 @smallexample
7069 set $sp += 4
7070 @end smallexample
7071
7072 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7073 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7074 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7075 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7076 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7077 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7078 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7079
7080 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7081 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7082 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7083 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7084 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7085 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7086 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7087
7088 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7089 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7090 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7091 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7092 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7093 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7094 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7095 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7096 prints the data in both formats.
7097
7098 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7099 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7100 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7101 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7102 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7103 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7104 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7105
7106 @smallexample
7107 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7108 $1 = @{
7109 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7110 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7111 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7112 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7113 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7114 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7115 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7116 @}
7117 @end smallexample
7118
7119 @noindent
7120 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7121 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7122 value to a @code{struct} member:
7123
7124 @smallexample
7125 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7126 @end smallexample
7127
7128 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7129 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7130 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7131 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7132 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7133 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7134
7135 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7136 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7137 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7138 frame makes no difference.
7139
7140 @node Floating Point Hardware
7141 @section Floating Point Hardware
7142 @cindex floating point
7143
7144 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7145 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7146
7147 @table @code
7148 @kindex info float
7149 @item info float
7150 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7151 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7152 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7153 the ARM and x86 machines.
7154 @end table
7155
7156 @node Vector Unit
7157 @section Vector Unit
7158 @cindex vector unit
7159
7160 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7161 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7162
7163 @table @code
7164 @kindex info vector
7165 @item info vector
7166 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7167 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7168 @end table
7169
7170 @node OS Information
7171 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7172 @cindex OS information
7173
7174 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7175 you debug your program.
7176
7177 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7178 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7179 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7180 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7181 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7182 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7183 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7184 structure.
7185
7186 @table @code
7187 @item info udot
7188 @kindex info udot
7189 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7190 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7191 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7192 the @code{examine} command.
7193 @end table
7194
7195 @cindex auxiliary vector
7196 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7197 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7198 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7199 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7200 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7201 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7202 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7203 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7204 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7205 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7206 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7207 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7208
7209 @table @code
7210 @kindex info auxv
7211 @item info auxv
7212 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7213 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7214 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7215 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7216 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7217 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7218 an unrecognized tag.
7219 @end table
7220
7221
7222 @node Memory Region Attributes
7223 @section Memory Region Attributes
7224 @cindex memory region attributes
7225
7226 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7227 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7228 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7229 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7230 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7231 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7232 user can override the fetched regions.
7233
7234 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7235 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7236 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7237 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7238 all memory.
7239
7240 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7241 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7242
7243 @table @code
7244 @kindex mem
7245 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7246 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7247 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7248 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7249 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7250 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7251
7252 @item mem auto
7253 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7254 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7255
7256 @kindex delete mem
7257 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7258 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7259 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7260
7261 @kindex disable mem
7262 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7263 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7264 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7265 It may be enabled again later.
7266
7267 @kindex enable mem
7268 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7269 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7270
7271 @kindex info mem
7272 @item info mem
7273 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7274 for each region:
7275
7276 @table @emph
7277 @item Memory Region Number
7278 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7279 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7280 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7281
7282 @item Lo Address
7283 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7284
7285 @item Hi Address
7286 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7287
7288 @item Attributes
7289 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7290 @end table
7291 @end table
7292
7293
7294 @subsection Attributes
7295
7296 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7297 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7298 write accesses to a memory region.
7299
7300 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7301 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7302 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7303
7304 @table @code
7305 @item ro
7306 Memory is read only.
7307 @item wo
7308 Memory is write only.
7309 @item rw
7310 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7311 @end table
7312
7313 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7314 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7315 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7316 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7317 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7318
7319 @table @code
7320 @item 8
7321 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7322 @item 16
7323 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7324 @item 32
7325 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7326 @item 64
7327 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7328 @end table
7329
7330 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7331 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7332 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7333 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7334 @c
7335 @c @table @code
7336 @c @item hwbreak
7337 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7338 @c @item swbreak (default)
7339 @c @end table
7340
7341 @subsubsection Data Cache
7342 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7343 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7344 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7345 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7346 registers.
7347
7348 @table @code
7349 @item cache
7350 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7351 @item nocache
7352 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7353 @end table
7354
7355 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7356 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7357 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7358 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7359 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7360
7361 @table @code
7362 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7363 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7364 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7365 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7366 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7367 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7368 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7369 The default value is @code{on}.
7370 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7371 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7372 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7373 @end table
7374
7375
7376 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7377 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7378 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7379 @c
7380 @c @table @code
7381 @c @item verify
7382 @c @item noverify (default)
7383 @c @end table
7384
7385 @node Dump/Restore Files
7386 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7387 @cindex dump/restore files
7388 @cindex append data to a file
7389 @cindex dump data to a file
7390 @cindex restore data from a file
7391
7392 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7393 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7394 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7395 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7396 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7397 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7398 files.
7399
7400 @table @code
7401
7402 @kindex dump
7403 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7404 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7405 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7406 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7407
7408 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7409 @table @code
7410 @item binary
7411 Raw binary form.
7412 @item ihex
7413 Intel hex format.
7414 @item srec
7415 Motorola S-record format.
7416 @item tekhex
7417 Tektronix Hex format.
7418 @end table
7419
7420 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7421 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7422 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7423 form.
7424
7425 @kindex append
7426 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7427 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7428 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7429 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7430 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7431
7432 @kindex restore
7433 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7434 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7435 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7436 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7437 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7438
7439 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7440 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7441 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7442 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7443 from that location.
7444
7445 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7446 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7447 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7448 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7449
7450 @end table
7451
7452 @node Core File Generation
7453 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7454 @cindex dump core from inferior
7455
7456 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7457 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7458 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7459 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7460 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7461 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7462 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7463
7464 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7465 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7466 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7467
7468 @table @code
7469 @kindex gcore
7470 @kindex generate-core-file
7471 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7472 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7473 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7474 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7475 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7476 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7477
7478 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7479 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7480 @end table
7481
7482 @node Character Sets
7483 @section Character Sets
7484 @cindex character sets
7485 @cindex charset
7486 @cindex translating between character sets
7487 @cindex host character set
7488 @cindex target character set
7489
7490 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7491 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7492 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7493 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7494 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7495 @dfn{target character set}.
7496
7497 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7498 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7499 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7500 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7501 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7502 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7503 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7504 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7505 character and string literals in expressions.
7506
7507 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7508 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7509 target-charset} command, described below.
7510
7511 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7512 support:
7513
7514 @table @code
7515 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7516 @kindex set target-charset
7517 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7518 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7519 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7520 list the target character sets it supports.
7521 @end table
7522
7523 @table @code
7524 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7525 @kindex set host-charset
7526 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7527
7528 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7529 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7530 @code{set host-charset} command.
7531
7532 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7533 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7534 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7535 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7536 list the host character sets it supports.
7537
7538 @item set charset @var{charset}
7539 @kindex set charset
7540 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7541 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7542 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7543 for both host and target.
7544
7545
7546 @item show charset
7547 @kindex show charset
7548 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7549
7550 @itemx show host-charset
7551 @kindex show host-charset
7552 Show the name of the current host charset.
7553
7554 @itemx show target-charset
7555 @kindex show target-charset
7556 Show the name of the current target charset.
7557
7558 @end table
7559
7560 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7561 sets:
7562
7563 @table @code
7564
7565 @item ASCII
7566 @cindex ASCII character set
7567 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7568 character set.
7569
7570 @item ISO-8859-1
7571 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7572 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7573 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7574 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7575 this as its host character set.
7576
7577 @item EBCDIC-US
7578 @itemx IBM1047
7579 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7580 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7581 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7582 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7583 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7584
7585 @end table
7586
7587 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7588 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7589 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7590
7591 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7592 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7593 @file{charset-test.c}:
7594
7595 @smallexample
7596 #include <stdio.h>
7597
7598 char ascii_hello[]
7599 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7600 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7601 char ibm1047_hello[]
7602 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7603 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7604
7605 main ()
7606 @{
7607 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7608 @}
7609 @end smallexample
7610
7611 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7612 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7613 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7614
7615 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7616
7617 @smallexample
7618 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7619 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7620 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7621 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7622 @dots{}
7623 (@value{GDBP})
7624 @end smallexample
7625
7626 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7627 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7628 strings:
7629
7630 @smallexample
7631 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7632 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7633 (@value{GDBP})
7634 @end smallexample
7635
7636 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7637 initial character set:
7638 @smallexample
7639 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7640 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7641 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7642 (@value{GDBP})
7643 @end smallexample
7644
7645 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7646 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7647 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7648 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7649 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7650
7651 @smallexample
7652 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7653 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7654 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7655 $2 = 72 'H'
7656 (@value{GDBP})
7657 @end smallexample
7658
7659 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7660 literals you use in expressions:
7661
7662 @smallexample
7663 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7664 $3 = 43 '+'
7665 (@value{GDBP})
7666 @end smallexample
7667
7668 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7669 character.
7670
7671 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7672 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7673 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7674
7675 @smallexample
7676 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7677 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7678 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7679 $5 = 200 '\310'
7680 (@value{GDBP})
7681 @end smallexample
7682
7683 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7684 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7685
7686 @smallexample
7687 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7688 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7689 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7690 @end smallexample
7691
7692 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7693 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7694 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7695 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7696 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7697
7698 @smallexample
7699 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7700 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7701 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7702 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7703 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7704 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7705 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7706 $7 = 72 '\110'
7707 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7708 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7709 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7710 $9 = 200 'H'
7711 (@value{GDBP})
7712 @end smallexample
7713
7714 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7715 string literals you use in expressions:
7716
7717 @smallexample
7718 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7719 $10 = 78 '+'
7720 (@value{GDBP})
7721 @end smallexample
7722
7723 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7724 character.
7725
7726 @node Caching Remote Data
7727 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7728 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7729
7730 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7731 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7732 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7733 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7734 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7735 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7736 volatile registers are in use.
7737
7738 @table @code
7739 @kindex set remotecache
7740 @item set remotecache on
7741 @itemx set remotecache off
7742 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7743 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7744
7745 @kindex show remotecache
7746 @item show remotecache
7747 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7748
7749 @kindex info dcache
7750 @item info dcache
7751 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7752 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7753 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7754 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7755 the data cache operation.
7756 @end table
7757
7758 @node Searching Memory
7759 @section Search Memory
7760 @cindex searching memory
7761
7762 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
7763 @code{find} command.
7764
7765 @table @code
7766 @kindex find
7767 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7768 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7769 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
7770 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
7771 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
7772 @end table
7773
7774 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
7775 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
7776
7777 @table @r
7778 @item @var{s}, search query size
7779 The size of each search query value.
7780
7781 @table @code
7782 @item b
7783 bytes
7784 @item h
7785 halfwords (two bytes)
7786 @item w
7787 words (four bytes)
7788 @item g
7789 giant words (eight bytes)
7790 @end table
7791
7792 All values are interpreted in the current language.
7793 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
7794 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
7795
7796 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
7797 value's type in the current language.
7798 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
7799 pattern as a mixture of types.
7800 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
7801 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
7802 which is typically four bytes.
7803
7804 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
7805 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
7806 @end table
7807
7808 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
7809 (@code{"}).
7810 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
7811 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
7812
7813 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
7814 number of matches found.
7815
7816 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
7817 @samp{$_}.
7818 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
7819
7820 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
7821
7822 @smallexample
7823 void
7824 hello ()
7825 @{
7826 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
7827 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
7828 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
7829 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
7830 printf ("%s\n", hello);
7831 @}
7832 @end smallexample
7833
7834 @noindent
7835 you get during debugging:
7836
7837 @smallexample
7838 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
7839 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
7840 1 pattern found
7841 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
7842 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
7843 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
7844 2 patterns found
7845 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
7846 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
7847 1 pattern found
7848 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
7849 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
7850 1 pattern found
7851 (gdb) print $numfound
7852 $1 = 1
7853 (gdb) print $_
7854 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
7855 @end smallexample
7856
7857 @node Macros
7858 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7859
7860 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7861 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7862 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7863 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7864 where it was defined.
7865
7866 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7867 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7868 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7869 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7870
7871 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7872 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7873 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7874 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7875 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7876 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7877 see @ref{List}.
7878
7879 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7880 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7881 variable-arity macros.
7882
7883 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7884 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7885 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7886
7887 @table @code
7888
7889 @kindex macro expand
7890 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7891 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7892 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7893 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7894 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7895 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7896 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7897 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7898 it can be any string of tokens.
7899
7900 @kindex macro exp1
7901 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7902 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7903 @cindex expand macro once
7904 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7905 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7906 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7907 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7908 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7909 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7910 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7911 can be any string of tokens.
7912
7913 @kindex info macro
7914 @cindex macro definition, showing
7915 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7916 @item info macro @var{macro}
7917 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7918 source location where that definition was established.
7919
7920 @kindex macro define
7921 @cindex user-defined macros
7922 @cindex defining macros interactively
7923 @cindex macros, user-defined
7924 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7925 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7926 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7927 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7928 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7929 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7930 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7931 given in @var{arglist}.
7932
7933 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7934 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7935 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7936 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7937 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7938
7939 @kindex macro undef
7940 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7941 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7942 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7943 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7944 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7945 debugged.
7946
7947 @kindex macro list
7948 @item macro list
7949 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7950 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7951 @end table
7952
7953 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7954 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7955 show our source files:
7956
7957 @smallexample
7958 $ cat sample.c
7959 #include <stdio.h>
7960 #include "sample.h"
7961
7962 #define M 42
7963 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7964
7965 main ()
7966 @{
7967 #define N 28
7968 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7969 #undef N
7970 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7971 #define N 1729
7972 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7973 @}
7974 $ cat sample.h
7975 #define Q <
7976 $
7977 @end smallexample
7978
7979 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7980 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7981 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7982 information.
7983
7984 @smallexample
7985 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7986 $
7987 @end smallexample
7988
7989 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7990
7991 @smallexample
7992 $ gdb -nw sample
7993 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7994 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7995 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7996 (@value{GDBP})
7997 @end smallexample
7998
7999 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8000 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8001 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8002
8003 @smallexample
8004 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8005 3
8006 4 #define M 42
8007 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8008 6
8009 7 main ()
8010 8 @{
8011 9 #define N 28
8012 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8013 11 #undef N
8014 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8015 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8016 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8017 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8018 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8019 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8020 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8021 #define Q <
8022 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8023 expands to: (42 + 1)
8024 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8025 expands to: once (M + 1)
8026 (@value{GDBP})
8027 @end smallexample
8028
8029 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
8030 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8031 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8032 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8033
8034 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8035 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8036
8037 @smallexample
8038 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8039 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8040 (@value{GDBP}) run
8041 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8042
8043 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8044 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8045 (@value{GDBP})
8046 @end smallexample
8047
8048 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8049
8050 @smallexample
8051 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8052 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8053 #define N 28
8054 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8055 expands to: 28 < 42
8056 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8057 $1 = 1
8058 (@value{GDBP})
8059 @end smallexample
8060
8061 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8062 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8063 thereof) in force at each point:
8064
8065 @smallexample
8066 (@value{GDBP}) next
8067 Hello, world!
8068 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8069 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8070 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8071 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8072 (@value{GDBP}) next
8073 We're so creative.
8074 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8075 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8076 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8077 #define N 1729
8078 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8079 expands to: 1729 < 42
8080 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8081 $2 = 0
8082 (@value{GDBP})
8083 @end smallexample
8084
8085
8086 @node Tracepoints
8087 @chapter Tracepoints
8088 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8089 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8090
8091 @cindex tracepoints
8092 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8093 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8094 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8095 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8096 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8097 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8098 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8099
8100 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8101 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8102 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8103 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8104 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8105 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8106 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8107 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8108 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8109 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8110 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8111
8112 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8113 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8114 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8115 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8116 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8117 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8118 Packets}.
8119
8120 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8121
8122 @menu
8123 * Set Tracepoints::
8124 * Analyze Collected Data::
8125 * Tracepoint Variables::
8126 @end menu
8127
8128 @node Set Tracepoints
8129 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8130
8131 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8132 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8133 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8134 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8135 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8136 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8137 work on.
8138
8139 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8140 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8141 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8142 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8143 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8144 tracepoint was hit.
8145
8146 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8147 conditions and actions.
8148
8149 @menu
8150 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8151 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8152 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8153 * Tracepoint Actions::
8154 * Listing Tracepoints::
8155 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8156 @end menu
8157
8158 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8159 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8160
8161 @table @code
8162 @cindex set tracepoint
8163 @kindex trace
8164 @item trace
8165 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8166 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8167 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8168 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8169 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8170 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8171 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8172 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8173 running.
8174
8175 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8176
8177 @smallexample
8178 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8179
8180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8181
8182 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8183
8184 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8185
8186 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8187 @end smallexample
8188
8189 @noindent
8190 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8191
8192 @vindex $tpnum
8193 @cindex last tracepoint number
8194 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8195 @cindex tracepoint number
8196 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8197 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8198
8199 @kindex delete tracepoint
8200 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8201 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8202 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8203 default is to delete all tracepoints.
8204
8205 Examples:
8206
8207 @smallexample
8208 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8209
8210 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8211 @end smallexample
8212
8213 @noindent
8214 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8215 @end table
8216
8217 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8218 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8219
8220 @table @code
8221 @kindex disable tracepoint
8222 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8223 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8224 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8225 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8226 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8227
8228 @kindex enable tracepoint
8229 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8230 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8231 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8232 run.
8233 @end table
8234
8235 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8236 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8237
8238 @table @code
8239 @kindex passcount
8240 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8241 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8242 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8243 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8244 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8245 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8246 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8247 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8248 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8249 user.
8250
8251 Examples:
8252
8253 @smallexample
8254 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8255 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8256
8257 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8258 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8259 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8260 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8261 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8262 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8263 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8264 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8265 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8266 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8267 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8268 @end smallexample
8269 @end table
8270
8271 @node Tracepoint Actions
8272 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8273
8274 @table @code
8275 @kindex actions
8276 @cindex tracepoint actions
8277 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8278 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8279 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8280 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8281 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8282 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8283 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8284 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8285 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8286 @code{while-stepping}.
8287
8288 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8289 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8290 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8291
8292 @smallexample
8293 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8294
8295 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8296
8297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8298 @end smallexample
8299
8300 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8301 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8302 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8303 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8304 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8305 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8306 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8307 @code{end} command.
8308
8309 @smallexample
8310 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8311 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8312 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8313 > collect bar,baz
8314 > collect $regs
8315 > while-stepping 12
8316 > collect $fp, $sp
8317 > end
8318 end
8319 @end smallexample
8320
8321 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8322 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8323 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8324 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8325 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8326 special arguments are supported:
8327
8328 @table @code
8329 @item $regs
8330 collect all registers
8331
8332 @item $args
8333 collect all function arguments
8334
8335 @item $locals
8336 collect all local variables.
8337 @end table
8338
8339 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8340 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8341 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8342
8343 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8344 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8345
8346 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8347 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8348 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8349 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8350 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8351 its own @code{end} command):
8352
8353 @smallexample
8354 > while-stepping 12
8355 > collect $regs, myglobal
8356 > end
8357 >
8358 @end smallexample
8359
8360 @noindent
8361 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8362 @code{stepping}.
8363 @end table
8364
8365 @node Listing Tracepoints
8366 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8367
8368 @table @code
8369 @kindex info tracepoints
8370 @kindex info tp
8371 @cindex information about tracepoints
8372 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8373 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8374 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8375 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8376 shown:
8377
8378 @itemize @bullet
8379 @item
8380 its number
8381 @item
8382 whether it is enabled or disabled
8383 @item
8384 its address
8385 @item
8386 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8387 @item
8388 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8389 @item
8390 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8391 @item
8392 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8393 @end itemize
8394
8395 @smallexample
8396 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8397 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8398 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8399 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8400 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8401 (@value{GDBP})
8402 @end smallexample
8403
8404 @noindent
8405 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8406 @end table
8407
8408 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8409 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8410
8411 @table @code
8412 @kindex tstart
8413 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8414 @cindex collected data discarded
8415 @item tstart
8416 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8417 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8418 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8419 experiment.
8420
8421 @kindex tstop
8422 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8423 @item tstop
8424 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8425 stops collecting data.
8426
8427 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8428 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8429 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8430
8431 @kindex tstatus
8432 @cindex status of trace data collection
8433 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8434 @item tstatus
8435 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8436 collection.
8437 @end table
8438
8439 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8440
8441 @smallexample
8442 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8444 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8445 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8446 > while-stepping 11
8447 > collect $regs
8448 > end
8449 > end
8450 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8451 [time passes @dots{}]
8452 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8453 @end smallexample
8454
8455
8456 @node Analyze Collected Data
8457 @section Using the Collected Data
8458
8459 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8460 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8461 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8462 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8463 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8464 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8465 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8466 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8467 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8468 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8469 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8470 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8471 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8472 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8473 the buffer will fail.
8474
8475 @menu
8476 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8477 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8478 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8479 @end menu
8480
8481 @node tfind
8482 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8483
8484 @kindex tfind
8485 @cindex select trace snapshot
8486 @cindex find trace snapshot
8487 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8488 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8489 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8490 snapshot is selected.
8491
8492 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8493
8494 @table @code
8495 @item tfind start
8496 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8497 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8498
8499 @item tfind none
8500 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8501
8502 @item tfind end
8503 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8504
8505 @item tfind
8506 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8507
8508 @item tfind -
8509 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8510 retracing earlier steps.
8511
8512 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8513 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8514 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8515 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8516 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8517
8518 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8519 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8520 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8521 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8522 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8523
8524 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8525 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8526 addresses.
8527
8528 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8529 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8530 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8531
8532 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8533 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8534 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8535 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8536 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8537 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8538 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8539 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8540 @end table
8541
8542 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8543 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8544 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8545 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8546 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8547 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8548 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8549 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8550 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8551 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8552 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8553 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8554 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8555 tracepoint as the current one.
8556
8557 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8558 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8559 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8560 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8561 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8562
8563 @smallexample
8564 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8566 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8567 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8568 > tfind
8569 > end
8570
8571 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8572 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8573 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8574 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8575 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8576 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8577 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8578 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8579 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8580 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8581 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8582 @end smallexample
8583
8584 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8585 the buffer:
8586
8587 @smallexample
8588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8589 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8590 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8591 > tfind line
8592 > end
8593
8594 Frame 0, X = 1
8595 Frame 7, X = 2
8596 Frame 13, X = 255
8597 @end smallexample
8598
8599 @node tdump
8600 @subsection @code{tdump}
8601 @kindex tdump
8602 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8603 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8604
8605 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8606 the current trace snapshot.
8607
8608 @smallexample
8609 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8610 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8611 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8612 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8613 > end
8614
8615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8616
8617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8618 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8619 at gdb_test.c:444
8620 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8621
8622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8623 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8624 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8625 d1 0x18 24
8626 d2 0x80 128
8627 d3 0x33 51
8628 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8629 d5 0x22 34
8630 d6 0xe0 224
8631 d7 0x380035 3670069
8632 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8633 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8634 a2 0x100 256
8635 a3 0x322000 3284992
8636 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8637 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8638 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8639 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8640 ps 0x0 0
8641 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8642 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8643 fpstatus 0x0 0
8644 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8645 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8646 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8647 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8648 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8649 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8650 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8651 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8652 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8653
8654 (@value{GDBP})
8655 @end smallexample
8656
8657 @node save-tracepoints
8658 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8659 @kindex save-tracepoints
8660 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8661
8662 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8663 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8664 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8665 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8666 Files}).
8667
8668 @node Tracepoint Variables
8669 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8670 @cindex tracepoint variables
8671 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8672
8673 @table @code
8674 @vindex $trace_frame
8675 @item (int) $trace_frame
8676 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8677 snapshot is selected.
8678
8679 @vindex $tracepoint
8680 @item (int) $tracepoint
8681 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8682
8683 @vindex $trace_line
8684 @item (int) $trace_line
8685 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8686
8687 @vindex $trace_file
8688 @item (char []) $trace_file
8689 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8690
8691 @vindex $trace_func
8692 @item (char []) $trace_func
8693 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8694 @end table
8695
8696 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8697 use @code{output} instead.
8698
8699 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8700 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8701 data.
8702
8703 @smallexample
8704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8705
8706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8707 > output $trace_file
8708 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8709 > tfind
8710 > end
8711 @end smallexample
8712
8713 @node Overlays
8714 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8715 @cindex overlays
8716
8717 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8718 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8719 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8720 use overlays.
8721
8722 @menu
8723 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8724 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8725 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8726 mapped by asking the inferior.
8727 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8728 @end menu
8729
8730 @node How Overlays Work
8731 @section How Overlays Work
8732 @cindex mapped overlays
8733 @cindex unmapped overlays
8734 @cindex load address, overlay's
8735 @cindex mapped address
8736 @cindex overlay area
8737
8738 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8739 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8740 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8741 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8742 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8743
8744 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8745 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8746 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8747 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8748 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8749 largest overlay as well.
8750
8751 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8752 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8753 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8754 there.
8755
8756 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8757 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8758 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8759
8760 @smallexample
8761 @group
8762 Data Instruction Larger
8763 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8764 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8765 | | | | | |
8766 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8767 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8768 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8769 | and heap | | | | | |
8770 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8771 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8772 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8773 | | | | | |
8774 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8775 address | | | | | |
8776 | overlay | <-' | | |
8777 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8778 | | <---. | | load address
8779 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8780 | | | |
8781 +-----------+ | |
8782 +-----------+
8783 | |
8784 +-----------+
8785
8786 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8787 @end group
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8791 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8792 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8793 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8794 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8795 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8796 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8797 program and the overlay area.
8798
8799 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8800 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8801 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8802 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8803 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8804 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8805 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8806
8807 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8808 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8809 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8810
8811 @itemize @bullet
8812
8813 @item
8814 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8815 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8816 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8817 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8818
8819 @item
8820 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8821 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8822 your program's performance.
8823
8824 @item
8825 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8826 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8827 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8828 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8829 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8830 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8831 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8832
8833 @item
8834 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8835 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8836 instruction and data spaces.
8837
8838 @end itemize
8839
8840 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8841 improved in many ways:
8842
8843 @itemize @bullet
8844
8845 @item
8846 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8847 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8848 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8849 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8850 area in the usual way.
8851
8852 @item
8853 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8854 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8855
8856 @item
8857 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8858 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8859 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8860 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8861 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8862 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8863 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8864
8865 @end itemize
8866
8867
8868 @node Overlay Commands
8869 @section Overlay Commands
8870
8871 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8872 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8873 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8874 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8875 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8876 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8877
8878 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8879 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8880
8881 @table @code
8882 @item overlay off
8883 @kindex overlay
8884 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8885 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8886 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8887 overlay support is disabled.
8888
8889 @item overlay manual
8890 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8891 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8892 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8893 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8894 commands described below.
8895
8896 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8897 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8898 @cindex map an overlay
8899 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8900 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8901 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8902 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8903 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8904 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8905
8906 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8907 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8908 @cindex unmap an overlay
8909 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8910 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8911 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8912 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8913
8914 @item overlay auto
8915 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8916 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8917 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8918 Overlay Debugging}.
8919
8920 @item overlay load-target
8921 @itemx overlay load
8922 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8923 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8924 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8925 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8926 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8927 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8928
8929 @item overlay list-overlays
8930 @itemx overlay list
8931 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8932 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8933 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8934
8935 @end table
8936
8937 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8938 of the function the address falls in:
8939
8940 @smallexample
8941 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8942 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8943 @end smallexample
8944 @noindent
8945 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8946 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8947 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8948 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8949
8950 @smallexample
8951 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8952 No sections are mapped.
8953 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8954 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8955 @end smallexample
8956 @noindent
8957 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8958 name normally:
8959
8960 @smallexample
8961 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8962 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8963 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8964 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8965 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8966 @end smallexample
8967
8968 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8969 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8970 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8971 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8972 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8973
8974 @itemize @bullet
8975 @item
8976 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8977 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8978 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8979 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8980 @item
8981 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8982 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8983 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8984 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8985 breakpoints properly.
8986 @end itemize
8987
8988
8989 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8990 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8991 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8992
8993 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8994 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8995 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8996 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8997 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8998 current state of the overlays.
8999
9000 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9001 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9002
9003 @table @asis
9004
9005 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9006 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9007
9008 @smallexample
9009 struct
9010 @{
9011 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9012 unsigned long vma;
9013
9014 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9015 unsigned long size;
9016
9017 /* The overlay's load address. */
9018 unsigned long lma;
9019
9020 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9021 zero otherwise. */
9022 unsigned long mapped;
9023 @}
9024 @end smallexample
9025
9026 @item @code{_novlys}:
9027 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9028 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9029
9030 @end table
9031
9032 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9033 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9034 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9035 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9036 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9037 currently mapped.
9038
9039 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9040 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9041 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9042 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9043 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9044 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9045 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9046 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9047 are not being executed.
9048
9049 @node Overlay Sample Program
9050 @section Overlay Sample Program
9051 @cindex overlay example program
9052
9053 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9054 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9055 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9056 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9057 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9058 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9059 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9060
9061 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9062 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9063 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9064 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9065
9066 @table @file
9067 @item overlays.c
9068 The main program file.
9069 @item ovlymgr.c
9070 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9071 @item foo.c
9072 @itemx bar.c
9073 @itemx baz.c
9074 @itemx grbx.c
9075 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9076 @item d10v.ld
9077 @itemx m32r.ld
9078 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9079 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9080 @end table
9081
9082 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9083 cross-compiler like this:
9084
9085 @smallexample
9086 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9087 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9088 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9089 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9090 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9091 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9092 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9093 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9094 @end smallexample
9095
9096 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9097 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9098 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9099
9100
9101 @node Languages
9102 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9103 @cindex languages
9104
9105 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9106 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9107 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9108 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9109 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9110 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9111
9112 @cindex working language
9113 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9114 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9115 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9116 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9117 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9118 language}.
9119
9120 @menu
9121 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9122 * Show:: Displaying the language
9123 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9124 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9125 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9126 @end menu
9127
9128 @node Setting
9129 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9130
9131 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9132 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9133 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9134 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9135 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9136 are printed, etc.
9137
9138 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9139 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9140 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9141 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9142 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9143 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9144 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9145 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9146 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9147 Displaying the Language}.
9148
9149 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9150 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9151 another language. In that case, make the
9152 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9153 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9154 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9155
9156 @menu
9157 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9158 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9159 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9160 @end menu
9161
9162 @node Filenames
9163 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9164
9165 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9166 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9167
9168 @table @file
9169 @item .ada
9170 @itemx .ads
9171 @itemx .adb
9172 @itemx .a
9173 Ada source file.
9174
9175 @item .c
9176 C source file
9177
9178 @item .C
9179 @itemx .cc
9180 @itemx .cp
9181 @itemx .cpp
9182 @itemx .cxx
9183 @itemx .c++
9184 C@t{++} source file
9185
9186 @item .m
9187 Objective-C source file
9188
9189 @item .f
9190 @itemx .F
9191 Fortran source file
9192
9193 @item .mod
9194 Modula-2 source file
9195
9196 @item .s
9197 @itemx .S
9198 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9199 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9200 @end table
9201
9202 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9203 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9204
9205 @node Manually
9206 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9207
9208 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9209 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9210 your program.
9211
9212 @kindex set language
9213 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9214 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9215 a language, such as
9216 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9217 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9218
9219 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9220 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9221 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9222 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9223 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9224 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9225 command such as:
9226
9227 @smallexample
9228 print a = b + c
9229 @end smallexample
9230
9231 @noindent
9232 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9233 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9234 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9235 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9236
9237 @node Automatically
9238 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9239
9240 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9241 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9242 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9243 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9244 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9245 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9246 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9247 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9248 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9249
9250 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9251 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9252 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9253 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9254 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9255
9256 @node Show
9257 @section Displaying the Language
9258
9259 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9260 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9261
9262 @table @code
9263 @item show language
9264 @kindex show language
9265 Display the current working language. This is the
9266 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9267 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9268
9269 @item info frame
9270 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9271 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9272 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9273 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9274 information listed here.
9275
9276 @item info source
9277 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9278 Display the source language of this source file.
9279 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9280 information listed here.
9281 @end table
9282
9283 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9284 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9285 with a language explicitly:
9286
9287 @table @code
9288 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9289 @kindex set extension-language
9290 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9291 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9292
9293 @item info extensions
9294 @kindex info extensions
9295 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9296 @end table
9297
9298 @node Checks
9299 @section Type and Range Checking
9300
9301 @quotation
9302 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9303 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9304 section documents the intended facilities.
9305 @end quotation
9306 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9307
9308 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9309 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9310 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9311 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9312 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9313 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9314 errors when your program is running.
9315
9316 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9317 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9318 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9319 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9320 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9321 automatically based on your program's source language.
9322 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9323 settings of supported languages.
9324
9325 @menu
9326 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9327 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9328 @end menu
9329
9330 @cindex type checking
9331 @cindex checks, type
9332 @node Type Checking
9333 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9334
9335 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9336 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9337 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9338 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9339
9340 @smallexample
9341 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9342 @exdent but
9343 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9344 @end smallexample
9345
9346 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9347 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9348
9349 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9350 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9351 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9352 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9353 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9354 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9355 also issues a warning.
9356
9357 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9358 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9359 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9360 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9361 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9362 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9363
9364 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9365 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9366 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9367 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9368 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9369 details on specific languages.
9370
9371 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9372
9373 @kindex set check type
9374 @kindex show check type
9375 @table @code
9376 @item set check type auto
9377 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9378 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9379 each language.
9380
9381 @item set check type on
9382 @itemx set check type off
9383 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9384 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9385 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9386 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9387 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9388
9389 @item set check type warn
9390 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9391 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9392 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9393 numbers and structures.
9394
9395 @item show type
9396 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9397 is setting it automatically.
9398 @end table
9399
9400 @cindex range checking
9401 @cindex checks, range
9402 @node Range Checking
9403 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9404
9405 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9406 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9407 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9408 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9409 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9410
9411 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9412 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9413 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9414 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9415
9416 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9417 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9418 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9419 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9420 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9421 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9422
9423 @smallexample
9424 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9425 @end smallexample
9426
9427 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9428 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9429 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9430
9431 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9432
9433 @kindex set check range
9434 @kindex show check range
9435 @table @code
9436 @item set check range auto
9437 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9438 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9439 each language.
9440
9441 @item set check range on
9442 @itemx set check range off
9443 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9444 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9445 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9446 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9447
9448 @item set check range warn
9449 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9450 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9451 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9452 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9453 systems).
9454
9455 @item show range
9456 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9457 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9458 @end table
9459
9460 @node Supported Languages
9461 @section Supported Languages
9462
9463 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9464 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9465 @c This is false ...
9466 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9467 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9468 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9469 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9470 language.
9471
9472 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9473 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9474 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9475 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9476 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9477 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9478 language reference or tutorial.
9479
9480 @menu
9481 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9482 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9483 * Fortran:: Fortran
9484 * Pascal:: Pascal
9485 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9486 * Ada:: Ada
9487 @end menu
9488
9489 @node C
9490 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9491
9492 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9493 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9494
9495 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9496 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9497 together.
9498
9499 @cindex C@t{++}
9500 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9501 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9502 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9503 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9504 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9505 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9506 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9507
9508 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9509 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9510 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9511 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9512 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9513 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9514
9515 @menu
9516 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9517 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9518 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9519 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9520 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9521 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9522 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9523 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9524 @end menu
9525
9526 @node C Operators
9527 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9528
9529 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9530
9531 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9532 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9533 often defined on groups of types.
9534
9535 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9536
9537 @itemize @bullet
9538
9539 @item
9540 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9541 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9542
9543 @item
9544 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9545 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9546
9547 @item
9548 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9549
9550 @item
9551 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9552
9553 @end itemize
9554
9555 @noindent
9556 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9557 in order of increasing precedence:
9558
9559 @table @code
9560 @item ,
9561 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9562 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9563 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9564
9565 @item =
9566 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9567 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9568
9569 @item @var{op}=
9570 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9571 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9572 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9573 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9574 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9575
9576 @item ?:
9577 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9578 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9579 integral type.
9580
9581 @item ||
9582 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9583
9584 @item &&
9585 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9586
9587 @item |
9588 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9589
9590 @item ^
9591 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9592
9593 @item &
9594 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9595
9596 @item ==@r{, }!=
9597 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9598 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9599
9600 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9601 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9602 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9603 and non-zero for true.
9604
9605 @item <<@r{, }>>
9606 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9607
9608 @item @@
9609 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9610
9611 @item +@r{, }-
9612 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9613 pointer types.
9614
9615 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9616 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9617 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9618 integral types.
9619
9620 @item ++@r{, }--
9621 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9622 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9623 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9624 operation takes place.
9625
9626 @item *
9627 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9628 @code{++}.
9629
9630 @item &
9631 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9632
9633 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9634 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9635 to examine the address
9636 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9637 stored.
9638
9639 @item -
9640 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9641 precedence as @code{++}.
9642
9643 @item !
9644 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9645 @code{++}.
9646
9647 @item ~
9648 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9649 @code{++}.
9650
9651
9652 @item .@r{, }->
9653 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9654 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9655 pointer based on the stored type information.
9656 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9657
9658 @item .*@r{, }->*
9659 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9660
9661 @item []
9662 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9663 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9664
9665 @item ()
9666 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9667
9668 @item ::
9669 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9670 and @code{class} types.
9671
9672 @item ::
9673 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9674 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9675 above.
9676 @end table
9677
9678 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9679 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9680 predefined meaning.
9681
9682 @node C Constants
9683 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9684
9685 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9686
9687 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9688 following ways:
9689
9690 @itemize @bullet
9691 @item
9692 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9693 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9694 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9695 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9696 @code{long} value.
9697
9698 @item
9699 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9700 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9701 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9702 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9703 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9704 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9705 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9706 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9707 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9708 constant.
9709
9710 @item
9711 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9712 integral equivalents.
9713
9714 @item
9715 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9716 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9717 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9718 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9719 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9720 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9721 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9722 @samp{\n} for newline.
9723
9724 @item
9725 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9726 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9727 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9728 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9729 characters.
9730
9731 @item
9732 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9733 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9734
9735 @item
9736 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9737 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9738 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9739 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9740 @end itemize
9741
9742 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9743 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9744
9745 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9746 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9747
9748 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9749 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9750 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9751 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9752 @quotation
9753 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9754 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9755 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9756 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9757 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9758 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9759 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9760 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9761 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9762 C@t{++} code.
9763 @end quotation
9764
9765 @enumerate
9766
9767 @cindex member functions
9768 @item
9769 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9770
9771 @smallexample
9772 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9773 @end smallexample
9774
9775 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9776 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9777 @item
9778 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9779 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9780 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9781 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9782
9783 @cindex call overloaded functions
9784 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9785 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9786 @item
9787 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9788 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9789 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9790 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9791 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9792 default arguments.
9793
9794 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9795 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9796 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9797 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9798 number of function arguments.
9799
9800 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9801 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9802 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9803
9804 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9805 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9806 @smallexample
9807 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9808 @end smallexample
9809
9810 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9811 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9812
9813 @cindex reference declarations
9814 @item
9815 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9816 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9817 dereferenced.
9818
9819 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9820 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9821 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9822 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9823 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9824
9825 @item
9826 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9827 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9828 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9829 necessary, for example in an expression like
9830 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9831 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9832 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9833 @end enumerate
9834
9835 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9836 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9837 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9838 invoking user-defined operators.
9839
9840 @node C Defaults
9841 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9842
9843 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9844
9845 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9846 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9847 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9848 selects the working language.
9849
9850 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9851 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9852 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9853 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9854 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9855 for further details.
9856
9857 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9858 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9859 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9860
9861 @node C Checks
9862 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9863
9864 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9865
9866 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9867 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9868 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9869
9870 @itemize @bullet
9871 @item
9872 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9873 enumerated tag.
9874
9875 @item
9876 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9877 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9878
9879 @ignore
9880 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9881 @c FIXME--beers?
9882 @item
9883 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9884 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9885 compilers.)
9886 @end ignore
9887 @end itemize
9888
9889 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9890 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9891 that is not itself an array.
9892
9893 @node Debugging C
9894 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9895
9896 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9897 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9898 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9899 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9900
9901 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9902 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9903 ,Expressions}.
9904
9905 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9906 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9907
9908 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9909
9910 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9911 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9912
9913 @table @code
9914 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9915 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9916 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9917 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
9918 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
9919 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
9920
9921 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9922 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9923 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9924 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9925 classes.
9926 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9927
9928 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9929 @item catch throw
9930 @itemx catch catch
9931 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9932 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9933
9934 @cindex inheritance
9935 @item ptype @var{typename}
9936 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9937 @var{typename}.
9938 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9939
9940 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9941 @item set print demangle
9942 @itemx show print demangle
9943 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9944 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9945 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9946 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9947 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9948
9949 @item set print object
9950 @itemx show print object
9951 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9952 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9953
9954 @item set print vtbl
9955 @itemx show print vtbl
9956 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9957 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9958 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9959 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9960
9961 @kindex set overload-resolution
9962 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9963 @item set overload-resolution on
9964 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9965 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9966 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9967 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9968 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9969 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9970
9971 @item set overload-resolution off
9972 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9973 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9974 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9975 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9976 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9977 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9978 argument types.
9979
9980 @kindex show overload-resolution
9981 @item show overload-resolution
9982 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9983
9984 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9985 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9986 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9987 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9988 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9989 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9990 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9991 @end table
9992
9993 @node Decimal Floating Point
9994 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9995 @cindex decimal floating point format
9996
9997 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9998 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9999 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10000 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10001
10002 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10003 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10004 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10005 target.
10006
10007 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10008 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10009 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10010
10011 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10012 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10013 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10014
10015 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10016 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10017 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10018
10019 @node Objective-C
10020 @subsection Objective-C
10021
10022 @cindex Objective-C
10023 This section provides information about some commands and command
10024 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10025 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10026 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10027
10028 @menu
10029 * Method Names in Commands::
10030 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10031 @end menu
10032
10033 @node Method Names in Commands
10034 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10035
10036 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10037 names as line specifications:
10038
10039 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10040 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10041 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10042 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10043 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10044 @itemize
10045 @item @code{clear}
10046 @item @code{break}
10047 @item @code{info line}
10048 @item @code{jump}
10049 @item @code{list}
10050 @end itemize
10051
10052 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10053
10054 @smallexample
10055 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10056 @end smallexample
10057
10058 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10059 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10060 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10061 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10062 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10063 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10064 debugged, enter:
10065
10066 @smallexample
10067 break -[Fruit create]
10068 @end smallexample
10069
10070 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10071 enter:
10072
10073 @smallexample
10074 list +[NSText initialize]
10075 @end smallexample
10076
10077 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10078 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10079 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10080 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10081
10082 @smallexample
10083 break create
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10087 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10088 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10089 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10090 none apply.
10091
10092 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10093 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10094
10095 @smallexample
10096 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10097 @end smallexample
10098
10099 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10100 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10101 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10102 @kindex print-object
10103 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10104
10105 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10106
10107 @smallexample
10108 print -[@var{object} hash]
10109 @end smallexample
10110
10111 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10112 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10113 @noindent
10114 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10115 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10116 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10117 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10118 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10119 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10120
10121 @node Fortran
10122 @subsection Fortran
10123 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10124
10125 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10126 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10127
10128 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10129 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10130 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10131 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10132 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10133 underscore.
10134
10135 @menu
10136 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10137 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10138 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10139 @end menu
10140
10141 @node Fortran Operators
10142 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10143
10144 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10145
10146 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10147 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10148 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10149
10150 @table @code
10151 @item **
10152 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10153 of the second one.
10154
10155 @item :
10156 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10157 represent a section of array.
10158
10159 @item %
10160 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10161 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10162 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10163 union type.
10164 @end table
10165
10166 @node Fortran Defaults
10167 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10168
10169 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10170
10171 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10172 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10173 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10174 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10175
10176 @node Special Fortran Commands
10177 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10178
10179 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10180
10181 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10182 such as displaying common blocks.
10183
10184 @table @code
10185 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10186 @kindex info common
10187 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10188 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10189 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10190 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10191 printed.
10192 @end table
10193
10194 @node Pascal
10195 @subsection Pascal
10196
10197 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10198 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10199 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10200 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10201 syntax.
10202
10203 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10204 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10205 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10206
10207 @node Modula-2
10208 @subsection Modula-2
10209
10210 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10211
10212 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10213 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10214 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10215 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10216 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10217 table.
10218
10219 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10220 @menu
10221 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10222 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10223 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10224 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10225 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10226 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10227 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10228 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10229 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10230 @end menu
10231
10232 @node M2 Operators
10233 @subsubsection Operators
10234 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10235
10236 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10237 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10238 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10239 following definitions hold:
10240
10241 @itemize @bullet
10242
10243 @item
10244 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10245 their subranges.
10246
10247 @item
10248 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10249
10250 @item
10251 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10252
10253 @item
10254 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10255 @var{type}}.
10256
10257 @item
10258 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10259
10260 @item
10261 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10262
10263 @item
10264 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10265 @end itemize
10266
10267 @noindent
10268 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10269 increasing precedence:
10270
10271 @table @code
10272 @item ,
10273 Function argument or array index separator.
10274
10275 @item :=
10276 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10277 @var{value}.
10278
10279 @item <@r{, }>
10280 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10281 types.
10282
10283 @item <=@r{, }>=
10284 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10285 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10286 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10287
10288 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10289 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10290 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10291 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10292 comment character.
10293
10294 @item IN
10295 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10296 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10297
10298 @item OR
10299 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10300
10301 @item AND@r{, }&
10302 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10303
10304 @item @@
10305 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10306
10307 @item +@r{, }-
10308 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10309 and difference on set types.
10310
10311 @item *
10312 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10313 on set types.
10314
10315 @item /
10316 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10317 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10318
10319 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10320 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10321 precedence as @code{*}.
10322
10323 @item -
10324 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10325
10326 @item ^
10327 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10328
10329 @item NOT
10330 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10331 @code{^}.
10332
10333 @item .
10334 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10335 precedence as @code{^}.
10336
10337 @item []
10338 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10339
10340 @item ()
10341 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10342 as @code{^}.
10343
10344 @item ::@r{, }.
10345 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10346 @end table
10347
10348 @quotation
10349 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10350 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10351 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10352 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10353 @end quotation
10354
10355
10356 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10357 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10358 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10359
10360 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10361 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10362
10363 @table @var
10364
10365 @item a
10366 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10367
10368 @item c
10369 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10370
10371 @item i
10372 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10373
10374 @item m
10375 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10376 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10377 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10378
10379 @item n
10380 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10381
10382 @item r
10383 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10384
10385 @item t
10386 represents a type.
10387
10388 @item v
10389 represents a variable.
10390
10391 @item x
10392 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10393 explanation of the function for details.
10394 @end table
10395
10396 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10397
10398 @table @code
10399 @item ABS(@var{n})
10400 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10401
10402 @item CAP(@var{c})
10403 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10404 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10405
10406 @item CHR(@var{i})
10407 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10408
10409 @item DEC(@var{v})
10410 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10411
10412 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10413 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10414 new value.
10415
10416 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10417 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10418 set.
10419
10420 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10421 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10422
10423 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10424 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10425
10426 @item INC(@var{v})
10427 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10428
10429 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10430 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10431 new value.
10432
10433 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10434 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10435 there. Returns the new set.
10436
10437 @item MAX(@var{t})
10438 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10439
10440 @item MIN(@var{t})
10441 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10442
10443 @item ODD(@var{i})
10444 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10445
10446 @item ORD(@var{x})
10447 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10448 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10449 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10450 integral, character and enumerated types.
10451
10452 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10453 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10454
10455 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10456 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10457
10458 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10459 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10460
10461 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10462 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10463 @end table
10464
10465 @quotation
10466 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10467 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10468 an error.
10469 @end quotation
10470
10471 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10472 @node M2 Constants
10473 @subsubsection Constants
10474
10475 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10476 ways:
10477
10478 @itemize @bullet
10479
10480 @item
10481 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10482 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10483 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10484 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10485
10486 @item
10487 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10488 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10489 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10490 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10491 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10492 digits.
10493
10494 @item
10495 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10496 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10497 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10498 followed by a @samp{C}.
10499
10500 @item
10501 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10502 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10503 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10504 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10505 sequences.
10506
10507 @item
10508 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10509
10510 @item
10511 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10512 @code{FALSE}.
10513
10514 @item
10515 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10516
10517 @item
10518 Set constants are not yet supported.
10519 @end itemize
10520
10521 @node M2 Types
10522 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10523 @cindex Modula-2 types
10524
10525 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10526 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10527 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10528 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10529 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10530 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10531
10532 The first example contains the following section of code:
10533
10534 @smallexample
10535 VAR
10536 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10537 r: [20..40] ;
10538 @end smallexample
10539
10540 @noindent
10541 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10542 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10543
10544 @smallexample
10545 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10546 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10547 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10548 SET OF CHAR
10549 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10550 21
10551 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10552 [20..40]
10553 @end smallexample
10554
10555 @noindent
10556 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10557
10558 @smallexample
10559 VAR
10560 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10561 @end smallexample
10562
10563 @noindent
10564 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10565
10566 @smallexample
10567 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10568 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10569 @end smallexample
10570
10571 @noindent
10572 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10573 expressions using the debugger.
10574
10575 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10576 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10577
10578 @smallexample
10579 VAR
10580 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10581 @end smallexample
10582
10583 @smallexample
10584 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10585 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10586 @end smallexample
10587
10588 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10589 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10590 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10591 above.
10592
10593 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10594
10595 @smallexample
10596 TYPE
10597 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10598 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10599 VAR
10600 s: t ;
10601 BEGIN
10602 s := blue ;
10603 @end smallexample
10604
10605 @noindent
10606 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10607 and value of a variable.
10608
10609 @smallexample
10610 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10611 $1 = blue
10612 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10613 type = [blue..yellow]
10614 @end smallexample
10615
10616 @noindent
10617 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10618 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10619 their @code{C} counterparts.
10620
10621 @smallexample
10622 VAR
10623 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10624 BEGIN
10625 s[1] := 1 ;
10626 @end smallexample
10627
10628 @smallexample
10629 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10630 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10631 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10632 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10633 @end smallexample
10634
10635 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10636 pointer types as shown in this example:
10637
10638 @smallexample
10639 VAR
10640 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10641 BEGIN
10642 NEW(s) ;
10643 s^[1] := 1 ;
10644 @end smallexample
10645
10646 @noindent
10647 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10648
10649 @smallexample
10650 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10651 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10652 @end smallexample
10653
10654 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10655 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10656 types:
10657
10658 @smallexample
10659 TYPE
10660 foo = RECORD
10661 f1: CARDINAL ;
10662 f2: CHAR ;
10663 f3: myarray ;
10664 END ;
10665
10666 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10667 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10668 VAR
10669 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10670 @end smallexample
10671
10672 @noindent
10673 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10674 below.
10675
10676 @smallexample
10677 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10678 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10679 f1 : CARDINAL;
10680 f2 : CHAR;
10681 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10682 END
10683 @end smallexample
10684
10685 @node M2 Defaults
10686 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10687 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10688
10689 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10690 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10691 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10692 selected the working language.
10693
10694 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10695 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10696 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10697 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10698
10699 @node Deviations
10700 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10701 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10702
10703 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10704 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10705
10706 @itemize @bullet
10707 @item
10708 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10709 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10710 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10711 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10712 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10713 returned a pointer.)
10714
10715 @item
10716 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10717 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10718 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10719 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10720
10721 @item
10722 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10723 argument.
10724
10725 @item
10726 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10727 @end itemize
10728
10729 @node M2 Checks
10730 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10731 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10732
10733 @quotation
10734 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10735 range checking.
10736 @end quotation
10737 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10738
10739 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10740
10741 @itemize @bullet
10742 @item
10743 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10744 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10745
10746 @item
10747 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10748 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10749 @end itemize
10750
10751 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10752 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10753
10754 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10755 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10756
10757 @node M2 Scope
10758 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10759 @cindex scope
10760 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10761 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10762 @ifinfo
10763 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10764 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10765 @end ifinfo
10766 @iftex
10767 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10768 @end iftex
10769
10770 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10771 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10772 similar syntax:
10773
10774 @smallexample
10775
10776 @var{module} . @var{id}
10777 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10778 @end smallexample
10779
10780 @noindent
10781 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10782 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10783 identifier within your program, except another module.
10784
10785 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10786 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10787 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10788 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10789
10790 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10791 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10792 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10793 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10794 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10795 @var{module}.
10796
10797 @node GDB/M2
10798 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10799
10800 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10801 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10802 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10803 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10804 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10805 analogue in Modula-2.
10806
10807 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10808 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10809 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10810 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10811 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10812 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10813
10814 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10815 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10816 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10817
10818 @node Ada
10819 @subsection Ada
10820 @cindex Ada
10821
10822 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10823 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10824 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10825 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10826 to be difficult.
10827
10828
10829 @cindex expressions in Ada
10830 @menu
10831 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10832 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10833 in @value{GDBN}.
10834 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10835 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10836 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10837 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10838 @end menu
10839
10840 @node Ada Mode Intro
10841 @subsubsection Introduction
10842 @cindex Ada mode, general
10843
10844 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10845 syntax, with some extensions.
10846 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10847
10848 @itemize @bullet
10849 @item
10850 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10851 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10852 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10853 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10854
10855 @item
10856 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10857 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10858
10859 @item
10860 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10861 @end itemize
10862
10863 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10864 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10865 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10866 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10867 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10868
10869 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10870 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10871 was translated from an Ada source file.
10872
10873 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10874 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10875 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10876 middle (to allow based literals).
10877
10878 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10879 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10880 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10881 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10882 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10883 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10884
10885 @node Omissions from Ada
10886 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10887 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10888
10889 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10890
10891 @itemize @bullet
10892 @item
10893 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10894
10895 @itemize @minus
10896 @item
10897 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10898 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10899
10900 @item
10901 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10902
10903 @item
10904 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10905
10906 @item
10907 @t{'Tag}.
10908
10909 @item
10910 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10911 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10912
10913 @item
10914 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10915 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10916
10917 @item
10918 @t{'Address}.
10919 @end itemize
10920
10921 @item
10922 The names in
10923 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10924 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10925 not currently available.
10926
10927 @item
10928 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10929 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10930 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10931 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10932 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10933 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10934 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10935 indeterminate values.
10936
10937 @item
10938 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10939 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10940 are not implemented.
10941
10942 @item
10943 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10944 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10945 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10946 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10947 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10948
10949 @smallexample
10950 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10951 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10952 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10953 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10954 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10955 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10956 @end smallexample
10957
10958 Changing a
10959 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10960 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10961 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10962 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10963 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10964 declared to have a type such as:
10965
10966 @smallexample
10967 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10968 Id : Integer;
10969 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10970 end record;
10971 @end smallexample
10972
10973 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10974 assignments:
10975
10976 @smallexample
10977 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10978 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10979 @end smallexample
10980
10981 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10982 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10983 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10984 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10985 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10986 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10987 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10988 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10989
10990 @item
10991 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10992
10993 @item
10994 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10995 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10996 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10997 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10998 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10999 the proper resolution.
11000
11001 @item
11002 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11003
11004 @item
11005 Entry calls are not implemented.
11006
11007 @item
11008 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11009 formats are not supported.
11010
11011 @item
11012 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11013 @end itemize
11014
11015 @node Additions to Ada
11016 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11017 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11018
11019 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11020 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11021
11022 @itemize @bullet
11023 @item
11024 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11025 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11026 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11027 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11028 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11029 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11030 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11031 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11032
11033 @item
11034 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11035 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11036 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11037
11038 @item
11039 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11040 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11041
11042 @item
11043 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11044 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11045 @end itemize
11046
11047 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11048 additions specific to Ada:
11049
11050 @itemize @bullet
11051 @item
11052 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11053 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11054
11055 @smallexample
11056 set x := y + 3
11057 print A(tmp := y + 1)
11058 @end smallexample
11059
11060 @item
11061 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11062 the value of its right-hand operand.
11063 This allows, for example,
11064 complex conditional breaks:
11065
11066 @smallexample
11067 break f
11068 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11069 @end smallexample
11070
11071 @item
11072 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11073 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11074 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11075 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11076 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11077 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11078 in strings. For example,
11079 @smallexample
11080 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11081 @end smallexample
11082 @noindent
11083 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11084 after each period.
11085
11086 @item
11087 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11088 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11089 to write
11090
11091 @smallexample
11092 print 'max(x, y)
11093 @end smallexample
11094
11095 @item
11096 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11097 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11098 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11099 of 3 might print as
11100
11101 @smallexample
11102 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11103 @end smallexample
11104
11105 @noindent
11106 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11107 clause.
11108
11109 @item
11110 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11111 multi-character subsequence of
11112 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11113 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11114 in place of @t{a'length}.
11115
11116 @item
11117 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11118 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11119 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11120 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11121 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11122 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11123 For example,
11124 @smallexample
11125 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11126 @end smallexample
11127
11128 @item
11129 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11130 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11131 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11132 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11133 object.
11134
11135 @end itemize
11136
11137 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11138 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11139
11140 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11141 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11142 before reaching the main procedure.
11143 As defined in the Ada Reference
11144 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11145 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11146 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11147 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11148
11149 @node Ada Glitches
11150 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11151 @cindex Ada, problems
11152
11153 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11154 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11155 @value{GDBN},
11156 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11157 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11158
11159 @itemize @bullet
11160 @item
11161 Currently, the debugger
11162 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11163 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11164 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11165 to get it printed properly.
11166
11167 @item
11168 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11169 storage are invisible to the debugger.
11170
11171 @item
11172 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11173 argument lists are treated as positional).
11174
11175 @item
11176 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11177
11178 @item
11179 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11180 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11181 the host machine.
11182
11183 @item
11184 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
11185
11186 @item
11187 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11188 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11189 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11190 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11191 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11192 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11193 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11194 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11195 you can usually resolve the confusion
11196 by qualifying the problematic names with package
11197 @code{Standard} explicitly.
11198 @end itemize
11199
11200 @node Unsupported Languages
11201 @section Unsupported Languages
11202
11203 @cindex unsupported languages
11204 @cindex minimal language
11205 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11206 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11207 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11208 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11209 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11210 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11211
11212 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11213 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11214 language.
11215
11216 @node Symbols
11217 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11218
11219 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11220 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11221 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11222 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11223 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11224 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11225 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11226
11227 @cindex symbol names
11228 @cindex names of symbols
11229 @cindex quoting names
11230 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11231 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11232 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11233 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11234 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11235 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11236 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11237 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11238
11239 @smallexample
11240 p 'foo.c'::x
11241 @end smallexample
11242
11243 @noindent
11244 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11245
11246 @table @code
11247 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11248 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11249 @kindex set case-sensitive
11250 @item set case-sensitive on
11251 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11252 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11253 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11254 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11255 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11256 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11257 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11258 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11259 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11260 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11261 case-insensitive matches.
11262
11263 @kindex show case-sensitive
11264 @item show case-sensitive
11265 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11266 lookups.
11267
11268 @kindex info address
11269 @cindex address of a symbol
11270 @item info address @var{symbol}
11271 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11272 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11273 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11274 is always stored.
11275
11276 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11277 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11278 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11279
11280 @kindex info symbol
11281 @cindex symbol from address
11282 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11283 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11284 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11285 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11286 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11287
11288 @smallexample
11289 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11290 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11291 @end smallexample
11292
11293 @noindent
11294 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11295 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11296
11297 @kindex whatis
11298 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11299 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11300 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11301 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11302 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11303 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11304 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11305 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11306 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11307 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11308 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11309
11310 @kindex ptype
11311 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11312 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11313 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11314 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11315
11316 For example, for this variable declaration:
11317
11318 @smallexample
11319 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11320 @end smallexample
11321
11322 @noindent
11323 the two commands give this output:
11324
11325 @smallexample
11326 @group
11327 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11328 type = struct complex
11329 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11330 type = struct complex @{
11331 double real;
11332 double imag;
11333 @}
11334 @end group
11335 @end smallexample
11336
11337 @noindent
11338 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11339 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11340
11341 @cindex incomplete type
11342 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11343 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11344 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11345 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11346 given these declarations:
11347
11348 @smallexample
11349 struct foo;
11350 struct foo *fooptr;
11351 @end smallexample
11352
11353 @noindent
11354 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11355
11356 @smallexample
11357 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11358 $1 = <incomplete type>
11359 @end smallexample
11360
11361 @noindent
11362 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11363 completely specified.
11364
11365 @kindex info types
11366 @item info types @var{regexp}
11367 @itemx info types
11368 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11369 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11370 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11371 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11372 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11373 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11374 name is @code{value}.
11375
11376 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11377 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11378 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11379
11380 @kindex info scope
11381 @cindex local variables
11382 @item info scope @var{location}
11383 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11384 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11385 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11386 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11387 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11388
11389 @smallexample
11390 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11391 Scope for command_line_handler:
11392 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11393 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11394 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11395 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11396 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11397 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11398 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11399 @end smallexample
11400
11401 @noindent
11402 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11403 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11404 collect}.
11405
11406 @kindex info source
11407 @item info source
11408 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11409 the function containing the current point of execution:
11410 @itemize @bullet
11411 @item
11412 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11413 @item
11414 the directory it was compiled in,
11415 @item
11416 its length, in lines,
11417 @item
11418 which programming language it is written in,
11419 @item
11420 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11421 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11422 @item
11423 whether the debugging information includes information about
11424 preprocessor macros.
11425 @end itemize
11426
11427
11428 @kindex info sources
11429 @item info sources
11430 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11431 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11432 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11433
11434 @kindex info functions
11435 @item info functions
11436 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11437
11438 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11439 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11440 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11441 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11442 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11443 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11444 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11445 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11446
11447 @kindex info variables
11448 @item info variables
11449 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11450 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11451
11452 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11453 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11454 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11455 @var{regexp}.
11456
11457 @kindex info classes
11458 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11459 @item info classes
11460 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11461 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11462 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11463 expression.
11464
11465 @kindex info selectors
11466 @item info selectors
11467 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11468 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11469 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11470 expression.
11471
11472 @ignore
11473 This was never implemented.
11474 @kindex info methods
11475 @item info methods
11476 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11477 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11478 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11479 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11480 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11481 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11482 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11483 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11484 @end ignore
11485
11486 @cindex reloading symbols
11487 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11488 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11489 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11490 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11491 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11492
11493 @table @code
11494 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11495 @item set symbol-reloading on
11496 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11497 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11498
11499 @item set symbol-reloading off
11500 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11501 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11502 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11503 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11504 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11505 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11506 name.
11507
11508 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11509 @item show symbol-reloading
11510 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11511 @end table
11512
11513 @cindex opaque data types
11514 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11515 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11516 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11517 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11518 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11519 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11520 another source file. The default is on.
11521
11522 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11523 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11524
11525 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11526 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11527 is printed as follows:
11528 @smallexample
11529 @{<no data fields>@}
11530 @end smallexample
11531
11532 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11533 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11534 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11535
11536 @kindex set print symbol-loading
11537 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
11538 @item set print symbol-loading
11539 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
11540 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
11541 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
11542 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
11543 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
11544 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
11545 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
11546 annoying than useful.
11547
11548 @kindex show print symbol-loading
11549 @item show print symbol-loading
11550 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
11551
11552 @kindex maint print symbols
11553 @cindex symbol dump
11554 @kindex maint print psymbols
11555 @cindex partial symbol dump
11556 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11557 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11558 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11559 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11560 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11561 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11562 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11563 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11564 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11565 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11566 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11567 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11568 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11569 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11570 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11571 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11572 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11573
11574 @kindex maint info symtabs
11575 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11576 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11577 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11578 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11579 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11580 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11581 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11582
11583 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11584 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11585 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11586 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11587 structure in more detail. For example:
11588
11589 @smallexample
11590 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11591 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11592 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11593 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11594 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11595 readin no
11596 fullname (null)
11597 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11598 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11599 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11600 dependencies (none)
11601 @}
11602 @}
11603 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11604 (@value{GDBP})
11605 @end smallexample
11606 @noindent
11607 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11608 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11609 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11610 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11611 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11612
11613 @smallexample
11614 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11615 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11616 line 1574.
11617 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11618 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11619 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11620 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11621 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11622 dirname (null)
11623 fullname (null)
11624 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11625 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11626 debugformat DWARF 2
11627 @}
11628 @}
11629 (@value{GDBP})
11630 @end smallexample
11631 @end table
11632
11633
11634 @node Altering
11635 @chapter Altering Execution
11636
11637 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11638 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11639 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11640 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11641 program.
11642
11643 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11644 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11645 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11646
11647 @menu
11648 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11649 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11650 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11651 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11652 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11653 * Patching:: Patching your program
11654 @end menu
11655
11656 @node Assignment
11657 @section Assignment to Variables
11658
11659 @cindex assignment
11660 @cindex setting variables
11661 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11662 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11663
11664 @smallexample
11665 print x=4
11666 @end smallexample
11667
11668 @noindent
11669 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11670 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11671 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11672 information on operators in supported languages.
11673
11674 @kindex set variable
11675 @cindex variables, setting
11676 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11677 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11678 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11679 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11680 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11681
11682 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11683 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11684 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11685 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11686 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11687 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11688 command @code{set width}:
11689
11690 @smallexample
11691 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11692 type = double
11693 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11694 $4 = 13
11695 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11696 Invalid syntax in expression.
11697 @end smallexample
11698
11699 @noindent
11700 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11701 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11702
11703 @smallexample
11704 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11705 @end smallexample
11706
11707 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11708 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11709 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11710 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11711 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11712 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11713
11714 @smallexample
11715 @group
11716 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11717 type = double
11718 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11719 $1 = 1
11720 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11721 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11722 $2 = 1
11723 (@value{GDBP}) r
11724 The program being debugged has been started already.
11725 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11726 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11727 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11728 Invalid bfd target.
11729 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11730 The current BFD target is "=4".
11731 @end group
11732 @end smallexample
11733
11734 @noindent
11735 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11736 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11737 @code{g}, use
11738
11739 @smallexample
11740 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11741 @end smallexample
11742
11743 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11744 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11745 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11746 same length or shorter.
11747 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11748 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11749
11750 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11751 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11752 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11753 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11754 and representation in memory), and
11755
11756 @smallexample
11757 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11758 @end smallexample
11759
11760 @noindent
11761 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11762
11763 @node Jumping
11764 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11765
11766 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11767 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11768 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11769
11770 @table @code
11771 @kindex jump
11772 @item jump @var{linespec}
11773 @itemx jump @var{location}
11774 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11775 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11776 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11777 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11778 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11779 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11780
11781 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11782 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11783 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11784 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11785 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11786 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11787 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11788 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11789 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11790 @end table
11791
11792 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11793 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11794 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11795 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11796 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11797 example,
11798
11799 @smallexample
11800 set $pc = 0x485
11801 @end smallexample
11802
11803 @noindent
11804 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11805 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11806 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11807
11808 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11809 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11810 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11811 detail.
11812
11813 @c @group
11814 @node Signaling
11815 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11816 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11817
11818 @table @code
11819 @kindex signal
11820 @item signal @var{signal}
11821 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11822 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11823 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11824 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11825
11826 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11827 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11828 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11829 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11830 signal.
11831
11832 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11833 after executing the command.
11834 @end table
11835 @c @end group
11836
11837 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11838 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11839 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11840 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11841 passes the signal directly to your program.
11842
11843
11844 @node Returning
11845 @section Returning from a Function
11846
11847 @table @code
11848 @cindex returning from a function
11849 @kindex return
11850 @item return
11851 @itemx return @var{expression}
11852 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11853 command. If you give an
11854 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11855 value.
11856 @end table
11857
11858 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11859 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11860 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11861 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11862
11863 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11864 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11865 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11866 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11867 of functions.
11868
11869 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11870 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11871 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11872 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11873 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11874
11875 @node Calling
11876 @section Calling Program Functions
11877
11878 @table @code
11879 @cindex calling functions
11880 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11881 @item print @var{expr}
11882 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11883 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11884 debugged.
11885
11886 @kindex call
11887 @item call @var{expr}
11888 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11889 returned values.
11890
11891 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11892 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11893 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11894 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11895 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11896 value history.
11897 @end table
11898
11899 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11900 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11901 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11902 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11903
11904 @table @code
11905 @item set unwindonsignal
11906 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11907 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11908 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11909 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11910 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11911 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11912 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11913 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11914 received.
11915
11916 @item show unwindonsignal
11917 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11918 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11919 @value{GDBN}.
11920 @end table
11921
11922 @cindex weak alias functions
11923 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11924 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11925 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11926 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11927 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11928 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11929 function instead.
11930
11931 @node Patching
11932 @section Patching Programs
11933
11934 @cindex patching binaries
11935 @cindex writing into executables
11936 @cindex writing into corefiles
11937
11938 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11939 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11940 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11941 patching your program's binary.
11942
11943 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11944 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11945 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11946 repairs.
11947
11948 @table @code
11949 @kindex set write
11950 @item set write on
11951 @itemx set write off
11952 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11953 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11954 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11955
11956 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11957 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11958 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11959
11960 @item show write
11961 @kindex show write
11962 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11963 as well as reading.
11964 @end table
11965
11966 @node GDB Files
11967 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11968
11969 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11970 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11971 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11972 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11973
11974 @menu
11975 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11976 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11977 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11978 @end menu
11979
11980 @node Files
11981 @section Commands to Specify Files
11982
11983 @cindex symbol table
11984 @cindex core dump file
11985
11986 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11987 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11988 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11989 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11990
11991 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11992 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11993 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11994 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11995 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11996 new files are useful.
11997
11998 @table @code
11999 @cindex executable file
12000 @kindex file
12001 @item file @var{filename}
12002 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12003 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12004 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12005 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12006 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12007 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12008 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12009 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12010
12011 @cindex unlinked object files
12012 @cindex patching object files
12013 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12014 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12015 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12016 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12017 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12018 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12019 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12020 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12021
12022 @item file
12023 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12024 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12025
12026 @kindex exec-file
12027 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12028 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12029 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12030 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12031 discard information on the executable file.
12032
12033 @kindex symbol-file
12034 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12035 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12036 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12037 table and program to run from the same file.
12038
12039 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12040 program's symbol table.
12041
12042 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12043 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12044 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12045 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12046 @value{GDBN}.
12047
12048 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12049 executing it once.
12050
12051 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12052 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12053 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12054 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12055 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12056 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12057 optimized code.
12058
12059 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12060 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12061 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12062 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12063 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12064
12065 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12066 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12067 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12068 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12069 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12070 Warnings and Messages}.)
12071
12072 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12073 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12074 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12075 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12076 in stabs format.
12077
12078 @kindex readnow
12079 @cindex reading symbols immediately
12080 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
12081 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12082 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12083 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12084 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12085 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12086 entire symbol table available.
12087
12088 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12089 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12090 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12091 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12092 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12093 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12094 @c files.
12095
12096 @kindex core-file
12097 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12098 @itemx core
12099 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12100 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12101 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12102 executable file itself for other parts.
12103
12104 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12105 to be used.
12106
12107 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12108 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12109 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12110 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
12111 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
12112
12113 @kindex add-symbol-file
12114 @cindex dynamic linking
12115 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12116 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12117 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12118 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12119 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12120 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12121 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12122 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12123 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12124 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12125 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12126 @var{address} as an expression.
12127
12128 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12129 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12130 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12131 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12132 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12133
12134 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12135 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12136 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12137 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12138 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12139 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12140 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12141 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12142 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12143
12144 @itemize @bullet
12145 @item
12146 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12147 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12148 @item
12149 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12150 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12151 @item
12152 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12153 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12154 @end itemize
12155
12156 @noindent
12157 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12158 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12159 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12160 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12161 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12162 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12163 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12164 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12165 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12166 way.
12167
12168 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12169
12170 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12171 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12172 @cindex load symbols from memory
12173 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12174 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12175 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12176 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12177 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12178 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12179 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12180 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12181 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12182
12183 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12184 @kindex assf
12185 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12186 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
12187 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12188 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12189 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12190 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12191 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12192 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12193 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12194 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12195
12196 @kindex section
12197 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12198 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12199 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12200 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12201 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12202 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12203 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12204 their addresses.
12205
12206 @kindex info files
12207 @kindex info target
12208 @item info files
12209 @itemx info target
12210 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12211 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12212 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12213 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12214 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12215 current ones.
12216
12217 @kindex maint info sections
12218 @item maint info sections
12219 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12220 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12221 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12222 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12223 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12224 may be arbitrarily combined):
12225
12226 @table @code
12227 @item ALLOBJ
12228 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12229 @item @var{sections}
12230 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12231 @item @var{section-flags}
12232 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12233 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12234 @table @code
12235 @item ALLOC
12236 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12237 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12238 @item LOAD
12239 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12240 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12241 @item RELOC
12242 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12243 @item READONLY
12244 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12245 @item CODE
12246 Section contains executable code only.
12247 @item DATA
12248 Section contains data only (no executable code).
12249 @item ROM
12250 Section will reside in ROM.
12251 @item CONSTRUCTOR
12252 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12253 @item HAS_CONTENTS
12254 Section is not empty.
12255 @item NEVER_LOAD
12256 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12257 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12258 A notification to the linker that the section contains
12259 COFF shared library information.
12260 @item IS_COMMON
12261 Section contains common symbols.
12262 @end table
12263 @end table
12264 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12265 @cindex read-only sections
12266 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
12267 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12268 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12269 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12270 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12271 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12272 enhancement to debugging performance.
12273
12274 The default is off.
12275
12276 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12277 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12278 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12279 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12280
12281 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12282 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12283 @end table
12284
12285 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12286 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12287 name and remembers it that way.
12288
12289 @cindex shared libraries
12290 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12291 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12292 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12293
12294 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12295 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12296
12297 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12298 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12299 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12300 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12301 debugging a core file).
12302
12303 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12304 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12305
12306 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12307 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12308 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12309
12310 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12311 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12312 particularly large or there are many of them.
12313
12314 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12315 commands:
12316
12317 @table @code
12318 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12319 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12320 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12321 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12322 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12323 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12324 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12325 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12326
12327 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12328 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12329 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12330 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12331 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12332 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12333 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12334 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12335 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12336
12337 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12338 @item show auto-solib-add
12339 Display the current autoloading mode.
12340 @end table
12341
12342 @cindex load shared library
12343 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12344 command:
12345
12346 @table @code
12347 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12348 @kindex info share
12349 @item info share
12350 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12351 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12352
12353 @kindex sharedlibrary
12354 @kindex share
12355 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12356 @itemx share @var{regex}
12357 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12358 Unix regular expression.
12359 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12360 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12361 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12362 loaded.
12363
12364 @item nosharedlibrary
12365 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12366 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12367 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12368 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12369 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12370 discarded.
12371 @end table
12372
12373 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12374 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12375 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12376
12377 @table @code
12378 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12379 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12380 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12381 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12382 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12383 shared library.
12384
12385 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12386 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12387 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12388 library events happen.
12389 @end table
12390
12391 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12392 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12393 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12394 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12395 not.
12396
12397 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12398 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12399 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12400 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12401 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12402
12403 @table @code
12404 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12405 @cindex system root, alternate
12406 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12407 @kindex set sysroot
12408 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12409 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12410 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12411 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12412 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12413 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12414 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12415 under @var{path}.
12416
12417 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12418 sysroot}.
12419
12420 @cindex default system root
12421 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12422 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12423 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12424 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12425 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12426 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12427 location.
12428
12429 @kindex show sysroot
12430 @item show sysroot
12431 Display the current shared library prefix.
12432
12433 @kindex set solib-search-path
12434 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12435 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12436 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12437 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12438 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12439 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12440 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12441 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12442 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12443 of shared library symbols.
12444
12445 @kindex show solib-search-path
12446 @item show solib-search-path
12447 Display the current shared library search path.
12448 @end table
12449
12450
12451 @node Separate Debug Files
12452 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12453 @cindex separate debugging information files
12454 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12455 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12456 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12457 @cindex global debugging information directory
12458 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12459 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12460
12461 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12462 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12463 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12464 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12465 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12466 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12467 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12468
12469 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12470 file:
12471
12472 @itemize @bullet
12473 @item
12474 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12475 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12476 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12477 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12478 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12479 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12480 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12481 came from the same build.
12482
12483 @item
12484 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12485 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12486 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12487 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12488 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12489 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12490 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12491 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12492 below.
12493 @end itemize
12494
12495 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12496 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12497
12498 @itemize @bullet
12499 @item
12500 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12501 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12502 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12503 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12504 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12505
12506 @item
12507 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12508 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12509 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12510 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12511 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12512 hex characters, not 10.)
12513 @end itemize
12514
12515 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12516 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12517 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12518 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12519 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12520 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12521
12522 @itemize @minus
12523 @item
12524 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12525 @item
12526 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12527 @item
12528 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12529 @item
12530 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12531 @end itemize
12532
12533 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12534 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12535
12536 @table @code
12537
12538 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12539 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12540 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12541 information files to @var{directory}.
12542
12543 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12544 @item show debug-file-directory
12545 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12546 information files.
12547
12548 @end table
12549
12550 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12551 @cindex debug link sections
12552 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12553 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12554
12555 @itemize
12556 @item
12557 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12558 a zero byte,
12559 @item
12560 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12561 boundary within the section, and
12562 @item
12563 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12564 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12565 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12566 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12567 @end itemize
12568
12569 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12570 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12571 described above.
12572
12573 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12574 @cindex build ID sections
12575 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12576 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12577 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12578 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12579 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12580 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12581 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12582 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12583 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12584
12585 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12586 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12587 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12588 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12589 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12590 in an ordinary executable.
12591
12592 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12593 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12594 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12595 following commands:
12596
12597 @smallexample
12598 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12599 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12600 @end smallexample
12601
12602 @noindent
12603 These commands remove the debugging
12604 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12605 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12606 two files:
12607
12608 @itemize @bullet
12609 @item
12610 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12611 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12612
12613 @smallexample
12614 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12615 @end smallexample
12616
12617 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12618 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12619 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12620 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12621
12622 @item
12623 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12624 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12625 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12626 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12627 @end itemize
12628
12629 @noindent
12630
12631 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12632 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12633 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12634 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12635
12636 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12637 @smallexample
12638 unsigned long
12639 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12640 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12641 @{
12642 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12643 @{
12644 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12645 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12646 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12647 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12648 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12649 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12650 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12651 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12652 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12653 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12654 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12655 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12656 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12657 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12658 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12659 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12660 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12661 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12662 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12663 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12664 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12665 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12666 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12667 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12668 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12669 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12670 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12671 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12672 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12673 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12674 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12675 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12676 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12677 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12678 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12679 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12680 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12681 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12682 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12683 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12684 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12685 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12686 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12687 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12688 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12689 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12690 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12691 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12692 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12693 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12694 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12695 0x2d02ef8d
12696 @};
12697 unsigned char *end;
12698
12699 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12700 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12701 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12702 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12703 @}
12704 @end smallexample
12705
12706 @noindent
12707 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12708
12709
12710 @node Symbol Errors
12711 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12712
12713 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12714 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12715 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12716 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12717 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12718 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12719 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12720 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12721 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12722 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12723 Messages}).
12724
12725 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12726
12727 @table @code
12728 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12729
12730 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12731 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12732 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12733 in its outer scope blocks.
12734
12735 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12736 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12737 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12738 function.
12739
12740 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12741
12742 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12743 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12744 do so.
12745
12746 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12747 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12748 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12749 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12750 Messages}.)
12751
12752 @item bad block start address patched
12753
12754 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12755 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12756 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12757
12758 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12759 starting on the previous source line.
12760
12761 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12762
12763 @cindex foo
12764 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12765 larger than the size of the string table.
12766
12767 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12768 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12769 with this name.
12770
12771 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12772
12773 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12774 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12775 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12776
12777 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12778 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12779 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12780 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12781 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12782 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12783
12784 @item stub type has NULL name
12785
12786 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12787
12788 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12789 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12790 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12791 it.
12792
12793 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12794
12795 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12796
12797 @end table
12798
12799 @node Targets
12800 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12801
12802 @cindex debugging target
12803 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12804
12805 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12806 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12807 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12808 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12809 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12810 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12811 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12812 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12813
12814 @cindex target architecture
12815 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12816 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12817 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12818 command.
12819
12820 @table @code
12821 @kindex set architecture
12822 @kindex show architecture
12823 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12824 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12825 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12826 supported architectures.
12827
12828 @item show architecture
12829 Show the current target architecture.
12830
12831 @item set processor
12832 @itemx processor
12833 @kindex set processor
12834 @kindex show processor
12835 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12836 and @code{show architecture}.
12837 @end table
12838
12839 @menu
12840 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12841 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12842 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12843 @end menu
12844
12845 @node Active Targets
12846 @section Active Targets
12847
12848 @cindex stacking targets
12849 @cindex active targets
12850 @cindex multiple targets
12851
12852 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12853 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12854 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12855 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12856 a core file.
12857
12858 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12859 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12860 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12861 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12862 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12863 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12864 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12865 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12866 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12867
12868 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12869 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12870 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12871 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12872 process target is active.
12873
12874 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12875 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12876 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12877 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12878 Process}).
12879
12880 @node Target Commands
12881 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12882
12883 @table @code
12884 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12885 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12886 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12887 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12888 protocol of the target machine.
12889
12890 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12891 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12892 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12893
12894 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12895 after executing the command.
12896
12897 @kindex help target
12898 @item help target
12899 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12900 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12901 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12902
12903 @item help target @var{name}
12904 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12905 select it.
12906
12907 @kindex set gnutarget
12908 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12909 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12910 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12911 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12912 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12913 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12914
12915 @quotation
12916 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12917 you must know the actual BFD name.
12918 @end quotation
12919
12920 @noindent
12921 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12922
12923 @kindex show gnutarget
12924 @item show gnutarget
12925 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12926 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12927 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12928 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12929 @end table
12930
12931 @cindex common targets
12932 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12933 configuration):
12934
12935 @table @code
12936 @kindex target
12937 @item target exec @var{program}
12938 @cindex executable file target
12939 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12940 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12941
12942 @item target core @var{filename}
12943 @cindex core dump file target
12944 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12945 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12946
12947 @item target remote @var{medium}
12948 @cindex remote target
12949 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12950 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12951 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12952
12953 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12954 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12955
12956 @smallexample
12957 target remote /dev/ttya
12958 @end smallexample
12959
12960 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12961 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12962 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12963 clobbered by the download.
12964
12965 @item target sim
12966 @cindex built-in simulator target
12967 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12968 In general,
12969 @smallexample
12970 target sim
12971 load
12972 run
12973 @end smallexample
12974 @noindent
12975 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12976 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12977 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12978 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12979 Processors}.
12980
12981 @end table
12982
12983 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12984
12985 @table @code
12986
12987 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12988 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12989 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12990
12991 @end table
12992
12993 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12994 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12995
12996 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12997 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12998 various aspects of this process.
12999
13000 @table @code
13001
13002 @item set hash
13003 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13004 @cindex hash mark while downloading
13005 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13006 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13007 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13008 monitor.
13009
13010 @item show hash
13011 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13012 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13013
13014 @item set debug monitor
13015 @kindex set debug monitor
13016 @cindex display remote monitor communications
13017 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13018 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13019
13020 @item show debug monitor
13021 @kindex show debug monitor
13022 Show the current status of displaying communications between
13023 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13024 @end table
13025
13026 @table @code
13027
13028 @kindex load @var{filename}
13029 @item load @var{filename}
13030 @anchor{load}
13031 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13032 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13033 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13034 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13035 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13036 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13037
13038 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13039 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13040 target is @dots{}}''
13041
13042 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13043 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13044 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13045 specifies a fixed address.
13046 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13047
13048 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13049 load programs into flash memory.
13050
13051 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13052 @end table
13053
13054 @node Byte Order
13055 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
13056
13057 @cindex choosing target byte order
13058 @cindex target byte order
13059
13060 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13061 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13062 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13063 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13064 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13065 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13066
13067 @table @code
13068 @kindex set endian
13069 @item set endian big
13070 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
13071
13072 @item set endian little
13073 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
13074
13075 @item set endian auto
13076 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
13077 executable.
13078
13079 @item show endian
13080 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
13081
13082 @end table
13083
13084 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
13085 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
13086 target system.
13087
13088
13089 @node Remote Debugging
13090 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
13091 @cindex remote debugging
13092
13093 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
13094 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
13095 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
13096 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
13097 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
13098
13099 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
13100 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
13101 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
13102 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
13103 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
13104 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
13105
13106 Other remote targets may be available in your
13107 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
13108
13109 @menu
13110 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
13111 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
13112 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
13113 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
13114 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13115 @end menu
13116
13117 @node Connecting
13118 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
13119
13120 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13121 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13122 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13123 program as the first argument.
13124
13125 @cindex @code{target remote}
13126 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13127 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13128 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13129 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13130 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13131 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13132
13133 @table @code
13134
13135 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
13136 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13137 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13138 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13139
13140 @smallexample
13141 target remote /dev/ttyb
13142 @end smallexample
13143
13144 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13145 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13146 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13147 @code{target} command.
13148
13149 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13150 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13151 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13152 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13153 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13154 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13155 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13156 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13157 target.
13158
13159 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13160 @code{manyfarms}:
13161
13162 @smallexample
13163 target remote manyfarms:2828
13164 @end smallexample
13165
13166 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13167 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13168 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13169 port 1234 on your local machine:
13170
13171 @smallexample
13172 target remote :1234
13173 @end smallexample
13174 @noindent
13175
13176 Note that the colon is still required here.
13177
13178 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13179 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13180 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13181 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13182
13183 @smallexample
13184 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13185 @end smallexample
13186
13187 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13188 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13189 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13190 cause havoc with your debugging session.
13191
13192 @item target remote | @var{command}
13193 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13194 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13195 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13196 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13197 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13198 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13199 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13200 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13201
13202 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13203 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13204 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13205
13206 @end table
13207
13208 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13209 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13210 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13211 need to use @kbd{run}.
13212
13213 @cindex interrupting remote programs
13214 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
13215 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13216 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13217 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13218 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13219 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13220
13221 @smallexample
13222 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13223 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13224 @end smallexample
13225
13226 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13227 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13228 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13229 goes back to waiting.
13230
13231 @table @code
13232 @kindex detach (remote)
13233 @item detach
13234 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13235 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13236 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13237 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13238 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13239
13240 @kindex disconnect
13241 @item disconnect
13242 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13243 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13244 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13245 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13246 another target.
13247
13248 @cindex send command to remote monitor
13249 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13250 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
13251 @kindex monitor
13252 @item monitor @var{cmd}
13253 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13254 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13255 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13256 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13257 and implement.
13258 @end table
13259
13260 @node File Transfer
13261 @section Sending files to a remote system
13262 @cindex remote target, file transfer
13263 @cindex file transfer
13264 @cindex sending files to remote systems
13265
13266 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13267 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13268 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13269 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13270 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13271 the only way to upload or download files.
13272
13273 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13274
13275 @table @code
13276 @kindex remote put
13277 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13278 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13279 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13280
13281 @kindex remote get
13282 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13283 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13284 on the host system.
13285
13286 @kindex remote delete
13287 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13288 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13289
13290 @end table
13291
13292 @node Server
13293 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13294
13295 @kindex gdbserver
13296 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13297 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13298 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13299 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13300
13301 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13302 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13303 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13304 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13305 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13306 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13307 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13308 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13309 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13310 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13311 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13312 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13313 choice for debugging.
13314
13315 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13316 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13317 protocol.
13318
13319 @quotation
13320 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13321 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13322 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13323 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13324 @code{gdbserver}.
13325 @end quotation
13326
13327 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13328 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13329
13330 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13331 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13332 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13333 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13334 system does all the symbol handling.
13335
13336 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13337 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13338 syntax is:
13339
13340 @smallexample
13341 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13342 @end smallexample
13343
13344 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13345 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13346 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13347 @file{/dev/com1}:
13348
13349 @smallexample
13350 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13351 @end smallexample
13352
13353 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13354 with it.
13355
13356 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13357
13358 @smallexample
13359 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13360 @end smallexample
13361
13362 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13363 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13364 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13365 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13366 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13367 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13368 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13369 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13370 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13371 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13372 @code{target remote} command.
13373
13374 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13375
13376 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13377 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13378
13379 @smallexample
13380 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13381 @end smallexample
13382
13383 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13384 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13385
13386 @pindex pidof
13387 @cindex attach to a program by name
13388 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13389 @code{pidof} utility:
13390
13391 @smallexample
13392 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13393 @end smallexample
13394
13395 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13396 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13397 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13398
13399 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13400 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13401 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13402
13403 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13404 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13405 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13406 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13407
13408 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13409 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13410 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13411 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13412 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13413 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13414 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13415 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13416 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13417
13418 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13419 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13420 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13421 the program you want to debug.
13422
13423 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13424 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13425 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13426
13427 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13428
13429 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13430 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13431 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13432 for bug reports to the developers.
13433
13434 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13435 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13436 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13437 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13438
13439 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13440 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13441 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13442 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13443
13444 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13445 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13446 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13447 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13448
13449 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13450 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13451 environment:
13452
13453 @smallexample
13454 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13455 @end smallexample
13456
13457 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13458
13459 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13460
13461 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13462 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13463 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13464 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13465
13466 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13467 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13468 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13469 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13470 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13471 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13472 programs.
13473
13474 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13475 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13476 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13477 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13478 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13479 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13480 already on the target.
13481
13482 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13483 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13484 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13485
13486 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13487 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13488 Here are the available commands.
13489
13490 @table @code
13491 @item monitor help
13492 List the available monitor commands.
13493
13494 @item monitor set debug 0
13495 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13496 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13497
13498 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13499 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13500 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13501 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13502
13503 @item monitor exit
13504 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13505 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13506 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13507 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13508 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13509
13510 @end table
13511
13512 @node Remote Configuration
13513 @section Remote Configuration
13514
13515 @kindex set remote
13516 @kindex show remote
13517 This section documents the configuration options available when
13518 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13519 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13520 system-call-allowed}.
13521
13522 @table @code
13523 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13524 @cindex address size for remote targets
13525 @cindex bits in remote address
13526 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13527 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13528 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13529 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13530
13531 @item show remoteaddresssize
13532 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13533
13534 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13535 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13536 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13537 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13538 remote targets.
13539
13540 @item show remotebaud
13541 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13542
13543 @item set remotebreak
13544 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13545 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13546 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13547 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13548 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13549 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13550 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13551 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13552
13553 @item show remotebreak
13554 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13555 interrupt the remote program.
13556
13557 @item set remoteflow on
13558 @itemx set remoteflow off
13559 @kindex set remoteflow
13560 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13561 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13562
13563 @item show remoteflow
13564 @kindex show remoteflow
13565 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13566
13567 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13568 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13569 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13570 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13571 @code{ascii}.
13572
13573 @item show remotelogbase
13574 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13575 protocol.
13576
13577 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13578 @cindex record serial communications on file
13579 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13580 default is not to record at all.
13581
13582 @item show remotelogfile.
13583 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13584 serial communications.
13585
13586 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13587 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13588 @cindex remote timeout
13589 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13590 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13591
13592 @item show remotetimeout
13593 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13594 responses.
13595
13596 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13597 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13598 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13599 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13600 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13601 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13602 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13603 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13604
13605 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13606 @itemx show remote exec-file
13607 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13608 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13609 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13610 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13611 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13612 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13613 @end table
13614
13615 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13616 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13617 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13618 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13619 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13620 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13621 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13622 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13623 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13624
13625 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13626 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13627 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13628 @value{GDBN} developers.
13629
13630 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13631 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13632 are:
13633
13634 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13635 @item Command Name
13636 @tab Remote Packet
13637 @tab Related Features
13638
13639 @item @code{fetch-register}
13640 @tab @code{p}
13641 @tab @code{info registers}
13642
13643 @item @code{set-register}
13644 @tab @code{P}
13645 @tab @code{set}
13646
13647 @item @code{binary-download}
13648 @tab @code{X}
13649 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13650
13651 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13652 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13653 @tab @code{info auxv}
13654
13655 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13656 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13657 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13658
13659 @item @code{attach}
13660 @tab @code{vAttach}
13661 @tab @code{attach}
13662
13663 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13664 @tab @code{vCont}
13665 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13666
13667 @item @code{run}
13668 @tab @code{vRun}
13669 @tab @code{run}
13670
13671 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13672 @tab @code{Z0}
13673 @tab @code{break}
13674
13675 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13676 @tab @code{Z1}
13677 @tab @code{hbreak}
13678
13679 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13680 @tab @code{Z2}
13681 @tab @code{watch}
13682
13683 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13684 @tab @code{Z3}
13685 @tab @code{rwatch}
13686
13687 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13688 @tab @code{Z4}
13689 @tab @code{awatch}
13690
13691 @item @code{target-features}
13692 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13693 @tab @code{set architecture}
13694
13695 @item @code{library-info}
13696 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13697 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13698
13699 @item @code{memory-map}
13700 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13701 @tab @code{info mem}
13702
13703 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13704 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13705 @tab @code{info spu}
13706
13707 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13708 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13709 @tab @code{info spu}
13710
13711 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13712 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13713 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13714
13715 @item @code{search-memory}
13716 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
13717 @tab @code{find}
13718
13719 @item @code{supported-packets}
13720 @tab @code{qSupported}
13721 @tab Remote communications parameters
13722
13723 @item @code{pass-signals}
13724 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13725 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13726
13727 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13728 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13729 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13730
13731 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13732 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13733 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13734
13735 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13736 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13737 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13738
13739 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13740 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13741 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13742
13743 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13744 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13745 @tab @code{remote delete}
13746 @end multitable
13747
13748 @node Remote Stub
13749 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13750
13751 @cindex debugging stub, example
13752 @cindex remote stub, example
13753 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13754 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13755 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13756 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13757 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13758 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13759 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13760 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13761
13762 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13763 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13764 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13765 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13766 program, you need:
13767
13768 @enumerate
13769 @item
13770 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13771 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13772 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13773
13774 @item
13775 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13776 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13777
13778 @item
13779 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13780 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13781 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13782 documentation.
13783 @end enumerate
13784
13785 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13786 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13787 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13788
13789 @table @emph
13790 @item On the host,
13791 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13792 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13793 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13794
13795 @item On the target,
13796 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13797 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13798 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13799
13800 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13801 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13802 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13803 @end table
13804
13805 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13806 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13807 @sc{sparc} boards.
13808
13809 @cindex remote serial stub list
13810 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13811
13812 @table @code
13813
13814 @item i386-stub.c
13815 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13816 @cindex Intel
13817 @cindex i386
13818 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13819
13820 @item m68k-stub.c
13821 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13822 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13823 @cindex m680x0
13824 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13825
13826 @item sh-stub.c
13827 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13828 @cindex Renesas
13829 @cindex SH
13830 For Renesas SH architectures.
13831
13832 @item sparc-stub.c
13833 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13834 @cindex Sparc
13835 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13836
13837 @item sparcl-stub.c
13838 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13839 @cindex Fujitsu
13840 @cindex SparcLite
13841 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13842
13843 @end table
13844
13845 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13846 recently added stubs.
13847
13848 @menu
13849 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13850 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13851 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13852 @end menu
13853
13854 @node Stub Contents
13855 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13856
13857 @cindex remote serial stub
13858 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13859 subroutines:
13860
13861 @table @code
13862 @item set_debug_traps
13863 @findex set_debug_traps
13864 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13865 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13866 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13867 beginning of your program.
13868
13869 @item handle_exception
13870 @findex handle_exception
13871 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13872 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13873 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13874 run when a trap is triggered.
13875
13876 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13877 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13878 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13879 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13880 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13881 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13882 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13883 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13884 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13885 machine.
13886
13887 @item breakpoint
13888 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13889 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13890 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13891 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13892 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13893 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13894 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13895 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13896 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13897 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13898 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13899
13900 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13901 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13902 start of your debugging session.
13903 @end table
13904
13905 @node Bootstrapping
13906 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13907
13908 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13909 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13910 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13911 debugging target machine.
13912
13913 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13914 serial port.
13915
13916 @table @code
13917 @item int getDebugChar()
13918 @findex getDebugChar
13919 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13920 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13921 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13922
13923 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13924 @findex putDebugChar
13925 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13926 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13927 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13928 @end table
13929
13930 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13931 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13932 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13933 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13934 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13935 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13936 remote system to stop.
13937
13938 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13939 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13940 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13941 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13942
13943 Other routines you need to supply are:
13944
13945 @table @code
13946 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13947 @findex exceptionHandler
13948 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13949 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13950 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13951 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13952 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13953 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13954 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13955 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13956 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13957 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13958 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13959 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13960 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13961
13962 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13963 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13964 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13965 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13966 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13967
13968 @item void flush_i_cache()
13969 @findex flush_i_cache
13970 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13971 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13972 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13973
13974 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13975 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13976 @end table
13977
13978 @noindent
13979 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13980
13981 @table @code
13982 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13983 @findex memset
13984 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13985 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13986 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13987 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13988 @end table
13989
13990 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13991 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13992 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13993 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13994
13995
13996 @node Debug Session
13997 @subsection Putting it All Together
13998
13999 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
14000 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14001 steps.
14002
14003 @enumerate
14004 @item
14005 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14006 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14007 @display
14008 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14009 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14010 @end display
14011
14012 @item
14013 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14014
14015 @smallexample
14016 set_debug_traps();
14017 breakpoint();
14018 @end smallexample
14019
14020 @item
14021 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
14022 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
14023
14024 @smallexample
14025 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
14026 @end smallexample
14027
14028 @noindent
14029 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
14030 function in your program, that function is called when
14031 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
14032 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
14033 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
14034
14035 @item
14036 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
14037 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
14038
14039 @item
14040 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
14041 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
14042
14043 @item
14044 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
14045 @c document that. FIXME.
14046 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
14047 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
14048
14049 @item
14050 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
14051 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14052
14053 @end enumerate
14054
14055 @node Configurations
14056 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
14057
14058 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
14059 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
14060 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
14061
14062 There are three major categories of configurations: native
14063 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
14064 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
14065 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
14066 are quite different from each other.
14067
14068 @menu
14069 * Native::
14070 * Embedded OS::
14071 * Embedded Processors::
14072 * Architectures::
14073 @end menu
14074
14075 @node Native
14076 @section Native
14077
14078 This section describes details specific to particular native
14079 configurations.
14080
14081 @menu
14082 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
14083 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
14084 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
14085 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
14086 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
14087 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
14088 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
14089 @end menu
14090
14091 @node HP-UX
14092 @subsection HP-UX
14093
14094 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
14095 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
14096 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
14097
14098
14099 @node BSD libkvm Interface
14100 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
14101
14102 @cindex libkvm
14103 @cindex kernel memory image
14104 @cindex kernel crash dump
14105
14106 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
14107 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
14108 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
14109 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
14110 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
14111 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
14112 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
14113 @code{kvm} target:
14114
14115 @smallexample
14116 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14117 @end smallexample
14118
14119 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14120 argument:
14121
14122 @smallexample
14123 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14124 @end smallexample
14125
14126 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14127 available:
14128
14129 @table @code
14130 @kindex kvm
14131 @item kvm pcb
14132 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14133
14134 @item kvm proc
14135 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14136 modern FreeBSD systems.
14137 @end table
14138
14139 @node SVR4 Process Information
14140 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
14141 @cindex /proc
14142 @cindex examine process image
14143 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14144
14145 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14146 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14147 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14148 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14149 proc} is available to report information about the process running
14150 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14151 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14152 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14153 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14154
14155 @table @code
14156 @kindex info proc
14157 @cindex process ID
14158 @item info proc
14159 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14160 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14161 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14162 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14163 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14164 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14165 executable file's absolute file name.
14166
14167 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14168 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14169 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14170 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14171 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14172 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14173
14174 @item info proc mappings
14175 @cindex memory address space mappings
14176 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14177 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14178 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14179 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14180 memory access rights to that range.
14181
14182 @item info proc stat
14183 @itemx info proc status
14184 @cindex process detailed status information
14185 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14186 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14187 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14188 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14189 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14190 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14191 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14192
14193 @item info proc all
14194 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14195 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14196
14197 @ignore
14198 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14199 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14200 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14201 @kindex info proc times
14202 @item info proc times
14203 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14204 its children.
14205
14206 @kindex info proc id
14207 @item info proc id
14208 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14209 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14210 @end ignore
14211
14212 @item set procfs-trace
14213 @kindex set procfs-trace
14214 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14215 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14216
14217 @item show procfs-trace
14218 @kindex show procfs-trace
14219 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14220
14221 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
14222 @kindex set procfs-file
14223 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14224 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14225 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14226 standard output.
14227
14228 @item show procfs-file
14229 @kindex show procfs-file
14230 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14231
14232 @item proc-trace-entry
14233 @itemx proc-trace-exit
14234 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
14235 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
14236 @kindex proc-trace-entry
14237 @kindex proc-trace-exit
14238 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
14239 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
14240 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14241 from the @code{syscall} interface.
14242
14243 @item info pidlist
14244 @kindex info pidlist
14245 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14246 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14247 processes and all the threads within each process.
14248
14249 @item info meminfo
14250 @kindex info meminfo
14251 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14252 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14253 @end table
14254
14255 @node DJGPP Native
14256 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14257 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14258 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14259 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14260
14261 @cindex DPMI
14262 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14263 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14264 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14265 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14266
14267 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14268 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14269 subsection describes those commands.
14270
14271 @table @code
14272 @kindex info dos
14273 @item info dos
14274 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14275 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14276
14277 @kindex sysinfo
14278 @cindex MS-DOS system info
14279 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14280 @item info dos sysinfo
14281 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14282 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14283 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14284
14285 @cindex GDT
14286 @cindex LDT
14287 @cindex IDT
14288 @cindex segment descriptor tables
14289 @cindex descriptor tables display
14290 @item info dos gdt
14291 @itemx info dos ldt
14292 @itemx info dos idt
14293 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14294 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14295 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14296 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14297 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14298 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14299 rights.
14300
14301 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14302 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14303 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14304 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14305 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14306
14307 @cindex garbled pointers
14308 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14309 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14310 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14311 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14312 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14313 debugged program's data segment:
14314
14315 @smallexample
14316 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14317 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14318 @end smallexample
14319
14320 @noindent
14321 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14322 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14323
14324 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14325 @item info dos pde
14326 @itemx info dos pte
14327 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14328 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14329 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14330 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14331 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14332 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14333 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14334 that is currently in use.
14335
14336 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14337 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14338 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14339 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14340 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14341 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14342 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14343
14344 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14345 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14346 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14347 controller.
14348
14349 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14350
14351 @cindex physical address from linear address
14352 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14353 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14354 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14355 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14356 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14357 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14358 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14359
14360 @smallexample
14361 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14362 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14363 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14364 @end smallexample
14365
14366 @noindent
14367 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14368 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14369 attributes of that page.
14370
14371 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14372 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14373 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14374 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14375 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14376 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14377
14378 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14379 transfer buffer:
14380
14381 @smallexample
14382 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14383 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14384 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14385 @end smallexample
14386
14387 @noindent
14388 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14389 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14390 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14391 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14392 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14393
14394 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14395 @end table
14396
14397 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14398 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14399 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14400 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14401
14402 @table @code
14403 @kindex set com1base
14404 @kindex set com1irq
14405 @kindex set com2base
14406 @kindex set com2irq
14407 @kindex set com3base
14408 @kindex set com3irq
14409 @kindex set com4base
14410 @kindex set com4irq
14411 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14412 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14413 port.
14414
14415 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14416 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14417 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14418
14419 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14420 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14421 other 3 COM ports.
14422
14423 @kindex show com1base
14424 @kindex show com1irq
14425 @kindex show com2base
14426 @kindex show com2irq
14427 @kindex show com3base
14428 @kindex show com3irq
14429 @kindex show com4base
14430 @kindex show com4irq
14431 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14432 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14433 lines used by the COM ports.
14434
14435 @item info serial
14436 @kindex info serial
14437 @cindex DOS serial port status
14438 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14439 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14440 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14441 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14442 @end table
14443
14444
14445 @node Cygwin Native
14446 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14447 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14448 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14449 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14450
14451 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14452 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14453 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14454 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14455 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14456
14457 @table @code
14458 @kindex info w32
14459 @item info w32
14460 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14461 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14462
14463 @item info w32 selector
14464 This command displays information returned by
14465 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14466 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14467 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14468 Without argument, this command displays information
14469 about the six segment registers.
14470
14471 @kindex info dll
14472 @item info dll
14473 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14474
14475 @kindex dll-symbols
14476 @item dll-symbols
14477 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14478 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14479
14480 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14481 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14482 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14483 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14484 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14485 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14486 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14487 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14488 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14489 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14490 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14491
14492 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14493 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14494 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14495 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14496
14497 @kindex set new-console
14498 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14499 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14500 be started in a new console on next start.
14501 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14502 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14503
14504 @kindex show new-console
14505 @item show new-console
14506 Displays whether a new console is used
14507 when the debuggee is started.
14508
14509 @kindex set new-group
14510 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14511 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14512 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14513 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14514 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14515
14516 @kindex show new-group
14517 @item show new-group
14518 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14519
14520 @kindex set debugevents
14521 @item set debugevents
14522 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14523 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14524 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14525 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14526 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14527
14528 @kindex set debugexec
14529 @item set debugexec
14530 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14531 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14532
14533 @kindex set debugexceptions
14534 @item set debugexceptions
14535 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14536 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14537
14538 @kindex set debugmemory
14539 @item set debugmemory
14540 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14541 and writes by the debugger.
14542
14543 @kindex set shell
14544 @item set shell
14545 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14546 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14547
14548 @kindex show shell
14549 @item show shell
14550 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14551
14552 @end table
14553
14554 @menu
14555 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14556 @end menu
14557
14558 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14559 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14560 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14561 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14562
14563 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14564 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14565 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14566 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14567 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14568 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14569 ``minimal symbols''.
14570
14571 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14572 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14573 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14574 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14575 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14576 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14577 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14578 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14579 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14580 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14581
14582 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14583
14584 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14585 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14586 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14587 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14588 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14589 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14590 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14591 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14592 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14593
14594 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14595 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14596 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14597 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14598 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14599 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14600
14601 @smallexample
14602 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14603 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14604
14605 Non-debugging symbols:
14606 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14607 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14608 @end smallexample
14609
14610 @smallexample
14611 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14612 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14613
14614 Non-debugging symbols:
14615 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14616 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14617 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14618 [etc...]
14619 @end smallexample
14620
14621 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14622
14623 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14624 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14625 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14626 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14627 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14628 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14629 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14630
14631 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14632 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14633 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14634 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14635 problem:
14636
14637 @smallexample
14638 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14639 $1 = 268572168
14640 @end smallexample
14641
14642 @smallexample
14643 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14644 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14645 @end smallexample
14646
14647 And two possible solutions:
14648
14649 @smallexample
14650 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14651 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14652 @end smallexample
14653
14654 @smallexample
14655 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14656 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14657 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14658 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14659 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14660 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14661 @end smallexample
14662
14663 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14664 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14665 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14666 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14667 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14668
14669 @smallexample
14670 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14671 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14672 @end smallexample
14673
14674 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14675 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14676 safe.
14677
14678 @node Hurd Native
14679 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14680 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14681
14682 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14683 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14684
14685 @table @code
14686 @item set signals
14687 @itemx set sigs
14688 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14689 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14690 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14691 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14692 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14693 @code{signals}.
14694
14695 @item show signals
14696 @itemx show sigs
14697 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14698 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14699 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14700
14701 @item set signal-thread
14702 @itemx set sigthread
14703 @kindex set signal-thread
14704 @kindex set sigthread
14705 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14706 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14707 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14708 signal-thread}.
14709
14710 @item show signal-thread
14711 @itemx show sigthread
14712 @kindex show signal-thread
14713 @kindex show sigthread
14714 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14715 delivered a signal.
14716
14717 @item set stopped
14718 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14719 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14720 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14721 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14722
14723 @item show stopped
14724 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14725 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14726 stopped.
14727
14728 @item set exceptions
14729 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14730 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14731 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14732 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14733 trapping on.
14734
14735 @item show exceptions
14736 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14737 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14738
14739 @item set task pause
14740 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14741 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14742 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14743 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14744 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14745 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14746 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14747 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14748 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14749
14750 @item show task pause
14751 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14752 Show the current state of task suspension.
14753
14754 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14755 @cindex task suspend count
14756 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14757 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14758 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14759
14760 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14761 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14762
14763 @item set task exception-port
14764 @itemx set task excp
14765 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14766 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14767 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14768 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14769
14770 @item set noninvasive
14771 @cindex noninvasive task options
14772 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14773 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14774 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14775 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14776
14777 @item info send-rights
14778 @itemx info receive-rights
14779 @itemx info port-rights
14780 @itemx info port-sets
14781 @itemx info dead-names
14782 @itemx info ports
14783 @itemx info psets
14784 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14785 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14786 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14787 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14788 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14789 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14790 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14791 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14792 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14793
14794 @item set thread pause
14795 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14796 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14797 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14798 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14799 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14800 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14801 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14802 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14803 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14804 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14805 only the current thread.
14806
14807 @item show thread pause
14808 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14809 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14810
14811 @item set thread run
14812 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14813
14814 @item show thread run
14815 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14816
14817 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14818 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14819 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14820 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14821 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14822 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14823 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14824
14825 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14826 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14827 detaching.
14828
14829 @item set thread exception-port
14830 @itemx set thread excp
14831 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14832 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14833 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14834
14835 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14836 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14837 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14838 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14839
14840 @item set thread default
14841 @itemx show thread default
14842 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14843 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14844 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14845 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14846 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14847 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14848 the non-default commands.
14849 @end table
14850
14851
14852 @node Neutrino
14853 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14854 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14855
14856 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14857 Neutrino target:
14858
14859 @table @code
14860 @item set debug nto-debug
14861 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14862 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14863 Neutrino support.
14864
14865 @item show debug nto-debug
14866 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14867 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14868 @end table
14869
14870
14871 @node Embedded OS
14872 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14873
14874 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14875 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14876 architectures.
14877
14878 @menu
14879 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14880 @end menu
14881
14882 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14883 various real-time operating systems.
14884
14885 @node VxWorks
14886 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14887
14888 @cindex VxWorks
14889
14890 @table @code
14891
14892 @kindex target vxworks
14893 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14894 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14895 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14896
14897 @end table
14898
14899 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14900 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14901
14902 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14903 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14904 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14905 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14906 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14907 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14908 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14909
14910 @table @code
14911 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14912 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14913 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14914 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14915 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14916 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14917 of a thin network line.
14918 @end table
14919
14920 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14921 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14922 procedures.
14923
14924 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14925 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14926 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14927 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14928 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14929 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14930 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14931 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14932 manual.
14933 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14934
14935 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14936 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14937 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14938 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14939
14940 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14941
14942 @smallexample
14943 (vxgdb)
14944 @end smallexample
14945
14946 @menu
14947 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14948 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14949 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14950 @end menu
14951
14952 @node VxWorks Connection
14953 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14954
14955 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14956 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14957
14958 @smallexample
14959 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14960 @end smallexample
14961
14962 @need 750
14963 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14964
14965 @smallexample
14966 Attaching remote machine across net...
14967 Connected to tt.
14968 @end smallexample
14969
14970 @need 1000
14971 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14972 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14973 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14974 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14975 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14976
14977 @smallexample
14978 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14979 @end smallexample
14980
14981 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14982 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14983 command again.
14984
14985 @node VxWorks Download
14986 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14987
14988 @cindex download to VxWorks
14989 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14990 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14991 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14992 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14993 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14994 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14995 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14996 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14997 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14998 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14999 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
15000 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
15001 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
15002 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
15003 program, type this on VxWorks:
15004
15005 @smallexample
15006 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
15007 @end smallexample
15008
15009 @noindent
15010 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15011
15012 @smallexample
15013 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
15014 (vxgdb) load prog.o
15015 @end smallexample
15016
15017 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
15018
15019 @smallexample
15020 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
15021 @end smallexample
15022
15023 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
15024 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
15025 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
15026 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
15027 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
15028 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
15029 table.)
15030
15031 @node VxWorks Attach
15032 @subsubsection Running Tasks
15033
15034 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
15035 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
15036 follows:
15037
15038 @smallexample
15039 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
15040 @end smallexample
15041
15042 @noindent
15043 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
15044 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
15045 the time of attachment.
15046
15047 @node Embedded Processors
15048 @section Embedded Processors
15049
15050 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
15051 configurations.
15052
15053 @cindex send command to simulator
15054 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
15055 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
15056
15057 @table @code
15058 @item sim @var{command}
15059 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
15060 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
15061 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
15062 acceptable commands.
15063 @end table
15064
15065
15066 @menu
15067 * ARM:: ARM RDI
15068 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
15069 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
15070 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
15071 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
15072 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
15073 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
15074 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
15075 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
15076 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
15077 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
15078 * CRIS:: CRIS
15079 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
15080 @end menu
15081
15082 @node ARM
15083 @subsection ARM
15084 @cindex ARM RDI
15085
15086 @table @code
15087 @kindex target rdi
15088 @item target rdi @var{dev}
15089 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
15090 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
15091 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
15092
15093 @kindex target rdp
15094 @item target rdp @var{dev}
15095 ARM Demon monitor.
15096
15097 @end table
15098
15099 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
15100
15101 @table @code
15102 @item set arm disassembler
15103 @kindex set arm
15104 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
15105 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
15106
15107 @item show arm disassembler
15108 @kindex show arm
15109 Show the current disassembly style.
15110
15111 @item set arm apcs32
15112 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
15113 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
15114
15115 @item show arm apcs32
15116 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15117
15118 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15119 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15120 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15121
15122 @table @code
15123 @item auto
15124 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15125 @item softfpa
15126 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15127 processors.
15128 @item fpa
15129 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15130 @item softvfp
15131 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15132 @item vfp
15133 VFP co-processor.
15134 @end table
15135
15136 @item show arm fpu
15137 Show the current type of the FPU.
15138
15139 @item set arm abi
15140 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15141
15142 @item show arm abi
15143 Show the currently used ABI.
15144
15145 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15146 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15147 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15148 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15149 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15150 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15151 register).
15152
15153 @item show arm fallback-mode
15154 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15155
15156 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15157 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15158 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15159 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15160 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15161
15162 @item show arm force-mode
15163 Show the current forced instruction mode.
15164
15165 @item set debug arm
15166 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15167 target support subsystem.
15168
15169 @item show debug arm
15170 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15171 @end table
15172
15173 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15174 using the RDI interface:
15175
15176 @table @code
15177 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15178 @kindex rdilogfile
15179 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15180 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15181 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15182 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15183 @file{rdi.log}.
15184
15185 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15186 @kindex rdilogenable
15187 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15188 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15189 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15190 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15191 are logged to a file.
15192
15193 @item set rdiromatzero
15194 @kindex set rdiromatzero
15195 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15196 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15197 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15198 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15199 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15200
15201 @item show rdiromatzero
15202 @kindex show rdiromatzero
15203 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15204
15205 @item set rdiheartbeat
15206 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
15207 @cindex RDI heartbeat
15208 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
15209 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
15210 well as the Angel monitor.
15211
15212 @item show rdiheartbeat
15213 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
15214 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
15215 @end table
15216
15217
15218 @node M32R/D
15219 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
15220
15221 @table @code
15222 @kindex target m32r
15223 @item target m32r @var{dev}
15224 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
15225
15226 @kindex target m32rsdi
15227 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
15228 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
15229 @end table
15230
15231 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
15232
15233 @table @code
15234 @item set download-path @var{path}
15235 @kindex set download-path
15236 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
15237 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15238
15239 @item show download-path
15240 @kindex show download-path
15241 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15242
15243 @item set board-address @var{addr}
15244 @kindex set board-address
15245 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
15246 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
15247
15248 @item show board-address
15249 @kindex show board-address
15250 Show the current IP address of the target board.
15251
15252 @item set server-address @var{addr}
15253 @kindex set server-address
15254 @cindex download server address (M32R)
15255 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15256 host machine.
15257
15258 @item show server-address
15259 @kindex show server-address
15260 Display the IP address of the download server.
15261
15262 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15263 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15264 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15265 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15266 executable file is uploaded.
15267
15268 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15269 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15270 Test the @code{upload} command.
15271 @end table
15272
15273 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15274
15275 @table @code
15276 @item sdireset
15277 @kindex sdireset
15278 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15279 This command resets the SDI connection.
15280
15281 @item sdistatus
15282 @kindex sdistatus
15283 This command shows the SDI connection status.
15284
15285 @item debug_chaos
15286 @kindex debug_chaos
15287 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15288 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15289
15290 @item use_debug_dma
15291 @kindex use_debug_dma
15292 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15293
15294 @item use_mon_code
15295 @kindex use_mon_code
15296 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15297
15298 @item use_ib_break
15299 @kindex use_ib_break
15300 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15301
15302 @item use_dbt_break
15303 @kindex use_dbt_break
15304 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15305 @end table
15306
15307 @node M68K
15308 @subsection M68k
15309
15310 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15311 target command for the following ROM monitor.
15312
15313 @table @code
15314
15315 @kindex target dbug
15316 @item target dbug @var{dev}
15317 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15318
15319 @end table
15320
15321 @node MIPS Embedded
15322 @subsection MIPS Embedded
15323
15324 @cindex MIPS boards
15325 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15326 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15327 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15328
15329 @need 1000
15330 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15331
15332 @table @code
15333 @item target mips @var{port}
15334 @kindex target mips @var{port}
15335 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15336 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15337 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15338 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15339 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15340 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15341
15342 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15343 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15344 debugger:
15345
15346 @smallexample
15347 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15348 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15349 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15350 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15351 (@value{GDBP}) run
15352 @end smallexample
15353
15354 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15355 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15356 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15357 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15358 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15359
15360 @item target pmon @var{port}
15361 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
15362 PMON ROM monitor.
15363
15364 @item target ddb @var{port}
15365 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
15366 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15367
15368 @item target lsi @var{port}
15369 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
15370 LSI variant of PMON.
15371
15372 @kindex target r3900
15373 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
15374 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15375
15376 @kindex target array
15377 @item target array @var{dev}
15378 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15379
15380 @end table
15381
15382
15383 @noindent
15384 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15385
15386 @table @code
15387 @item set mipsfpu double
15388 @itemx set mipsfpu single
15389 @itemx set mipsfpu none
15390 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
15391 @itemx show mipsfpu
15392 @kindex set mipsfpu
15393 @kindex show mipsfpu
15394 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
15395 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15396 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15397 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15398 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15399 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15400 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15401 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15402 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15403 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15404 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15405 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15406 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15407
15408 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15409 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15410 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15411
15412 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15413 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15414
15415 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15416 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15417 @itemx show timeout
15418 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15419 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15420 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15421 @kindex set timeout
15422 @kindex show timeout
15423 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15424 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15425 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15426 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15427 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15428 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
15429 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15430 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15431 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15432 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15433
15434 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15435 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15436 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15437 to run before stopping.
15438
15439 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15440 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15441 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15442 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15443 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15444 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15445
15446 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15447 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15448 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15449 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15450
15451 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15452 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15453 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15454 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15455 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15456 @table @asis
15457 @item pmon target
15458 @samp{PMON}
15459 @item ddb target
15460 @samp{NEC010}
15461 @item lsi target
15462 @samp{PMON>}
15463 @end table
15464
15465 @item show monitor-prompt
15466 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15467 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15468 remote monitor.
15469
15470 @item set monitor-warnings
15471 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15472 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15473 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15474 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15475 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15476
15477 @item show monitor-warnings
15478 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15479 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15480
15481 @item pmon @var{command}
15482 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15483 @cindex send PMON command
15484 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15485 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15486 @end table
15487
15488 @node OpenRISC 1000
15489 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15490 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15491
15492 @cindex or1k boards
15493 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15494 about platform and commands.
15495
15496 @table @code
15497
15498 @kindex target jtag
15499 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15500
15501 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15502 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15503 connected via parallel port to the board.
15504
15505 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15506
15507 @kindex or1ksim
15508 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15509 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15510 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15511
15512 @kindex info or1k spr
15513 @item info or1k spr
15514 Displays spr groups.
15515
15516 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15517 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15518 Displays register names in selected group.
15519
15520 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15521 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15522 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15523 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15524 Shows information about specified spr register.
15525
15526 @kindex spr
15527 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15528 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15529 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15530 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15531 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15532 @end table
15533
15534 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15535 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15536 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15537 triggers can be set using:
15538 @table @code
15539 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15540 Load effective address/data
15541 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15542 Store effective address/data
15543 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15544 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15545 @item $FETCH
15546 Fetch data
15547 @end table
15548
15549 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15550 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15551
15552 @code{htrace} commands:
15553 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15554 @table @code
15555 @kindex hwatch
15556 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15557 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15558 or Data. For example:
15559
15560 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15561
15562 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15563
15564 @kindex htrace
15565 @item htrace info
15566 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15567
15568 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15569 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15570
15571 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15572 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15573
15574 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15575 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15576
15577 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15578 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15579 triggered.
15580
15581 @item htrace enable
15582 @itemx htrace disable
15583 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15584
15585 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15586 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15587
15588 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15589 will be written there.
15590
15591 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15592 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15593
15594 @item htrace mode continuous
15595 Set continuous trace mode.
15596
15597 @item htrace mode suspend
15598 Set suspend trace mode.
15599
15600 @end table
15601
15602 @node PowerPC Embedded
15603 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
15604
15605 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15606
15607 @table @code
15608 @kindex set powerpc
15609 @item set powerpc soft-float
15610 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15611 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15612 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15613 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15614
15615 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15616 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15617 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15618 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15619 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15620 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15621 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15622 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15623
15624 @kindex target dink32
15625 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15626 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15627
15628 @kindex target ppcbug
15629 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15630 @kindex target ppcbug1
15631 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15632 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15633
15634 @kindex target sds
15635 @item target sds @var{dev}
15636 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15637 @end table
15638
15639 @cindex SDS protocol
15640 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15641 by @value{GDBN}:
15642
15643 @table @code
15644 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15645 @kindex set sdstimeout
15646 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15647 default is 2 seconds.
15648
15649 @item show sdstimeout
15650 @kindex show sdstimeout
15651 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15652
15653 @item sds @var{command}
15654 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15655 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15656 @end table
15657
15658
15659 @node PA
15660 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15661
15662 @table @code
15663
15664 @kindex target op50n
15665 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15666 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15667
15668 @kindex target w89k
15669 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15670 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15671
15672 @end table
15673
15674 @node Sparclet
15675 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15676
15677 @cindex Sparclet
15678
15679 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15680 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15681 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15682 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15683 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15684
15685 @table @code
15686 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15687 @kindex remotetimeout
15688 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15689 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15690 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15691 @end table
15692
15693 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15694 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15695 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15696 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15697 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15698
15699 @smallexample
15700 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15701 @end smallexample
15702
15703 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15704
15705 @smallexample
15706 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15707 @end smallexample
15708
15709 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15710 Once you have set
15711 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15712 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15713 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15714
15715 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15716
15717 @smallexample
15718 (gdbslet)
15719 @end smallexample
15720
15721 @menu
15722 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15723 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15724 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15725 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15726 @end menu
15727
15728 @node Sparclet File
15729 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15730
15731 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15732
15733 @smallexample
15734 (gdbslet) file prog
15735 @end smallexample
15736
15737 @need 1000
15738 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15739 @value{GDBN} locates
15740 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15741 path.
15742 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15743 files will be searched as well.
15744 @value{GDBN} locates
15745 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15746 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15747 If it fails
15748 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15749
15750 @smallexample
15751 prog: No such file or directory.
15752 @end smallexample
15753
15754 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15755 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15756 @code{target} command again.
15757
15758 @node Sparclet Connection
15759 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15760
15761 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15762 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15763
15764 @smallexample
15765 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15766 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15767 main () at ../prog.c:3
15768 @end smallexample
15769
15770 @need 750
15771 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15772
15773 @smallexample
15774 Connected to ttya.
15775 @end smallexample
15776
15777 @node Sparclet Download
15778 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15779
15780 @cindex download to Sparclet
15781 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15782 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15783 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15784 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15785 command.
15786 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15787 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15788 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15789 of each of the file's sections.
15790 For instance, if the program
15791 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15792 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15793
15794 @smallexample
15795 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15796 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15797 @end smallexample
15798
15799 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15800 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15801 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15802
15803 @node Sparclet Execution
15804 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15805
15806 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15807 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15808 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15809 manual for the list of commands.
15810
15811 @smallexample
15812 (gdbslet) b main
15813 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15814 (gdbslet) run
15815 Starting program: prog
15816 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15817 3 char *symarg = 0;
15818 (gdbslet) step
15819 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15820 (gdbslet)
15821 @end smallexample
15822
15823 @node Sparclite
15824 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15825
15826 @table @code
15827
15828 @kindex target sparclite
15829 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15830 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15831 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15832 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15833 remote protocol.
15834
15835 @end table
15836
15837 @node Z8000
15838 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15839
15840 @cindex Z8000
15841 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15842 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15843
15844 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15845 a Z8000 simulator.
15846
15847 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15848 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15849 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15850 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15851
15852 @table @code
15853 @item target sim @var{args}
15854 @kindex sim
15855 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15856 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15857 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15858 @end table
15859
15860 @noindent
15861 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15862 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15863 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15864 to run your program, and so on.
15865
15866 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15867 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15868 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15869
15870 @table @code
15871
15872 @item cycles
15873 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15874
15875 @item insts
15876 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15877
15878 @item time
15879 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15880
15881 @end table
15882
15883 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15884 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15885 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15886 simulated clock ticks.
15887
15888 @node AVR
15889 @subsection Atmel AVR
15890 @cindex AVR
15891
15892 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15893 following AVR-specific commands:
15894
15895 @table @code
15896 @item info io_registers
15897 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15898 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15899 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15900 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15901 @end table
15902
15903 @node CRIS
15904 @subsection CRIS
15905 @cindex CRIS
15906
15907 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15908 following CRIS-specific commands:
15909
15910 @table @code
15911 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15912 @cindex CRIS version
15913 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15914 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15915 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15916
15917 @item show cris-version
15918 Show the current CRIS version.
15919
15920 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15921 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15922 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15923 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15924 @code{R59}.
15925
15926 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15927 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15928
15929 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15930 @cindex CRIS mode
15931 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15932 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15933 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15934
15935 @item show cris-mode
15936 Show the current CRIS mode.
15937 @end table
15938
15939 @node Super-H
15940 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15941 @cindex Super-H
15942
15943 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15944 commands:
15945
15946 @table @code
15947 @item regs
15948 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15949 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15950
15951 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
15952 @kindex set sh calling-convention
15953 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
15954 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
15955 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
15956 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
15957 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
15958 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
15959 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
15960 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
15961 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
15962 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
15963
15964 @item show sh calling-convention
15965 @kindex show sh calling-convention
15966 Show the current calling convention setting.
15967
15968 @end table
15969
15970
15971 @node Architectures
15972 @section Architectures
15973
15974 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15975 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15976
15977 @menu
15978 * i386::
15979 * A29K::
15980 * Alpha::
15981 * MIPS::
15982 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15983 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15984 * PowerPC::
15985 @end menu
15986
15987 @node i386
15988 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15989
15990 @table @code
15991 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15992 @kindex set struct-convention
15993 @cindex struct return convention
15994 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15995 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15996 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15997 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15998 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15999 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
16000 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
16001 be returned in a register.
16002
16003 @item show struct-convention
16004 @kindex show struct-convention
16005 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
16006 from functions.
16007 @end table
16008
16009 @node A29K
16010 @subsection A29K
16011
16012 @table @code
16013
16014 @kindex set rstack_high_address
16015 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
16016 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
16017 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
16018 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
16019 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
16020 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
16021 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
16022 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
16023 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
16024 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
16025 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
16026 hexadecimal.
16027
16028 @kindex show rstack_high_address
16029 @item show rstack_high_address
16030 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
16031 processors.
16032
16033 @end table
16034
16035 @node Alpha
16036 @subsection Alpha
16037
16038 See the following section.
16039
16040 @node MIPS
16041 @subsection MIPS
16042
16043 @cindex stack on Alpha
16044 @cindex stack on MIPS
16045 @cindex Alpha stack
16046 @cindex MIPS stack
16047 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
16048 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
16049 find the beginning of a function.
16050
16051 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
16052 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
16053 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
16054 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
16055 commands:
16056
16057 @table @code
16058 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
16059 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
16060 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
16061 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
16062 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
16063 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
16064 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
16065 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
16066
16067 @item show heuristic-fence-post
16068 Display the current limit.
16069 @end table
16070
16071 @noindent
16072 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
16073 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
16074
16075 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
16076 programs:
16077
16078 @table @code
16079 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
16080 @kindex set mips abi
16081 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
16082 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
16083 values of @var{arg} are:
16084
16085 @table @samp
16086 @item auto
16087 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
16088 default).
16089 @item o32
16090 @item o64
16091 @item n32
16092 @item n64
16093 @item eabi32
16094 @item eabi64
16095 @item auto
16096 @end table
16097
16098 @item show mips abi
16099 @kindex show mips abi
16100 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
16101
16102 @item set mipsfpu
16103 @itemx show mipsfpu
16104 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
16105
16106 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
16107 @kindex set mips mask-address
16108 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
16109 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
16110 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
16111 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
16112 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
16113
16114 @item show mips mask-address
16115 @kindex show mips mask-address
16116 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16117 not.
16118
16119 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16120 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16121 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16122 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16123 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16124 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16125
16126 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16127 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16128 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16129
16130 @item set debug mips
16131 @kindex set debug mips
16132 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16133 target code in @value{GDBN}.
16134
16135 @item show debug mips
16136 @kindex show debug mips
16137 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16138 @end table
16139
16140
16141 @node HPPA
16142 @subsection HPPA
16143 @cindex HPPA support
16144
16145 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16146 following special commands:
16147
16148 @table @code
16149 @item set debug hppa
16150 @kindex set debug hppa
16151 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16152 messages are to be displayed.
16153
16154 @item show debug hppa
16155 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16156
16157 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
16158 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16159 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16160 given @var{address}.
16161
16162 @end table
16163
16164
16165 @node SPU
16166 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16167 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16168 @cindex SPU
16169
16170 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16171 it provides the following special commands:
16172
16173 @table @code
16174 @item info spu event
16175 @kindex info spu
16176 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16177 and pending event status.
16178
16179 @item info spu signal
16180 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16181 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16182 notification channels.
16183
16184 @item info spu mailbox
16185 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16186 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16187 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16188
16189 @item info spu dma
16190 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16191 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16192 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16193
16194 @item info spu proxydma
16195 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16196 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16197 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16198
16199 @end table
16200
16201 @node PowerPC
16202 @subsection PowerPC
16203 @cindex PowerPC architecture
16204
16205 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16206 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16207 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16208 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
16209 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
16210
16211 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
16212 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
16213 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
16214
16215
16216 @node Controlling GDB
16217 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
16218
16219 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
16220 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
16221 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
16222 described here.
16223
16224 @menu
16225 * Prompt:: Prompt
16226 * Editing:: Command editing
16227 * Command History:: Command history
16228 * Screen Size:: Screen size
16229 * Numbers:: Numbers
16230 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
16231 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
16232 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
16233 @end menu
16234
16235 @node Prompt
16236 @section Prompt
16237
16238 @cindex prompt
16239
16240 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
16241 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
16242 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
16243 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
16244 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
16245 which one you are talking to.
16246
16247 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16248 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16249 or a prompt that does not.
16250
16251 @table @code
16252 @kindex set prompt
16253 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16254 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16255
16256 @kindex show prompt
16257 @item show prompt
16258 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16259 @end table
16260
16261 @node Editing
16262 @section Command Editing
16263 @cindex readline
16264 @cindex command line editing
16265
16266 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16267 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16268 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16269 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16270 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16271 debugging sessions.
16272
16273 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16274 command @code{set}.
16275
16276 @table @code
16277 @kindex set editing
16278 @cindex editing
16279 @item set editing
16280 @itemx set editing on
16281 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16282
16283 @item set editing off
16284 Disable command line editing.
16285
16286 @kindex show editing
16287 @item show editing
16288 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16289 @end table
16290
16291 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16292 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16293 encouraged to read that chapter.
16294
16295 @node Command History
16296 @section Command History
16297 @cindex command history
16298
16299 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16300 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16301 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16302 history facility.
16303
16304 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16305 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16306 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16307
16308 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16309 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16310 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16311 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16312 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16313 pressed on a line by itself.
16314
16315 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16316 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16317 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16318 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16319
16320 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16321 history.
16322
16323 @table @code
16324 @cindex history substitution
16325 @cindex history file
16326 @kindex set history filename
16327 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16328 @item set history filename @var{fname}
16329 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16330 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16331 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16332 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16333 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16334 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16335 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16336 is not set.
16337
16338 @cindex save command history
16339 @kindex set history save
16340 @item set history save
16341 @itemx set history save on
16342 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16343 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16344
16345 @item set history save off
16346 Stop recording command history in a file.
16347
16348 @cindex history size
16349 @kindex set history size
16350 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16351 @item set history size @var{size}
16352 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16353 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16354 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16355 @end table
16356
16357 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16358 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16359
16360 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16361 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16362 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16363 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16364 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16365 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16366 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16367 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16368
16369 The commands to control history expansion are:
16370
16371 @table @code
16372 @item set history expansion on
16373 @itemx set history expansion
16374 @kindex set history expansion
16375 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16376
16377 @item set history expansion off
16378 Disable history expansion.
16379
16380 @c @group
16381 @kindex show history
16382 @item show history
16383 @itemx show history filename
16384 @itemx show history save
16385 @itemx show history size
16386 @itemx show history expansion
16387 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16388 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16389 @c @end group
16390 @end table
16391
16392 @table @code
16393 @kindex show commands
16394 @cindex show last commands
16395 @cindex display command history
16396 @item show commands
16397 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16398
16399 @item show commands @var{n}
16400 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16401
16402 @item show commands +
16403 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16404 @end table
16405
16406 @node Screen Size
16407 @section Screen Size
16408 @cindex size of screen
16409 @cindex pauses in output
16410
16411 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16412 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16413 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16414 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16415 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16416 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16417 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16418 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16419
16420 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16421 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16422 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16423 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16424 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16425 width} commands:
16426
16427 @table @code
16428 @kindex set height
16429 @kindex set width
16430 @kindex show width
16431 @kindex show height
16432 @item set height @var{lpp}
16433 @itemx show height
16434 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
16435 @itemx show width
16436 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16437 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16438 commands display the current settings.
16439
16440 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16441 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16442 file or to an editor buffer.
16443
16444 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16445 from wrapping its output.
16446
16447 @item set pagination on
16448 @itemx set pagination off
16449 @kindex set pagination
16450 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16451 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16452
16453 @item show pagination
16454 @kindex show pagination
16455 Show the current pagination mode.
16456 @end table
16457
16458 @node Numbers
16459 @section Numbers
16460 @cindex number representation
16461 @cindex entering numbers
16462
16463 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16464 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16465 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16466 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16467 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16468 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16469 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16470 both input and output with the commands described below.
16471
16472 @table @code
16473 @kindex set input-radix
16474 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16475 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16476 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16477 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16478 example, any of
16479
16480 @smallexample
16481 set input-radix 012
16482 set input-radix 10.
16483 set input-radix 0xa
16484 @end smallexample
16485
16486 @noindent
16487 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16488 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16489 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16490 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16491 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16492 change the radix.
16493
16494 @kindex set output-radix
16495 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16496 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16497 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16498 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16499
16500 @kindex show input-radix
16501 @item show input-radix
16502 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16503
16504 @kindex show output-radix
16505 @item show output-radix
16506 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16507
16508 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16509 @itemx show radix
16510 @kindex set radix
16511 @kindex show radix
16512 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16513 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16514 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16515 default value of 10.
16516
16517 @end table
16518
16519 @node ABI
16520 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16521
16522 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16523 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16524 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16525 current ABI.
16526
16527 @cindex OS ABI
16528 @kindex set osabi
16529 @kindex show osabi
16530
16531 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16532 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16533 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16534 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16535 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16536 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16537 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16538 platform provides.
16539
16540 @table @code
16541 @item show osabi
16542 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16543
16544 @item set osabi
16545 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16546
16547 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16548 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16549 @end table
16550
16551 @cindex float promotion
16552
16553 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16554 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16555 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16556 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16557 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16558 @code{double} and then passed.
16559
16560 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16561 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16562 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16563
16564 @table @code
16565 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16566 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16567 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16568 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16569 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16570
16571 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16572 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16573 functions.
16574
16575 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16576 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16577 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16578 @end table
16579
16580 @kindex set cp-abi
16581 @kindex show cp-abi
16582 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16583 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16584 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16585 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16586 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16587 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16588 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16589 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16590 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16591 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16592 ``auto''.
16593
16594 @table @code
16595 @item show cp-abi
16596 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16597
16598 @item set cp-abi
16599 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16600
16601 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16602 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16603 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16604 @end table
16605
16606 @node Messages/Warnings
16607 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16608
16609 @cindex verbose operation
16610 @cindex optional warnings
16611 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16612 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16613 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16614 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16615
16616 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16617 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16618 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16619
16620 @table @code
16621 @kindex set verbose
16622 @item set verbose on
16623 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16624
16625 @item set verbose off
16626 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16627
16628 @kindex show verbose
16629 @item show verbose
16630 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16631 @end table
16632
16633 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16634 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16635 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16636 Symbol Files}).
16637
16638 @table @code
16639
16640 @kindex set complaints
16641 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16642 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16643 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16644 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16645 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16646
16647 @kindex show complaints
16648 @item show complaints
16649 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16650
16651 @end table
16652
16653 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16654 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16655 you try to run a program which is already running:
16656
16657 @smallexample
16658 (@value{GDBP}) run
16659 The program being debugged has been started already.
16660 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16661 @end smallexample
16662
16663 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16664 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16665
16666 @table @code
16667
16668 @kindex set confirm
16669 @cindex flinching
16670 @cindex confirmation
16671 @cindex stupid questions
16672 @item set confirm off
16673 Disables confirmation requests.
16674
16675 @item set confirm on
16676 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16677
16678 @kindex show confirm
16679 @item show confirm
16680 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16681
16682 @end table
16683
16684 @cindex command tracing
16685 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16686 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16687 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16688 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16689
16690 @table @code
16691 @kindex set trace-commands
16692 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16693 @item set trace-commands on
16694 Enable command tracing.
16695 @item set trace-commands off
16696 Disable command tracing.
16697 @item show trace-commands
16698 Display the current state of command tracing.
16699 @end table
16700
16701 @node Debugging Output
16702 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16703 @cindex optional debugging messages
16704
16705 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16706 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16707 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16708 section documents those commands.
16709
16710 @table @code
16711 @kindex set exec-done-display
16712 @item set exec-done-display
16713 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16714 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16715 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16716 @kindex show exec-done-display
16717 @item show exec-done-display
16718 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16719 notification.
16720 @kindex set debug
16721 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16722 @cindex architecture debugging info
16723 @item set debug arch
16724 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16725 @kindex show debug
16726 @item show debug arch
16727 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16728 @item set debug aix-thread
16729 @cindex AIX threads
16730 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16731 module.
16732 @item show debug aix-thread
16733 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16734 @item set debug displaced
16735 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
16736 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
16737 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
16738 @item show debug displaced
16739 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
16740 related to displaced stepping.
16741 @item set debug event
16742 @cindex event debugging info
16743 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16744 default is off.
16745 @item show debug event
16746 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16747 info.
16748 @item set debug expression
16749 @cindex expression debugging info
16750 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16751 expression parsing. The default is off.
16752 @item show debug expression
16753 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16754 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16755 @item set debug frame
16756 @cindex frame debugging info
16757 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16758 default is off.
16759 @item show debug frame
16760 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16761 info.
16762 @item set debug infrun
16763 @cindex inferior debugging info
16764 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16765 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16766 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16767 @item show debug infrun
16768 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16769 @item set debug lin-lwp
16770 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16771 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16772 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16773 @item show debug lin-lwp
16774 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16775 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
16776 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
16777 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16778 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
16779 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
16780 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
16781 @item set debug observer
16782 @cindex observer debugging info
16783 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16784 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16785 @item show debug observer
16786 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16787 @item set debug overload
16788 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16789 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16790 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16791 is off.
16792 @item show debug overload
16793 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16794 debugging info.
16795 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16796 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16797 @cindex debug remote protocol
16798 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16799 @cindex display remote packets
16800 @item set debug remote
16801 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16802 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16803 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16804 @item show debug remote
16805 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16806 @item set debug serial
16807 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16808 default is off.
16809 @item show debug serial
16810 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16811 info.
16812 @item set debug solib-frv
16813 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16814 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16815 @item show debug solib-frv
16816 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16817 messages.
16818 @item set debug target
16819 @cindex target debugging info
16820 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16821 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16822 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16823 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16824 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16825 @item show debug target
16826 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16827 info.
16828 @item set debug timestamp
16829 @cindex timestampping debugging info
16830 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
16831 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
16832 message.
16833 @item show debug timestamp
16834 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
16835 debugging info.
16836 @item set debugvarobj
16837 @cindex variable object debugging info
16838 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16839 info. The default is off.
16840 @item show debugvarobj
16841 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16842 debugging info.
16843 @item set debug xml
16844 @cindex XML parser debugging
16845 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16846 @item show debug xml
16847 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16848 @end table
16849
16850 @node Sequences
16851 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16852
16853 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16854 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16855 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16856 files.
16857
16858 @menu
16859 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16860 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16861 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16862 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16863 @end menu
16864
16865 @node Define
16866 @section User-defined Commands
16867
16868 @cindex user-defined command
16869 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16870 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16871 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16872 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16873 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16874 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16875
16876 @smallexample
16877 define adder
16878 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16879 end
16880 @end smallexample
16881
16882 @noindent
16883 To execute the command use:
16884
16885 @smallexample
16886 adder 1 2 3
16887 @end smallexample
16888
16889 @noindent
16890 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16891 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16892 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16893 functions calls.
16894
16895 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16896 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16897 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16898 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16899
16900 @smallexample
16901 define adder
16902 if $argc == 2
16903 print $arg0 + $arg1
16904 end
16905 if $argc == 3
16906 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16907 end
16908 end
16909 @end smallexample
16910
16911 @table @code
16912
16913 @kindex define
16914 @item define @var{commandname}
16915 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16916 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16917
16918 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16919 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16920 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16921
16922 @kindex document
16923 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16924 @item document @var{commandname}
16925 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16926 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16927 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16928 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16929 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16930 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16931
16932 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16933 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16934 does not change the documentation.
16935
16936 @kindex dont-repeat
16937 @cindex don't repeat command
16938 @item dont-repeat
16939 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16940 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16941 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16942
16943 @kindex help user-defined
16944 @item help user-defined
16945 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16946 (if any) for each.
16947
16948 @kindex show user
16949 @item show user
16950 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16951 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16952 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16953 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16954
16955 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16956 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16957 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16958 @item show max-user-call-depth
16959 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16960 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16961 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16962 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16963 @end table
16964
16965 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16966 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16967
16968 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16969 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16970 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16971
16972 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16973 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16974 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16975 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16976
16977 @node Hooks
16978 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16979 @cindex command hooks
16980 @cindex hooks, for commands
16981 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16982
16983 @kindex hook
16984 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16985 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16986 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16987 before that command.
16988
16989 @cindex hooks, post-command
16990 @kindex hookpost
16991 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16992 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16993 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16994 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16995 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16996
16997 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16998 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16999
17000 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
17001 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
17002
17003 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
17004 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
17005 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
17006 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
17007 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
17008
17009 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
17010 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
17011 you could define:
17012
17013 @smallexample
17014 define hook-stop
17015 handle SIGALRM nopass
17016 end
17017
17018 define hook-run
17019 handle SIGALRM pass
17020 end
17021
17022 define hook-continue
17023 handle SIGALRM pass
17024 end
17025 @end smallexample
17026
17027 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
17028 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
17029 you could define:
17030
17031 @smallexample
17032 define hook-echo
17033 echo <<<---
17034 end
17035
17036 define hookpost-echo
17037 echo --->>>\n
17038 end
17039
17040 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
17041 <<<---Hello World--->>>
17042 (@value{GDBP})
17043
17044 @end smallexample
17045
17046 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
17047 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
17048 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
17049 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
17050 @c or not?
17051 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
17052 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
17053 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
17054
17055 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
17056 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
17057
17058 @node Command Files
17059 @section Command Files
17060
17061 @cindex command files
17062 @cindex scripting commands
17063 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
17064 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
17065 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
17066 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
17067 terminal.
17068
17069 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
17070 command:
17071
17072 @table @code
17073 @kindex source
17074 @cindex execute commands from a file
17075 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
17076 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
17077 @end table
17078
17079 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
17080 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
17081 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
17082 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
17083 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
17084
17085 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
17086 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
17087
17088 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
17089 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
17090 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
17091
17092 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
17093 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
17094 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
17095 when called from command files.
17096
17097 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
17098 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
17099 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
17100 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
17101 the next command.
17102
17103 @smallexample
17104 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
17105 @end smallexample
17106
17107 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
17108 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
17109 would be directed to @file{log}.
17110
17111 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
17112 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
17113 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
17114 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17115 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17116 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17117 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17118 conditionally, etc.
17119
17120 @table @code
17121 @kindex if
17122 @kindex else
17123 @item if
17124 @itemx else
17125 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17126 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17127 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17128 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17129 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17130 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17131 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17132
17133 @kindex while
17134 @item while
17135 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17136 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17137 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17138 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17139 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17140 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17141
17142 @kindex loop_break
17143 @item loop_break
17144 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17145 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17146 line.
17147
17148 @kindex loop_continue
17149 @item loop_continue
17150 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17151 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17152 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17153 the controlling expression.
17154
17155 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17156 @item end
17157 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17158 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17159 @end table
17160
17161
17162 @node Output
17163 @section Commands for Controlled Output
17164
17165 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17166 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17167 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17168 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17169 want.
17170
17171 @table @code
17172 @kindex echo
17173 @item echo @var{text}
17174 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17175 @c because it is not in ANSI.
17176 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17177 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
17178 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
17179 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
17180 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
17181 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
17182 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
17183 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
17184 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
17185
17186 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
17187 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
17188
17189 @smallexample
17190 echo This is some text\n\
17191 which is continued\n\
17192 onto several lines.\n
17193 @end smallexample
17194
17195 produces the same output as
17196
17197 @smallexample
17198 echo This is some text\n
17199 echo which is continued\n
17200 echo onto several lines.\n
17201 @end smallexample
17202
17203 @kindex output
17204 @item output @var{expression}
17205 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
17206 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
17207 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
17208 on expressions.
17209
17210 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
17211 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
17212 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
17213 Formats}, for more information.
17214
17215 @kindex printf
17216 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
17217 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
17218 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
17219 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
17220 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
17221 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
17222 executing the code below:
17223
17224 @smallexample
17225 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
17226 @end smallexample
17227
17228 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
17229 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
17230 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
17231 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
17232 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
17233 printed.
17234
17235 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
17236
17237 @smallexample
17238 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
17239 @end smallexample
17240
17241 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
17242 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
17243 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
17244
17245 @itemize @bullet
17246 @item
17247 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17248
17249 @item
17250 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17251 width.
17252
17253 @item
17254 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17255 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17256
17257 @item
17258 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17259 supported.
17260
17261 @item
17262 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17263
17264 @item
17265 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17266 @end itemize
17267
17268 @noindent
17269 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17270 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17271 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17272 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17273
17274 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17275 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17276 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17277 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17278 supported.
17279
17280 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17281 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17282 together with a floating point specifier.
17283 letters:
17284
17285 @itemize @bullet
17286 @item
17287 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17288
17289 @item
17290 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17291
17292 @item
17293 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17294 @end itemize
17295
17296 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17297 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17298 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17299
17300 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17301 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17302
17303 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17304 @smallexample
17305 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17306 @end smallexample
17307
17308 @end table
17309
17310 @node Interpreters
17311 @chapter Command Interpreters
17312 @cindex command interpreters
17313
17314 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
17315 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
17316 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
17317
17318 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
17319 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
17320 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
17321 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
17322
17323 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
17324 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
17325 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
17326 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
17327
17328 @table @code
17329 @item console
17330 @cindex console interpreter
17331 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
17332 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
17333 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
17334
17335 @item mi
17336 @cindex mi interpreter
17337 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
17338 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
17339 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
17340 Interface}.
17341
17342 @item mi2
17343 @cindex mi2 interpreter
17344 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
17345
17346 @item mi1
17347 @cindex mi1 interpreter
17348 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
17349
17350 @end table
17351
17352 @cindex invoke another interpreter
17353 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
17354 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
17355 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
17356 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
17357 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
17358 the IDE inoperable!
17359
17360 @kindex interpreter-exec
17361 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
17362 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
17363 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
17364 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
17365
17366 @smallexample
17367 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
17368 @end smallexample
17369
17370 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17371 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17372
17373 @node TUI
17374 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17375 @cindex TUI
17376 @cindex Text User Interface
17377
17378 @menu
17379 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17380 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17381 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17382 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17383 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17384 @end menu
17385
17386 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17387 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17388 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17389 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17390 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17391 is available.
17392
17393 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17394 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17395 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17396 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17397 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17398 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17399
17400 @node TUI Overview
17401 @section TUI Overview
17402
17403 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17404
17405 @table @emph
17406 @item command
17407 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17408 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17409 managed using readline.
17410
17411 @item source
17412 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17413 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17414
17415 @item assembly
17416 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17417
17418 @item register
17419 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17420 when their values change.
17421 @end table
17422
17423 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17424 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17425 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17426 indicates the breakpoint type:
17427
17428 @table @code
17429 @item B
17430 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17431
17432 @item b
17433 Breakpoint which was never hit.
17434
17435 @item H
17436 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17437
17438 @item h
17439 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17440 @end table
17441
17442 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17443
17444 @table @code
17445 @item +
17446 Breakpoint is enabled.
17447
17448 @item -
17449 Breakpoint is disabled.
17450 @end table
17451
17452 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17453 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17454 changes.
17455
17456 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17457 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17458 layouts:
17459
17460 @itemize @bullet
17461 @item
17462 source only,
17463
17464 @item
17465 assembly only,
17466
17467 @item
17468 source and assembly,
17469
17470 @item
17471 source and registers, or
17472
17473 @item
17474 assembly and registers.
17475 @end itemize
17476
17477 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17478
17479 @table @emph
17480 @item target
17481 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17482 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17483
17484 @item process
17485 Gives the current process or thread number.
17486 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17487
17488 @item function
17489 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17490 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17491 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17492 the string @code{??} is displayed.
17493
17494 @item line
17495 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17496 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17497
17498 @item pc
17499 Indicates the current program counter address.
17500 @end table
17501
17502 @node TUI Keys
17503 @section TUI Key Bindings
17504 @cindex TUI key bindings
17505
17506 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17507 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17508 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17509
17510 @table @kbd
17511 @kindex C-x C-a
17512 @item C-x C-a
17513 @kindex C-x a
17514 @itemx C-x a
17515 @kindex C-x A
17516 @itemx C-x A
17517 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17518 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17519 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17520 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17521 The screen is then refreshed.
17522
17523 @kindex C-x 1
17524 @item C-x 1
17525 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17526 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17527 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17528
17529 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17530
17531 @kindex C-x 2
17532 @item C-x 2
17533 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17534 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17535 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17536 previous layout and the new one.
17537
17538 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17539
17540 @kindex C-x o
17541 @item C-x o
17542 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17543 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17544 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17545
17546 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17547
17548 @kindex C-x s
17549 @item C-x s
17550 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17551 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17552 @end table
17553
17554 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17555
17556 @table @asis
17557 @kindex PgUp
17558 @item @key{PgUp}
17559 Scroll the active window one page up.
17560
17561 @kindex PgDn
17562 @item @key{PgDn}
17563 Scroll the active window one page down.
17564
17565 @kindex Up
17566 @item @key{Up}
17567 Scroll the active window one line up.
17568
17569 @kindex Down
17570 @item @key{Down}
17571 Scroll the active window one line down.
17572
17573 @kindex Left
17574 @item @key{Left}
17575 Scroll the active window one column left.
17576
17577 @kindex Right
17578 @item @key{Right}
17579 Scroll the active window one column right.
17580
17581 @kindex C-L
17582 @item @kbd{C-L}
17583 Refresh the screen.
17584 @end table
17585
17586 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17587 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17588 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17589 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17590 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17591
17592 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17593 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17594 @cindex TUI single key mode
17595
17596 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17597 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17598 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17599
17600 @table @kbd
17601 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17602 @item c
17603 continue
17604
17605 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17606 @item d
17607 down
17608
17609 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17610 @item f
17611 finish
17612
17613 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17614 @item n
17615 next
17616
17617 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17618 @item q
17619 exit the SingleKey mode.
17620
17621 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17622 @item r
17623 run
17624
17625 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17626 @item s
17627 step
17628
17629 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17630 @item u
17631 up
17632
17633 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17634 @item v
17635 info locals
17636
17637 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17638 @item w
17639 where
17640 @end table
17641
17642 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17643 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17644 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17645 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17646 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17647 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17648
17649
17650 @node TUI Commands
17651 @section TUI-specific Commands
17652 @cindex TUI commands
17653
17654 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17655 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17656 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17657 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17658
17659 @table @code
17660 @item info win
17661 @kindex info win
17662 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17663
17664 @item layout next
17665 @kindex layout
17666 Display the next layout.
17667
17668 @item layout prev
17669 Display the previous layout.
17670
17671 @item layout src
17672 Display the source window only.
17673
17674 @item layout asm
17675 Display the assembly window only.
17676
17677 @item layout split
17678 Display the source and assembly window.
17679
17680 @item layout regs
17681 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17682
17683 @item focus next
17684 @kindex focus
17685 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17686
17687 @item focus prev
17688 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17689
17690 @item focus src
17691 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17692
17693 @item focus asm
17694 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17695
17696 @item focus regs
17697 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17698
17699 @item focus cmd
17700 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17701
17702 @item refresh
17703 @kindex refresh
17704 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17705
17706 @item tui reg float
17707 @kindex tui reg
17708 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17709
17710 @item tui reg general
17711 Show the general registers in the register window.
17712
17713 @item tui reg next
17714 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17715 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17716 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17717 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17718
17719 @item tui reg system
17720 Show the system registers in the register window.
17721
17722 @item update
17723 @kindex update
17724 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17725
17726 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17727 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17728 @kindex winheight
17729 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17730 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17731 decrease it.
17732
17733 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17734 @kindex tabset
17735 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17736 @end table
17737
17738 @node TUI Configuration
17739 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17740 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17741
17742 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17743
17744 @table @code
17745 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17746 @kindex set tui border-kind
17747 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17748 The possible values are the following:
17749 @table @code
17750 @item space
17751 Use a space character to draw the border.
17752
17753 @item ascii
17754 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17755
17756 @item acs
17757 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17758 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17759 @end table
17760
17761 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17762 @kindex set tui border-mode
17763 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17764 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17765 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17766 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17767 @table @code
17768 @item normal
17769 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17770
17771 @item standout
17772 Use standout mode.
17773
17774 @item reverse
17775 Use reverse video mode.
17776
17777 @item half
17778 Use half bright mode.
17779
17780 @item half-standout
17781 Use half bright and standout mode.
17782
17783 @item bold
17784 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17785
17786 @item bold-standout
17787 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17788 @end table
17789 @end table
17790
17791 @node Emacs
17792 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17793
17794 @cindex Emacs
17795 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17796 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17797 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17798 @value{GDBN}.
17799
17800 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17801 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17802 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17803 created Emacs buffer.
17804 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17805
17806 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17807 things:
17808
17809 @itemize @bullet
17810 @item
17811 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17812 the GUD buffer.
17813
17814 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17815 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17816
17817 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17818 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17819 in this way.
17820
17821 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17822 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17823 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17824 stop.
17825
17826 @item
17827 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17828
17829 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17830 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17831 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17832 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17833 and the source.
17834
17835 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17836 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17837 @end itemize
17838
17839 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17840 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17841 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17842 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17843
17844 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17845 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17846 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17847 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17848 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17849 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17850 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17851 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17852 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17853
17854 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17855 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17856 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17857 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17858
17859 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17860 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17861 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17862 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17863 one you want.
17864
17865 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17866 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17867
17868 @table @kbd
17869 @item C-h m
17870 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17871
17872 @item C-c C-s
17873 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17874 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17875
17876 @item C-c C-n
17877 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17878 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17879 to show the current file and location.
17880
17881 @item C-c C-i
17882 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17883 display window accordingly.
17884
17885 @item C-c C-f
17886 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17887 @code{finish} command.
17888
17889 @item C-c C-r
17890 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17891 command.
17892
17893 @item C-c <
17894 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17895 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17896 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17897
17898 @item C-c >
17899 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17900 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17901 @end table
17902
17903 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17904 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17905
17906 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17907 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17908 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17909 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17910 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17911 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17912 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17913
17914 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17915 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17916 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17917 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17918 frame.
17919
17920 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17921 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17922 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17923 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17924 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17925 to correspond properly with the code.
17926
17927 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17928 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17929 Emacs Manual}).
17930
17931 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17932 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17933 @ignore
17934 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17935 @kindex Epoch
17936 @kindex inspect
17937
17938 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17939 called the @code{epoch}
17940 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17941 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17942 each value is printed in its own window.
17943 @end ignore
17944
17945
17946 @node GDB/MI
17947 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17948
17949 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17950
17951 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17952 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17953 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17954 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17955 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17956 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17957
17958 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17959 in the form of a reference manual.
17960
17961 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17962 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17963 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17964
17965 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17966
17967 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17968 This chapter uses the following notation:
17969
17970 @itemize @bullet
17971 @item
17972 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17973
17974 @item
17975 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17976 it may or may not be given.
17977
17978 @item
17979 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17980 may repeat zero or more times.
17981
17982 @item
17983 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17984 may repeat one or more times.
17985
17986 @item
17987 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17988 @end itemize
17989
17990 @ignore
17991 @heading Dependencies
17992 @end ignore
17993
17994 @menu
17995 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17996 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17997 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17998 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17999 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
18000 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
18001 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
18002 * GDB/MI Program Context::
18003 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
18004 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
18005 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
18006 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
18007 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
18008 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
18009 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
18010 * GDB/MI File Commands::
18011 @ignore
18012 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
18013 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
18014 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
18015 @end ignore
18016 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
18017 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
18018 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
18019 @end menu
18020
18021 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18022 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
18023 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
18024
18025 @menu
18026 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
18027 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
18028 @end menu
18029
18030 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
18031 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
18032
18033 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
18034 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
18035 @table @code
18036 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
18037 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
18038
18039 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
18040 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
18041 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18042
18043 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
18044 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
18045 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
18046
18047 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
18048 "any sequence of digits"
18049
18050 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
18051 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
18052
18053 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
18054 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
18055
18056 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
18057 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
18058
18059 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
18060 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
18061 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
18062
18063 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
18064 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
18065
18066 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18067 @code{CR | CR-LF}
18068 @end table
18069
18070 @noindent
18071 Notes:
18072
18073 @itemize @bullet
18074 @item
18075 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
18076 output is described below.
18077
18078 @item
18079 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
18080 finishes.
18081
18082 @item
18083 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
18084 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
18085 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
18086 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
18087 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
18088 @end itemize
18089
18090 Pragmatics:
18091
18092 @itemize @bullet
18093 @item
18094 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
18095
18096 @item
18097 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
18098 @end itemize
18099
18100 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
18101 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
18102
18103 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
18104 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
18105 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
18106 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
18107 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
18108 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
18109
18110 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
18111 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
18112 @var{token}.
18113
18114 @table @code
18115 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
18116 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
18117
18118 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
18119 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18120
18121 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
18122 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
18123
18124 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
18125 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
18126
18127 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
18128 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
18129
18130 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
18131 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
18132
18133 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
18134 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
18135
18136 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
18137 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18138
18139 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
18140 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
18141
18142 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
18143 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
18144 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
18145
18146 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
18147 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
18148
18149 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
18150 @code{ @var{string} }
18151
18152 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
18153 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
18154
18155 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
18156 @code{@var{c-string}}
18157
18158 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
18159 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
18160
18161 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
18162 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
18163 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
18164
18165 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
18166 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
18167
18168 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
18169 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
18170
18171 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
18172 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
18173
18174 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
18175 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
18176
18177 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18178 @code{CR | CR-LF}
18179
18180 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
18181 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
18182 @end table
18183
18184 @noindent
18185 Notes:
18186
18187 @itemize @bullet
18188 @item
18189 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
18190
18191 @item
18192 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
18193 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
18194 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
18195 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
18196 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
18197 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
18198 prior command.
18199
18200 @item
18201 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18202 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
18203 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
18204 prefixed by @samp{+}.
18205
18206 @item
18207 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18208 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
18209 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
18210 @samp{*}.
18211
18212 @item
18213 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18214 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
18215 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
18216 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
18217
18218 @item
18219 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18220 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
18221 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
18222 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
18223
18224 @item
18225 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18226 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
18227 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
18228
18229 @item
18230 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18231 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
18232 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
18233 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
18234
18235 @item
18236 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18237 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
18238 @var{values}.
18239
18240
18241 @end itemize
18242
18243 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
18244 details about the various output records.
18245
18246 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18247 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
18248 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
18249
18250 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
18251 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
18252
18253 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
18254 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
18255 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
18256 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
18257 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
18258 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
18259
18260 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
18261 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
18262 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
18263
18264 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18265 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
18266 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
18267 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
18268
18269 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
18270 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
18271
18272 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
18273 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
18274 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
18275 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
18276 might change.
18277
18278 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
18279 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
18280 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
18281 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
18282
18283 @itemize @bullet
18284 @item
18285 New MI commands may be added.
18286
18287 @item
18288 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
18289
18290 @item
18291 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
18292 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
18293
18294 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
18295 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
18296
18297 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
18298 @c resolve inconsistencies.
18299 @end itemize
18300
18301 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
18302 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
18303 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
18304 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
18305 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
18306
18307 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
18308 @c version?
18309
18310 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
18311 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
18312 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
18313 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
18314 @cindex mailing lists
18315
18316 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18317 @node GDB/MI Output Records
18318 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
18319
18320 @menu
18321 * GDB/MI Result Records::
18322 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
18323 * GDB/MI Async Records::
18324 @end menu
18325
18326 @node GDB/MI Result Records
18327 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
18328
18329 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18330 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
18331 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
18332 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
18333
18334 @table @code
18335 @findex ^done
18336 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
18337 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
18338 values.
18339
18340 @item "^running"
18341 @findex ^running
18342 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
18343 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
18344 running.
18345
18346 @item "^connected"
18347 @findex ^connected
18348 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
18349
18350 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
18351 @findex ^error
18352 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
18353 error message.
18354
18355 @item "^exit"
18356 @findex ^exit
18357 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
18358
18359 @end table
18360
18361 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
18362 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
18363
18364 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
18365 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18366 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
18367 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
18368 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
18369
18370 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18371 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18372 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18373 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18374 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18375
18376 @table @code
18377 @item "~" @var{string-output}
18378 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18379 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18380
18381 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
18382 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18383 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18384 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18385
18386 @item "&" @var{string-output}
18387 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18388 internals.
18389 @end table
18390
18391 @node GDB/MI Async Records
18392 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
18393
18394 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18395 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
18396 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18397 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18398 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18399 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18400
18401 The following is the list of possible async records:
18402
18403 @table @code
18404
18405 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
18406 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
18407 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
18408 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
18409 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
18410 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
18411 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
18412 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
18413 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
18414 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
18415
18416 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18417 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
18418 following values:
18419
18420 @table @code
18421 @item breakpoint-hit
18422 A breakpoint was reached.
18423 @item watchpoint-trigger
18424 A watchpoint was triggered.
18425 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
18426 A read watchpoint was triggered.
18427 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
18428 An access watchpoint was triggered.
18429 @item function-finished
18430 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18431 @item location-reached
18432 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18433 @item watchpoint-scope
18434 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18435 @item end-stepping-range
18436 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18437 similar CLI command was accomplished.
18438 @item exited-signalled
18439 The inferior exited because of a signal.
18440 @item exited
18441 The inferior exited.
18442 @item exited-normally
18443 The inferior exited normally.
18444 @item signal-received
18445 A signal was received by the inferior.
18446 @end table
18447
18448 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}"
18449 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}"
18450 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
18451 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread.
18452 @end table
18453
18454
18455
18456 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18457 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18458 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18459 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18460
18461 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18462 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18463 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18464 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18465
18466 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18467 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18468
18469 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18470
18471 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18472 information of the breakpoint.
18473
18474 @smallexample
18475 -> -break-insert main
18476 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18477 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18478 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18479 <- (gdb)
18480 @end smallexample
18481
18482 @subheading Program Execution
18483
18484 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18485 reason that execution stopped.
18486
18487 @smallexample
18488 -> -exec-run
18489 <- ^running
18490 <- (gdb)
18491 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18492 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18493 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18494 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18495 <- (gdb)
18496 -> -exec-continue
18497 <- ^running
18498 <- (gdb)
18499 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18500 <- (gdb)
18501 @end smallexample
18502
18503 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18504
18505 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18506
18507 @smallexample
18508 -> (gdb)
18509 <- -gdb-exit
18510 <- ^exit
18511 @end smallexample
18512
18513 @subheading A Bad Command
18514
18515 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18516
18517 @smallexample
18518 -> -rubbish
18519 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18520 <- (gdb)
18521 @end smallexample
18522
18523
18524 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18525 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18526 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18527
18528 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18529 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18530
18531 @subheading Motivation
18532
18533 The motivation for this collection of commands.
18534
18535 @subheading Introduction
18536
18537 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18538
18539 @subheading Commands
18540
18541 For each command in the block, the following is described:
18542
18543 @subsubheading Synopsis
18544
18545 @smallexample
18546 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18547 @end smallexample
18548
18549 @subsubheading Result
18550
18551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18552
18553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18554
18555 @subsubheading Example
18556
18557 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18558 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18559
18560
18561 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18562 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18563 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18564
18565 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18566 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18567 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18568 breakpoints.
18569
18570 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18571 @findex -break-after
18572
18573 @subsubheading Synopsis
18574
18575 @smallexample
18576 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18577 @end smallexample
18578
18579 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18580 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18581 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18582 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18583
18584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18585
18586 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18587
18588 @subsubheading Example
18589
18590 @smallexample
18591 (gdb)
18592 -break-insert main
18593 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18594 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
18595 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18596 (gdb)
18597 -break-after 1 3
18598 ~
18599 ^done
18600 (gdb)
18601 -break-list
18602 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18603 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18604 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18605 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18606 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18607 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18608 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18609 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18610 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18611 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18612 (gdb)
18613 @end smallexample
18614
18615 @ignore
18616 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18617 @findex -break-catch
18618
18619 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18620 @findex -break-commands
18621 @end ignore
18622
18623
18624 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18625 @findex -break-condition
18626
18627 @subsubheading Synopsis
18628
18629 @smallexample
18630 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18631 @end smallexample
18632
18633 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18634 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18635 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18636 command below).
18637
18638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18639
18640 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18641
18642 @subsubheading Example
18643
18644 @smallexample
18645 (gdb)
18646 -break-condition 1 1
18647 ^done
18648 (gdb)
18649 -break-list
18650 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18651 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18652 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18653 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18654 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18655 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18656 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18657 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18658 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18659 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18660 (gdb)
18661 @end smallexample
18662
18663 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18664 @findex -break-delete
18665
18666 @subsubheading Synopsis
18667
18668 @smallexample
18669 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18670 @end smallexample
18671
18672 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18673 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18674
18675 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18676
18677 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18678
18679 @subsubheading Example
18680
18681 @smallexample
18682 (gdb)
18683 -break-delete 1
18684 ^done
18685 (gdb)
18686 -break-list
18687 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18688 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18689 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18690 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18691 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18692 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18693 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18694 body=[]@}
18695 (gdb)
18696 @end smallexample
18697
18698 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18699 @findex -break-disable
18700
18701 @subsubheading Synopsis
18702
18703 @smallexample
18704 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18705 @end smallexample
18706
18707 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18708 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18709
18710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18711
18712 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18713
18714 @subsubheading Example
18715
18716 @smallexample
18717 (gdb)
18718 -break-disable 2
18719 ^done
18720 (gdb)
18721 -break-list
18722 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18723 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18724 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18725 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18726 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18727 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18728 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18729 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18730 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18731 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18732 (gdb)
18733 @end smallexample
18734
18735 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18736 @findex -break-enable
18737
18738 @subsubheading Synopsis
18739
18740 @smallexample
18741 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18742 @end smallexample
18743
18744 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18745
18746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18747
18748 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18749
18750 @subsubheading Example
18751
18752 @smallexample
18753 (gdb)
18754 -break-enable 2
18755 ^done
18756 (gdb)
18757 -break-list
18758 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18759 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18760 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18761 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18762 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18763 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18764 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18765 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18766 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18767 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18768 (gdb)
18769 @end smallexample
18770
18771 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18772 @findex -break-info
18773
18774 @subsubheading Synopsis
18775
18776 @smallexample
18777 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18778 @end smallexample
18779
18780 @c REDUNDANT???
18781 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18782
18783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18784
18785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18786
18787 @subsubheading Example
18788 N.A.
18789
18790 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18791 @findex -break-insert
18792
18793 @subsubheading Synopsis
18794
18795 @smallexample
18796 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18797 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18798 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18799 @end smallexample
18800
18801 @noindent
18802 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18803
18804 @itemize @bullet
18805 @item function
18806 @c @item +offset
18807 @c @item -offset
18808 @c @item linenum
18809 @item filename:linenum
18810 @item filename:function
18811 @item *address
18812 @end itemize
18813
18814 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18815
18816 @table @samp
18817 @item -t
18818 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18819 @item -h
18820 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18821 @item -c @var{condition}
18822 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18823 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18824 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18825 @item -f
18826 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18827 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18828 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18829 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18830 cannot be parsed.
18831 @end table
18832
18833 @subsubheading Result
18834
18835 The result is in the form:
18836
18837 @smallexample
18838 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18839 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18840 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18841 times="@var{times}"@}
18842 @end smallexample
18843
18844 @noindent
18845 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18846 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18847 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18848 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18849 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18850 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18851 which use the same output).
18852
18853 Note: this format is open to change.
18854 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18855
18856 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18857
18858 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18859 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18860
18861 @subsubheading Example
18862
18863 @smallexample
18864 (gdb)
18865 -break-insert main
18866 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18867 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18868 (gdb)
18869 -break-insert -t foo
18870 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18871 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18872 (gdb)
18873 -break-list
18874 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18875 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18876 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18877 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18878 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18879 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18880 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18881 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18882 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18883 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18884 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18885 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18886 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18887 (gdb)
18888 -break-insert -r foo.*
18889 ~int foo(int, int);
18890 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18891 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18892 (gdb)
18893 @end smallexample
18894
18895 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18896 @findex -break-list
18897
18898 @subsubheading Synopsis
18899
18900 @smallexample
18901 -break-list
18902 @end smallexample
18903
18904 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18905
18906 @table @samp
18907 @item Number
18908 number of the breakpoint
18909 @item Type
18910 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18911 @item Disposition
18912 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18913 or @samp{nokeep}
18914 @item Enabled
18915 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18916 @item Address
18917 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18918 @item What
18919 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18920 name, line number
18921 @item Times
18922 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18923 @end table
18924
18925 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18926 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18927
18928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18929
18930 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18931
18932 @subsubheading Example
18933
18934 @smallexample
18935 (gdb)
18936 -break-list
18937 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18938 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18939 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18940 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18941 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18942 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18943 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18944 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18945 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18946 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18947 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18948 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18949 (gdb)
18950 @end smallexample
18951
18952 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18953
18954 @smallexample
18955 (gdb)
18956 -break-list
18957 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18958 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18959 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18960 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18961 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18962 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18963 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18964 body=[]@}
18965 (gdb)
18966 @end smallexample
18967
18968 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18969 @findex -break-watch
18970
18971 @subsubheading Synopsis
18972
18973 @smallexample
18974 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18975 @end smallexample
18976
18977 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18978 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18979 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18980 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18981 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18982 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18983 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18984 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18985
18986 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18987 breakpoints inserted.
18988
18989 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18990
18991 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18992 @samp{rwatch}.
18993
18994 @subsubheading Example
18995
18996 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18997
18998 @smallexample
18999 (gdb)
19000 -break-watch x
19001 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
19002 (gdb)
19003 -exec-continue
19004 ^running
19005 (gdb)
19006 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
19007 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
19008 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19009 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
19010 (gdb)
19011 @end smallexample
19012
19013 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
19014 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
19015 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
19016
19017 @smallexample
19018 (gdb)
19019 -break-watch C
19020 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
19021 (gdb)
19022 -exec-continue
19023 ^running
19024 (gdb)
19025 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
19026 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
19027 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19028 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19029 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
19030 (gdb)
19031 -exec-continue
19032 ^running
19033 (gdb)
19034 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
19035 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
19036 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19037 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19038 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19039 (gdb)
19040 @end smallexample
19041
19042 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
19043 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
19044 deleted.
19045
19046 @smallexample
19047 (gdb)
19048 -break-watch C
19049 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
19050 (gdb)
19051 -break-list
19052 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19053 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19054 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19055 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19056 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19057 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19058 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19059 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19060 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19061 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19062 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
19063 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
19064 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
19065 (gdb)
19066 -exec-continue
19067 ^running
19068 (gdb)
19069 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
19070 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
19071 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19072 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19073 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
19074 (gdb)
19075 -break-list
19076 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19077 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19078 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19079 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19080 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19081 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19082 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19083 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19084 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19085 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19086 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
19087 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
19088 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
19089 (gdb)
19090 -exec-continue
19091 ^running
19092 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
19093 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
19094 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19095 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19096 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19097 (gdb)
19098 -break-list
19099 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19100 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19101 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19102 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19103 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19104 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19105 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19106 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19107 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19108 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19109 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
19110 times="1"@}]@}
19111 (gdb)
19112 @end smallexample
19113
19114 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19115 @node GDB/MI Program Context
19116 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
19117
19118 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
19119 @findex -exec-arguments
19120
19121
19122 @subsubheading Synopsis
19123
19124 @smallexample
19125 -exec-arguments @var{args}
19126 @end smallexample
19127
19128 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
19129 @samp{-exec-run}.
19130
19131 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19132
19133 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
19134
19135 @subsubheading Example
19136
19137 @smallexample
19138 (gdb)
19139 -exec-arguments -v word
19140 ^done
19141 (gdb)
19142 @end smallexample
19143
19144
19145 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
19146 @findex -exec-show-arguments
19147
19148 @subsubheading Synopsis
19149
19150 @smallexample
19151 -exec-show-arguments
19152 @end smallexample
19153
19154 Print the arguments of the program.
19155
19156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19157
19158 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
19159
19160 @subsubheading Example
19161 N.A.
19162
19163
19164 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
19165 @findex -environment-cd
19166
19167 @subsubheading Synopsis
19168
19169 @smallexample
19170 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
19171 @end smallexample
19172
19173 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
19174
19175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19176
19177 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
19178
19179 @subsubheading Example
19180
19181 @smallexample
19182 (gdb)
19183 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19184 ^done
19185 (gdb)
19186 @end smallexample
19187
19188
19189 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
19190 @findex -environment-directory
19191
19192 @subsubheading Synopsis
19193
19194 @smallexample
19195 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19196 @end smallexample
19197
19198 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
19199 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
19200 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
19201 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19202 occurs as normal.
19203 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19204 multiple directories in a single command
19205 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19206 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19207 If blanks are needed as
19208 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19209 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19210 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19211 character must not be used
19212 in any directory name.
19213 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
19214
19215 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19216
19217 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
19218
19219 @subsubheading Example
19220
19221 @smallexample
19222 (gdb)
19223 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19224 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19225 (gdb)
19226 -environment-directory ""
19227 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19228 (gdb)
19229 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
19230 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
19231 (gdb)
19232 -environment-directory -r
19233 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
19234 (gdb)
19235 @end smallexample
19236
19237
19238 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
19239 @findex -environment-path
19240
19241 @subsubheading Synopsis
19242
19243 @smallexample
19244 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19245 @end smallexample
19246
19247 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
19248 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
19249 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
19250 supplied in addition to the
19251 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19252 occurs as normal.
19253 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19254 multiple directories in a single command
19255 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19256 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19257 If blanks are needed as
19258 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19259 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19260 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19261 character must not be used
19262 in any directory name.
19263 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
19264
19265
19266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19267
19268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
19269
19270 @subsubheading Example
19271
19272 @smallexample
19273 (gdb)
19274 -environment-path
19275 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
19276 (gdb)
19277 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
19278 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
19279 (gdb)
19280 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
19281 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
19282 (gdb)
19283 @end smallexample
19284
19285
19286 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
19287 @findex -environment-pwd
19288
19289 @subsubheading Synopsis
19290
19291 @smallexample
19292 -environment-pwd
19293 @end smallexample
19294
19295 Show the current working directory.
19296
19297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19298
19299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
19300
19301 @subsubheading Example
19302
19303 @smallexample
19304 (gdb)
19305 -environment-pwd
19306 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
19307 (gdb)
19308 @end smallexample
19309
19310 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19311 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
19312 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
19313
19314
19315 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
19316 @findex -thread-info
19317
19318 @subsubheading Synopsis
19319
19320 @smallexample
19321 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
19322 @end smallexample
19323
19324 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
19325 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
19326 threads. When printing information about all threads,
19327 also reports the current thread.
19328
19329 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19330
19331 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
19332 about all threads.
19333
19334 @subsubheading Example
19335
19336 @smallexample
19337 -thread-info
19338 ^done,threads=[
19339 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
19340 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
19341 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
19342 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
19343 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
19344 current-thread-id="1"
19345 (gdb)
19346 @end smallexample
19347
19348 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
19349 @findex -thread-list-ids
19350
19351 @subsubheading Synopsis
19352
19353 @smallexample
19354 -thread-list-ids
19355 @end smallexample
19356
19357 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
19358 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
19359
19360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19361
19362 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
19363
19364 @subsubheading Example
19365
19366 No threads present, besides the main process:
19367
19368 @smallexample
19369 (gdb)
19370 -thread-list-ids
19371 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
19372 (gdb)
19373 @end smallexample
19374
19375
19376 Several threads:
19377
19378 @smallexample
19379 (gdb)
19380 -thread-list-ids
19381 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19382 number-of-threads="3"
19383 (gdb)
19384 @end smallexample
19385
19386
19387 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
19388 @findex -thread-select
19389
19390 @subsubheading Synopsis
19391
19392 @smallexample
19393 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19394 @end smallexample
19395
19396 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19397 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19398
19399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19400
19401 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19402
19403 @subsubheading Example
19404
19405 @smallexample
19406 (gdb)
19407 -exec-next
19408 ^running
19409 (gdb)
19410 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19411 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19412 (gdb)
19413 -thread-list-ids
19414 ^done,
19415 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19416 number-of-threads="3"
19417 (gdb)
19418 -thread-select 3
19419 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
19420 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19421 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19422 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19423 (gdb)
19424 @end smallexample
19425
19426 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19427 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
19428 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19429
19430 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19431 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19432 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19433 other cases.
19434
19435 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19436 @findex -exec-continue
19437
19438 @subsubheading Synopsis
19439
19440 @smallexample
19441 -exec-continue
19442 @end smallexample
19443
19444 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19445 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19446
19447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19448
19449 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19450
19451 @subsubheading Example
19452
19453 @smallexample
19454 -exec-continue
19455 ^running
19456 (gdb)
19457 @@Hello world
19458 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
19459 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
19460 line="13"@}
19461 (gdb)
19462 @end smallexample
19463
19464
19465 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19466 @findex -exec-finish
19467
19468 @subsubheading Synopsis
19469
19470 @smallexample
19471 -exec-finish
19472 @end smallexample
19473
19474 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19475 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19476
19477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19478
19479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19480
19481 @subsubheading Example
19482
19483 Function returning @code{void}.
19484
19485 @smallexample
19486 -exec-finish
19487 ^running
19488 (gdb)
19489 @@hello from foo
19490 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19491 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19492 (gdb)
19493 @end smallexample
19494
19495 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19496 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19497 value itself.
19498
19499 @smallexample
19500 -exec-finish
19501 ^running
19502 (gdb)
19503 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19504 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19505 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19506 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19507 (gdb)
19508 @end smallexample
19509
19510
19511 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19512 @findex -exec-interrupt
19513
19514 @subsubheading Synopsis
19515
19516 @smallexample
19517 -exec-interrupt
19518 @end smallexample
19519
19520 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19521 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19522 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19523 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19524 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19525
19526 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19527
19528 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19529
19530 @subsubheading Example
19531
19532 @smallexample
19533 (gdb)
19534 111-exec-continue
19535 111^running
19536
19537 (gdb)
19538 222-exec-interrupt
19539 222^done
19540 (gdb)
19541 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19542 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19543 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19544 (gdb)
19545
19546 (gdb)
19547 -exec-interrupt
19548 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19549 (gdb)
19550 @end smallexample
19551
19552
19553 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19554 @findex -exec-next
19555
19556 @subsubheading Synopsis
19557
19558 @smallexample
19559 -exec-next
19560 @end smallexample
19561
19562 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19563 of the next source line is reached.
19564
19565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19566
19567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19568
19569 @subsubheading Example
19570
19571 @smallexample
19572 -exec-next
19573 ^running
19574 (gdb)
19575 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19576 (gdb)
19577 @end smallexample
19578
19579
19580 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19581 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19582
19583 @subsubheading Synopsis
19584
19585 @smallexample
19586 -exec-next-instruction
19587 @end smallexample
19588
19589 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19590 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19591 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19592 printed as well.
19593
19594 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19595
19596 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19597
19598 @subsubheading Example
19599
19600 @smallexample
19601 (gdb)
19602 -exec-next-instruction
19603 ^running
19604
19605 (gdb)
19606 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19607 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19608 (gdb)
19609 @end smallexample
19610
19611
19612 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19613 @findex -exec-return
19614
19615 @subsubheading Synopsis
19616
19617 @smallexample
19618 -exec-return
19619 @end smallexample
19620
19621 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19622 Displays the new current frame.
19623
19624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19625
19626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19627
19628 @subsubheading Example
19629
19630 @smallexample
19631 (gdb)
19632 200-break-insert callee4
19633 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19634 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19635 (gdb)
19636 000-exec-run
19637 000^running
19638 (gdb)
19639 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19640 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19641 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19642 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19643 (gdb)
19644 205-break-delete
19645 205^done
19646 (gdb)
19647 111-exec-return
19648 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19649 args=[@{name="strarg",
19650 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19651 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19652 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19653 (gdb)
19654 @end smallexample
19655
19656
19657 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19658 @findex -exec-run
19659
19660 @subsubheading Synopsis
19661
19662 @smallexample
19663 -exec-run
19664 @end smallexample
19665
19666 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19667 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19668 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19669 the program has exited exceptionally.
19670
19671 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19672
19673 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19674
19675 @subsubheading Examples
19676
19677 @smallexample
19678 (gdb)
19679 -break-insert main
19680 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19681 (gdb)
19682 -exec-run
19683 ^running
19684 (gdb)
19685 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19686 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19687 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19688 (gdb)
19689 @end smallexample
19690
19691 @noindent
19692 Program exited normally:
19693
19694 @smallexample
19695 (gdb)
19696 -exec-run
19697 ^running
19698 (gdb)
19699 x = 55
19700 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19701 (gdb)
19702 @end smallexample
19703
19704 @noindent
19705 Program exited exceptionally:
19706
19707 @smallexample
19708 (gdb)
19709 -exec-run
19710 ^running
19711 (gdb)
19712 x = 55
19713 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19714 (gdb)
19715 @end smallexample
19716
19717 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19718 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19719
19720 @smallexample
19721 (gdb)
19722 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19723 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19724 @end smallexample
19725
19726
19727 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19728
19729
19730 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19731 @findex -exec-step
19732
19733 @subsubheading Synopsis
19734
19735 @smallexample
19736 -exec-step
19737 @end smallexample
19738
19739 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19740 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19741 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19742 function.
19743
19744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19745
19746 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19747
19748 @subsubheading Example
19749
19750 Stepping into a function:
19751
19752 @smallexample
19753 -exec-step
19754 ^running
19755 (gdb)
19756 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19757 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19758 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19759 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19760 (gdb)
19761 @end smallexample
19762
19763 Regular stepping:
19764
19765 @smallexample
19766 -exec-step
19767 ^running
19768 (gdb)
19769 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19770 (gdb)
19771 @end smallexample
19772
19773
19774 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19775 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19776
19777 @subsubheading Synopsis
19778
19779 @smallexample
19780 -exec-step-instruction
19781 @end smallexample
19782
19783 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19784 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19785 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19786 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19787 well.
19788
19789 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19790
19791 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19792
19793 @subsubheading Example
19794
19795 @smallexample
19796 (gdb)
19797 -exec-step-instruction
19798 ^running
19799
19800 (gdb)
19801 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19802 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19803 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19804 (gdb)
19805 -exec-step-instruction
19806 ^running
19807
19808 (gdb)
19809 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19810 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19811 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19812 (gdb)
19813 @end smallexample
19814
19815
19816 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19817 @findex -exec-until
19818
19819 @subsubheading Synopsis
19820
19821 @smallexample
19822 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19823 @end smallexample
19824
19825 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19826 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19827 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19828 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19829
19830 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19831
19832 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19833
19834 @subsubheading Example
19835
19836 @smallexample
19837 (gdb)
19838 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19839 ^running
19840 (gdb)
19841 x = 55
19842 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19843 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19844 (gdb)
19845 @end smallexample
19846
19847 @ignore
19848 @subheading -file-clear
19849 Is this going away????
19850 @end ignore
19851
19852 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19853 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19854 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19855
19856
19857 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19858 @findex -stack-info-frame
19859
19860 @subsubheading Synopsis
19861
19862 @smallexample
19863 -stack-info-frame
19864 @end smallexample
19865
19866 Get info on the selected frame.
19867
19868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19869
19870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19871 (without arguments).
19872
19873 @subsubheading Example
19874
19875 @smallexample
19876 (gdb)
19877 -stack-info-frame
19878 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19879 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19880 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19881 (gdb)
19882 @end smallexample
19883
19884 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19885 @findex -stack-info-depth
19886
19887 @subsubheading Synopsis
19888
19889 @smallexample
19890 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19891 @end smallexample
19892
19893 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19894 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19895
19896 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19897
19898 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19899
19900 @subsubheading Example
19901
19902 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19903
19904 @smallexample
19905 (gdb)
19906 -stack-info-depth
19907 ^done,depth="12"
19908 (gdb)
19909 -stack-info-depth 4
19910 ^done,depth="4"
19911 (gdb)
19912 -stack-info-depth 12
19913 ^done,depth="12"
19914 (gdb)
19915 -stack-info-depth 11
19916 ^done,depth="11"
19917 (gdb)
19918 -stack-info-depth 13
19919 ^done,depth="12"
19920 (gdb)
19921 @end smallexample
19922
19923 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19924 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19925
19926 @subsubheading Synopsis
19927
19928 @smallexample
19929 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19930 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19931 @end smallexample
19932
19933 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19934 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19935 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19936 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19937 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19938 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19939 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19940 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19941
19942 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19943 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19944 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19945
19946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19947
19948 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19949 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19950 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19951
19952 @subsubheading Example
19953
19954 @smallexample
19955 (gdb)
19956 -stack-list-frames
19957 ^done,
19958 stack=[
19959 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19960 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19961 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19962 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19963 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19964 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19965 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19966 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19967 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19968 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19969 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19970 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19971 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19972 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19973 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19974 (gdb)
19975 -stack-list-arguments 0
19976 ^done,
19977 stack-args=[
19978 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19979 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19980 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19981 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19982 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19983 (gdb)
19984 -stack-list-arguments 1
19985 ^done,
19986 stack-args=[
19987 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19988 frame=@{level="1",
19989 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19990 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19991 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19992 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19993 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19994 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19995 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19996 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19997 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19998 (gdb)
19999 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
20000 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
20001 (gdb)
20002 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
20003 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
20004 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20005 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
20006 (gdb)
20007 @end smallexample
20008
20009 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
20010
20011
20012 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
20013 @findex -stack-list-frames
20014
20015 @subsubheading Synopsis
20016
20017 @smallexample
20018 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
20019 @end smallexample
20020
20021 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
20022 following info:
20023
20024 @table @samp
20025 @item @var{level}
20026 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
20027 @item @var{addr}
20028 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
20029 @item @var{func}
20030 Function name.
20031 @item @var{file}
20032 File name of the source file where the function lives.
20033 @item @var{line}
20034 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
20035 @end table
20036
20037 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
20038 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
20039 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
20040 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
20041 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
20042 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
20043 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
20044
20045 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20046
20047 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
20048
20049 @subsubheading Example
20050
20051 Full stack backtrace:
20052
20053 @smallexample
20054 (gdb)
20055 -stack-list-frames
20056 ^done,stack=
20057 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
20058 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
20059 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20060 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20061 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20062 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20063 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20064 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20065 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20066 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20067 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20068 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20069 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20070 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20071 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20072 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20073 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20074 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20075 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20076 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20077 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20078 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20079 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
20080 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
20081 (gdb)
20082 @end smallexample
20083
20084 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
20085
20086 @smallexample
20087 (gdb)
20088 -stack-list-frames 3 5
20089 ^done,stack=
20090 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20091 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20092 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20093 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20094 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20095 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
20096 (gdb)
20097 @end smallexample
20098
20099 Show a single frame:
20100
20101 @smallexample
20102 (gdb)
20103 -stack-list-frames 3 3
20104 ^done,stack=
20105 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20106 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
20107 (gdb)
20108 @end smallexample
20109
20110
20111 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
20112 @findex -stack-list-locals
20113
20114 @subsubheading Synopsis
20115
20116 @smallexample
20117 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
20118 @end smallexample
20119
20120 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
20121 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
20122 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
20123 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
20124 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
20125 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
20126 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
20127 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
20128 more detail.
20129
20130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20131
20132 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
20133
20134 @subsubheading Example
20135
20136 @smallexample
20137 (gdb)
20138 -stack-list-locals 0
20139 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
20140 (gdb)
20141 -stack-list-locals --all-values
20142 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
20143 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
20144 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
20145 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
20146 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
20147 (gdb)
20148 @end smallexample
20149
20150
20151 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
20152 @findex -stack-select-frame
20153
20154 @subsubheading Synopsis
20155
20156 @smallexample
20157 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
20158 @end smallexample
20159
20160 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
20161 the stack.
20162
20163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20164
20165 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
20166 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
20167
20168 @subsubheading Example
20169
20170 @smallexample
20171 (gdb)
20172 -stack-select-frame 2
20173 ^done
20174 (gdb)
20175 @end smallexample
20176
20177 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20178 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20179 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20180
20181 @ignore
20182
20183 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20184
20185 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20186 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20187 used by @code{Insight}.
20188
20189 The two main reasons for that are:
20190
20191 @enumerate 1
20192 @item
20193 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20194
20195 @item
20196 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20197 now).
20198 @end enumerate
20199
20200 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20201 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20202 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20203 hints about their use.
20204
20205 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20206 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20207 least, the following operations:
20208
20209 @itemize @bullet
20210 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20211 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20212 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20213 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20214 @end itemize
20215
20216 @end ignore
20217
20218 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
20219
20220 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20221
20222 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
20223 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
20224 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
20225 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
20226 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
20227 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
20228 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
20229 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
20230 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
20231 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
20232 object, or to change display format.
20233
20234 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
20235 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
20236 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
20237 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
20238 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
20239 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
20240 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
20241 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
20242 child will be created.
20243
20244 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
20245 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
20246 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
20247 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
20248 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
20249
20250 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
20251 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
20252 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
20253 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
20254 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
20255 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
20256 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
20257 variables that frontend has created.
20258
20259 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
20260 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
20261 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
20262 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
20263 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
20264 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
20265 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
20266 implicitly updated.
20267
20268 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20269 access this functionality:
20270
20271 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20272 @item @strong{Operation}
20273 @tab @strong{Description}
20274
20275 @item @code{-var-create}
20276 @tab create a variable object
20277 @item @code{-var-delete}
20278 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
20279 @item @code{-var-set-format}
20280 @tab set the display format of this variable
20281 @item @code{-var-show-format}
20282 @tab show the display format of this variable
20283 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20284 @tab tells how many children this object has
20285 @item @code{-var-list-children}
20286 @tab return a list of the object's children
20287 @item @code{-var-info-type}
20288 @tab show the type of this variable object
20289 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
20290 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
20291 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
20292 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
20293 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20294 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20295 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20296 @tab get the value of this variable
20297 @item @code{-var-assign}
20298 @tab set the value of this variable
20299 @item @code{-var-update}
20300 @tab update the variable and its children
20301 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
20302 @tab set frozeness attribute
20303 @end multitable
20304
20305 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20306 how it can be used.
20307
20308 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20309
20310 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20311 @findex -var-create
20312
20313 @subsubheading Synopsis
20314
20315 @smallexample
20316 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20317 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20318 @end smallexample
20319
20320 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20321 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20322 register.
20323
20324 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20325 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20326 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20327 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20328 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20329
20330 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20331 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20332 frame should be used.
20333
20334 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20335 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20336
20337 @itemize @bullet
20338 @item
20339 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20340
20341 @item
20342 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20343
20344 @item
20345 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20346 @end itemize
20347
20348 @subsubheading Result
20349
20350 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20351 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20352 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20353
20354 @smallexample
20355 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20356 @end smallexample
20357
20358
20359 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20360 @findex -var-delete
20361
20362 @subsubheading Synopsis
20363
20364 @smallexample
20365 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
20366 @end smallexample
20367
20368 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20369 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
20370
20371 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20372
20373
20374 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20375 @findex -var-set-format
20376
20377 @subsubheading Synopsis
20378
20379 @smallexample
20380 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20381 @end smallexample
20382
20383 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20384 @var{format-spec}.
20385
20386 @anchor{-var-set-format}
20387 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20388
20389 @smallexample
20390 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20391 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20392 @end smallexample
20393
20394 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20395 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20396 for pointers, etc.).
20397
20398 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20399 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20400
20401 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20402 @findex -var-show-format
20403
20404 @subsubheading Synopsis
20405
20406 @smallexample
20407 -var-show-format @var{name}
20408 @end smallexample
20409
20410 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20411
20412 @smallexample
20413 @var{format} @expansion{}
20414 @var{format-spec}
20415 @end smallexample
20416
20417
20418 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20419 @findex -var-info-num-children
20420
20421 @subsubheading Synopsis
20422
20423 @smallexample
20424 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20425 @end smallexample
20426
20427 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20428
20429 @smallexample
20430 numchild=@var{n}
20431 @end smallexample
20432
20433
20434 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20435 @findex -var-list-children
20436
20437 @subsubheading Synopsis
20438
20439 @smallexample
20440 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20441 @end smallexample
20442 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20443
20444 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20445 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20446 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20447 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20448 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20449 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20450 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20451 and unions.
20452
20453 @subsubheading Example
20454
20455 @smallexample
20456 (gdb)
20457 -var-list-children n
20458 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20459 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20460 (gdb)
20461 -var-list-children --all-values n
20462 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20463 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20464 @end smallexample
20465
20466
20467 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20468 @findex -var-info-type
20469
20470 @subsubheading Synopsis
20471
20472 @smallexample
20473 -var-info-type @var{name}
20474 @end smallexample
20475
20476 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20477 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20478 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20479
20480 @smallexample
20481 type=@var{typename}
20482 @end smallexample
20483
20484
20485 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20486 @findex -var-info-expression
20487
20488 @subsubheading Synopsis
20489
20490 @smallexample
20491 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20492 @end smallexample
20493
20494 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20495 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20496 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20497
20498 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20499 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20500
20501 @smallexample
20502 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20503 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20504 @end smallexample
20505
20506 @noindent
20507 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20508
20509 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20510 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20511 is of limited use.
20512
20513 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20514 @findex -var-info-path-expression
20515
20516 @subsubheading Synopsis
20517
20518 @smallexample
20519 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20520 @end smallexample
20521
20522 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20523 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20524 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20525 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20526 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20527 watchpoint from a variable object.
20528
20529 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20530 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20531 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20532 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20533 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20534 @smallexample
20535 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20536 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20537 @end smallexample
20538
20539 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20540 @findex -var-show-attributes
20541
20542 @subsubheading Synopsis
20543
20544 @smallexample
20545 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20546 @end smallexample
20547
20548 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20549
20550 @smallexample
20551 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20552 @end smallexample
20553
20554 @noindent
20555 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20556
20557 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20558 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20559
20560 @subsubheading Synopsis
20561
20562 @smallexample
20563 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
20564 @end smallexample
20565
20566 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20567 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
20568 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
20569 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
20570 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
20571 the current display format will be used. The current display format
20572 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20573
20574 @smallexample
20575 value=@var{value}
20576 @end smallexample
20577
20578 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20579 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20580
20581 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20582 @findex -var-assign
20583
20584 @subsubheading Synopsis
20585
20586 @smallexample
20587 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20588 @end smallexample
20589
20590 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20591 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20592 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20593 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20594
20595 @subsubheading Example
20596
20597 @smallexample
20598 (gdb)
20599 -var-assign var1 3
20600 ^done,value="3"
20601 (gdb)
20602 -var-update *
20603 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20604 (gdb)
20605 @end smallexample
20606
20607 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20608 @findex -var-update
20609
20610 @subsubheading Synopsis
20611
20612 @smallexample
20613 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20614 @end smallexample
20615
20616 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20617 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20618 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20619 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20620 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20621 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20622 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20623 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20624 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20625 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
20626 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20627 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20628 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20629
20630
20631 @subsubheading Example
20632
20633 @smallexample
20634 (gdb)
20635 -var-assign var1 3
20636 ^done,value="3"
20637 (gdb)
20638 -var-update --all-values var1
20639 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20640 type_changed="false"@}]
20641 (gdb)
20642 @end smallexample
20643
20644 @anchor{-var-update}
20645 The field in_scope may take three values:
20646
20647 @table @code
20648 @item "true"
20649 The variable object's current value is valid.
20650
20651 @item "false"
20652 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20653 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20654 scope.
20655
20656 @item "invalid"
20657 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20658 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20659 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20660 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20661 objects.
20662 @end table
20663
20664 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20665 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20666
20667 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20668 @findex -var-set-frozen
20669 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20670
20671 @subsubheading Synopsis
20672
20673 @smallexample
20674 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20675 @end smallexample
20676
20677 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20678 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20679 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20680 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20681 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20682 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20683 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20684 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20685 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20686 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20687 @code{-var-update} does.
20688
20689 @subsubheading Example
20690
20691 @smallexample
20692 (gdb)
20693 -var-set-frozen V 1
20694 ^done
20695 (gdb)
20696 @end smallexample
20697
20698
20699 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20700 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20701 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20702
20703 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20704 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20705 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20706 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20707
20708 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20709 @c @subheading -data-assign
20710 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20711 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20712 @c set variable
20713 @c @subsubheading Example
20714 @c N.A.
20715
20716 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20717 @findex -data-disassemble
20718
20719 @subsubheading Synopsis
20720
20721 @smallexample
20722 -data-disassemble
20723 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20724 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20725 -- @var{mode}
20726 @end smallexample
20727
20728 @noindent
20729 Where:
20730
20731 @table @samp
20732 @item @var{start-addr}
20733 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20734 @item @var{end-addr}
20735 is the end address
20736 @item @var{filename}
20737 is the name of the file to disassemble
20738 @item @var{linenum}
20739 is the line number to disassemble around
20740 @item @var{lines}
20741 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20742 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20743 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20744 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20745 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20746 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20747 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20748 are displayed.
20749 @item @var{mode}
20750 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20751 disassembly).
20752 @end table
20753
20754 @subsubheading Result
20755
20756 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20757
20758 @itemize @bullet
20759 @item Address
20760 @item Func-name
20761 @item Offset
20762 @item Instruction
20763 @end itemize
20764
20765 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20766 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20767
20768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20769
20770 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20771
20772 @subsubheading Example
20773
20774 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20775
20776 @smallexample
20777 (gdb)
20778 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20779 ^done,
20780 asm_insns=[
20781 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20782 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20783 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20784 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20785 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20786 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20787 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20788 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20789 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20790 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20791 (gdb)
20792 @end smallexample
20793
20794 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20795 @code{main}.
20796
20797 @smallexample
20798 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20799 ^done,asm_insns=[
20800 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20801 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20802 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20803 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20804 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20805 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20806 [@dots{}]
20807 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20808 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20809 (gdb)
20810 @end smallexample
20811
20812 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20813
20814 @smallexample
20815 (gdb)
20816 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20817 ^done,asm_insns=[
20818 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20819 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20820 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20821 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20822 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20823 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20824 (gdb)
20825 @end smallexample
20826
20827 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20828
20829 @smallexample
20830 (gdb)
20831 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20832 ^done,asm_insns=[
20833 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20834 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20835 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20836 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20837 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20838 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20839 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20840 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20841 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20842 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20843 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20844 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20845 (gdb)
20846 @end smallexample
20847
20848
20849 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20850 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20851
20852 @subsubheading Synopsis
20853
20854 @smallexample
20855 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20856 @end smallexample
20857
20858 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20859 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20860 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20861
20862 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20863
20864 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20865 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20866 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20867
20868 @subsubheading Example
20869
20870 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20871 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20872 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20873 output.
20874
20875 @smallexample
20876 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20877 211^done,value="1"
20878 (gdb)
20879 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20880 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20881 (gdb)
20882 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20883 411^done,value="4"
20884 (gdb)
20885 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20886 511^done,value="4"
20887 (gdb)
20888 @end smallexample
20889
20890
20891 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20892 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20893
20894 @subsubheading Synopsis
20895
20896 @smallexample
20897 -data-list-changed-registers
20898 @end smallexample
20899
20900 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20901
20902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20903
20904 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20905 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20906
20907 @subsubheading Example
20908
20909 On a PPC MBX board:
20910
20911 @smallexample
20912 (gdb)
20913 -exec-continue
20914 ^running
20915
20916 (gdb)
20917 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
20918 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
20919 line="5"@}
20920 (gdb)
20921 -data-list-changed-registers
20922 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20923 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20924 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20925 (gdb)
20926 @end smallexample
20927
20928
20929 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20930 @findex -data-list-register-names
20931
20932 @subsubheading Synopsis
20933
20934 @smallexample
20935 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20939 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20940 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20941 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20942 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20943 include empty register names.
20944
20945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20946
20947 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20948 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20949 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20950
20951 @subsubheading Example
20952
20953 For the PPC MBX board:
20954 @smallexample
20955 (gdb)
20956 -data-list-register-names
20957 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20958 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20959 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20960 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20961 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20962 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20963 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20964 (gdb)
20965 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20966 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20967 (gdb)
20968 @end smallexample
20969
20970 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20971 @findex -data-list-register-values
20972
20973 @subsubheading Synopsis
20974
20975 @smallexample
20976 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20977 @end smallexample
20978
20979 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20980 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20981 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20982 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20983
20984 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20985
20986 @table @code
20987 @item x
20988 Hexadecimal
20989 @item o
20990 Octal
20991 @item t
20992 Binary
20993 @item d
20994 Decimal
20995 @item r
20996 Raw
20997 @item N
20998 Natural
20999 @end table
21000
21001 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21002
21003 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
21004 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
21005
21006 @subsubheading Example
21007
21008 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
21009 don't appear in the actual output):
21010
21011 @smallexample
21012 (gdb)
21013 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
21014 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
21015 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
21016 (gdb)
21017 -data-list-register-values x
21018 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
21019 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
21020 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
21021 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
21022 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
21023 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
21024 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
21025 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
21026 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
21027 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
21028 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
21029 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
21030 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
21031 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
21032 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
21033 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
21034 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
21035 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
21036 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
21037 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
21038 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
21039 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
21040 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
21041 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
21042 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
21043 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
21044 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
21045 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
21046 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
21047 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
21048 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
21049 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
21050 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
21051 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
21052 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
21053 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
21054 (gdb)
21055 @end smallexample
21056
21057
21058 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
21059 @findex -data-read-memory
21060
21061 @subsubheading Synopsis
21062
21063 @smallexample
21064 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
21065 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
21066 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
21067 @end smallexample
21068
21069 @noindent
21070 where:
21071
21072 @table @samp
21073 @item @var{address}
21074 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
21075 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
21076 quoted using the C convention.
21077
21078 @item @var{word-format}
21079 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
21080 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
21081 ,Output Formats}).
21082
21083 @item @var{word-size}
21084 The size of each memory word in bytes.
21085
21086 @item @var{nr-rows}
21087 The number of rows in the output table.
21088
21089 @item @var{nr-cols}
21090 The number of columns in the output table.
21091
21092 @item @var{aschar}
21093 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
21094 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
21095 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
21096 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
21097
21098 @item @var{byte-offset}
21099 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
21100 @end table
21101
21102 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
21103 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
21104 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
21105 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
21106 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
21107 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
21108 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
21109 @samp{addr}.
21110
21111 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
21112 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
21113 @samp{prev-page}.
21114
21115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21116
21117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
21118 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
21119
21120 @subsubheading Example
21121
21122 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
21123 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
21124 word. Display each word in hex.
21125
21126 @smallexample
21127 (gdb)
21128 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
21129 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
21130 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
21131 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
21132 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
21133 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
21134 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
21135 (gdb)
21136 @end smallexample
21137
21138 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
21139 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
21140
21141 @smallexample
21142 (gdb)
21143 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
21144 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
21145 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
21146 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
21147 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
21148 (gdb)
21149 @end smallexample
21150
21151 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
21152 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
21153 used as the non-printable character.
21154
21155 @smallexample
21156 (gdb)
21157 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
21158 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
21159 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
21160 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
21161 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21162 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21163 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21164 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21165 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
21166 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
21167 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
21168 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
21169 (gdb)
21170 @end smallexample
21171
21172 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21173 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
21174 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
21175
21176 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
21177
21178 @c @subheading -trace-actions
21179
21180 @c @subheading -trace-delete
21181
21182 @c @subheading -trace-disable
21183
21184 @c @subheading -trace-dump
21185
21186 @c @subheading -trace-enable
21187
21188 @c @subheading -trace-exists
21189
21190 @c @subheading -trace-find
21191
21192 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
21193
21194 @c @subheading -trace-info
21195
21196 @c @subheading -trace-insert
21197
21198 @c @subheading -trace-list
21199
21200 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
21201
21202 @c @subheading -trace-save
21203
21204 @c @subheading -trace-start
21205
21206 @c @subheading -trace-stop
21207
21208
21209 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21210 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
21211 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
21212
21213
21214 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
21215 @findex -symbol-info-address
21216
21217 @subsubheading Synopsis
21218
21219 @smallexample
21220 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
21221 @end smallexample
21222
21223 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
21224
21225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21226
21227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
21228
21229 @subsubheading Example
21230 N.A.
21231
21232
21233 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
21234 @findex -symbol-info-file
21235
21236 @subsubheading Synopsis
21237
21238 @smallexample
21239 -symbol-info-file
21240 @end smallexample
21241
21242 Show the file for the symbol.
21243
21244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21245
21246 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
21247 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
21248
21249 @subsubheading Example
21250 N.A.
21251
21252
21253 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
21254 @findex -symbol-info-function
21255
21256 @subsubheading Synopsis
21257
21258 @smallexample
21259 -symbol-info-function
21260 @end smallexample
21261
21262 Show which function the symbol lives in.
21263
21264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21265
21266 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
21267
21268 @subsubheading Example
21269 N.A.
21270
21271
21272 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
21273 @findex -symbol-info-line
21274
21275 @subsubheading Synopsis
21276
21277 @smallexample
21278 -symbol-info-line
21279 @end smallexample
21280
21281 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
21282
21283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21284
21285 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
21286 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
21287
21288 @subsubheading Example
21289 N.A.
21290
21291
21292 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
21293 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
21294
21295 @subsubheading Synopsis
21296
21297 @smallexample
21298 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
21299 @end smallexample
21300
21301 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
21302
21303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21304
21305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
21306
21307 @subsubheading Example
21308 N.A.
21309
21310
21311 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
21312 @findex -symbol-list-functions
21313
21314 @subsubheading Synopsis
21315
21316 @smallexample
21317 -symbol-list-functions
21318 @end smallexample
21319
21320 List the functions in the executable.
21321
21322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21323
21324 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
21325 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21326
21327 @subsubheading Example
21328 N.A.
21329
21330
21331 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
21332 @findex -symbol-list-lines
21333
21334 @subsubheading Synopsis
21335
21336 @smallexample
21337 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
21338 @end smallexample
21339
21340 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
21341 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
21342 ascending PC order.
21343
21344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21345
21346 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
21347
21348 @subsubheading Example
21349 @smallexample
21350 (gdb)
21351 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
21352 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
21353 (gdb)
21354 @end smallexample
21355
21356
21357 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
21358 @findex -symbol-list-types
21359
21360 @subsubheading Synopsis
21361
21362 @smallexample
21363 -symbol-list-types
21364 @end smallexample
21365
21366 List all the type names.
21367
21368 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21369
21370 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
21371 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21372
21373 @subsubheading Example
21374 N.A.
21375
21376
21377 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
21378 @findex -symbol-list-variables
21379
21380 @subsubheading Synopsis
21381
21382 @smallexample
21383 -symbol-list-variables
21384 @end smallexample
21385
21386 List all the global and static variable names.
21387
21388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21389
21390 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21391
21392 @subsubheading Example
21393 N.A.
21394
21395
21396 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
21397 @findex -symbol-locate
21398
21399 @subsubheading Synopsis
21400
21401 @smallexample
21402 -symbol-locate
21403 @end smallexample
21404
21405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21406
21407 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21408
21409 @subsubheading Example
21410 N.A.
21411
21412
21413 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21414 @findex -symbol-type
21415
21416 @subsubheading Synopsis
21417
21418 @smallexample
21419 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21420 @end smallexample
21421
21422 Show type of @var{variable}.
21423
21424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21425
21426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21427 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21428
21429 @subsubheading Example
21430 N.A.
21431
21432
21433 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21434 @node GDB/MI File Commands
21435 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21436
21437 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21438 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21439
21440 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21441 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21442
21443 @subsubheading Synopsis
21444
21445 @smallexample
21446 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21447 @end smallexample
21448
21449 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21450 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21451 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21452 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21453 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21454 notification.
21455
21456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21457
21458 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21459
21460 @subsubheading Example
21461
21462 @smallexample
21463 (gdb)
21464 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21465 ^done
21466 (gdb)
21467 @end smallexample
21468
21469
21470 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21471 @findex -file-exec-file
21472
21473 @subsubheading Synopsis
21474
21475 @smallexample
21476 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21477 @end smallexample
21478
21479 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21480 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21481 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21482 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21483 notification.
21484
21485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21486
21487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21488
21489 @subsubheading Example
21490
21491 @smallexample
21492 (gdb)
21493 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21494 ^done
21495 (gdb)
21496 @end smallexample
21497
21498
21499 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21500 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
21501
21502 @subsubheading Synopsis
21503
21504 @smallexample
21505 -file-list-exec-sections
21506 @end smallexample
21507
21508 List the sections of the current executable file.
21509
21510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21511
21512 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21513 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21514 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
21515
21516 @subsubheading Example
21517 N.A.
21518
21519
21520 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21521 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21522
21523 @subsubheading Synopsis
21524
21525 @smallexample
21526 -file-list-exec-source-file
21527 @end smallexample
21528
21529 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21530 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21531 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21532 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21533
21534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21535
21536 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21537
21538 @subsubheading Example
21539
21540 @smallexample
21541 (gdb)
21542 123-file-list-exec-source-file
21543 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21544 (gdb)
21545 @end smallexample
21546
21547
21548 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21549 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21550
21551 @subsubheading Synopsis
21552
21553 @smallexample
21554 -file-list-exec-source-files
21555 @end smallexample
21556
21557 List the source files for the current executable.
21558
21559 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21560 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21561
21562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21563
21564 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21565 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21566
21567 @subsubheading Example
21568 @smallexample
21569 (gdb)
21570 -file-list-exec-source-files
21571 ^done,files=[
21572 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21573 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21574 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21575 (gdb)
21576 @end smallexample
21577
21578 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21579 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21580
21581 @subsubheading Synopsis
21582
21583 @smallexample
21584 -file-list-shared-libraries
21585 @end smallexample
21586
21587 List the shared libraries in the program.
21588
21589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21590
21591 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21592
21593 @subsubheading Example
21594 N.A.
21595
21596
21597 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21598 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21599
21600 @subsubheading Synopsis
21601
21602 @smallexample
21603 -file-list-symbol-files
21604 @end smallexample
21605
21606 List symbol files.
21607
21608 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21609
21610 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21611
21612 @subsubheading Example
21613 N.A.
21614
21615
21616 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21617 @findex -file-symbol-file
21618
21619 @subsubheading Synopsis
21620
21621 @smallexample
21622 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21623 @end smallexample
21624
21625 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21626 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21627 produced, except for a completion notification.
21628
21629 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21630
21631 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21632
21633 @subsubheading Example
21634
21635 @smallexample
21636 (gdb)
21637 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21638 ^done
21639 (gdb)
21640 @end smallexample
21641
21642 @ignore
21643 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21644 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21645 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21646
21647 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21648
21649 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21650
21651 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21652
21653 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21654
21655 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21656
21657 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21658
21659 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21660
21661 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21662
21663 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21664 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21665 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21666
21667 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21668
21669 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21670
21671 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21672
21673 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21674 @end ignore
21675
21676
21677 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21678 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21679 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21680
21681
21682 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21683 @findex -target-attach
21684
21685 @subsubheading Synopsis
21686
21687 @smallexample
21688 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21689 @end smallexample
21690
21691 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21692
21693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21694
21695 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21696
21697 @subsubheading Example
21698 @smallexample
21699 (gdb)
21700 -target-attach 34
21701 =thread-created,id="1"
21702 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
21703 ^done
21704 (gdb)
21705 @end smallexample
21706
21707 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21708 @findex -target-compare-sections
21709
21710 @subsubheading Synopsis
21711
21712 @smallexample
21713 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21714 @end smallexample
21715
21716 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21717 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21718
21719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21720
21721 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21722
21723 @subsubheading Example
21724 N.A.
21725
21726
21727 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21728 @findex -target-detach
21729
21730 @subsubheading Synopsis
21731
21732 @smallexample
21733 -target-detach
21734 @end smallexample
21735
21736 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21737 There's no output.
21738
21739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21740
21741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21742
21743 @subsubheading Example
21744
21745 @smallexample
21746 (gdb)
21747 -target-detach
21748 ^done
21749 (gdb)
21750 @end smallexample
21751
21752
21753 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21754 @findex -target-disconnect
21755
21756 @subsubheading Synopsis
21757
21758 @smallexample
21759 -target-disconnect
21760 @end smallexample
21761
21762 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21763 generally not resumed.
21764
21765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21766
21767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21768
21769 @subsubheading Example
21770
21771 @smallexample
21772 (gdb)
21773 -target-disconnect
21774 ^done
21775 (gdb)
21776 @end smallexample
21777
21778
21779 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21780 @findex -target-download
21781
21782 @subsubheading Synopsis
21783
21784 @smallexample
21785 -target-download
21786 @end smallexample
21787
21788 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21789 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21790
21791 @table @samp
21792 @item section
21793 The name of the section.
21794 @item section-sent
21795 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21796 @item section-size
21797 The size of the section.
21798 @item total-sent
21799 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21800 @item total-size
21801 The size of the overall executable to download.
21802 @end table
21803
21804 @noindent
21805 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21806 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21807
21808 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21809 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21810
21811 @table @samp
21812 @item section
21813 The name of the section.
21814 @item section-size
21815 The size of the section.
21816 @item total-size
21817 The size of the overall executable to download.
21818 @end table
21819
21820 @noindent
21821 At the end, a summary is printed.
21822
21823 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21824
21825 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21826
21827 @subsubheading Example
21828
21829 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21830 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21831
21832 @smallexample
21833 (gdb)
21834 -target-download
21835 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21836 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21837 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21838 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21839 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21840 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21841 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21842 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21843 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21844 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21845 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21846 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21847 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21848 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21849 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21850 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21851 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21852 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21853 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21854 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21855 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21856 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21857 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21858 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21859 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21860 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21861 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21862 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21863 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21864 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21865 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21866 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21867 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21868 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21869 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21870 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21871 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21872 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21873 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21874 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21875 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21876 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21877 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21878 write-rate="429"
21879 (gdb)
21880 @end smallexample
21881
21882
21883 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21884 @findex -target-exec-status
21885
21886 @subsubheading Synopsis
21887
21888 @smallexample
21889 -target-exec-status
21890 @end smallexample
21891
21892 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21893 not, for instance).
21894
21895 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21896
21897 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21898
21899 @subsubheading Example
21900 N.A.
21901
21902
21903 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21904 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21905
21906 @subsubheading Synopsis
21907
21908 @smallexample
21909 -target-list-available-targets
21910 @end smallexample
21911
21912 List the possible targets to connect to.
21913
21914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21915
21916 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21917
21918 @subsubheading Example
21919 N.A.
21920
21921
21922 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21923 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21924
21925 @subsubheading Synopsis
21926
21927 @smallexample
21928 -target-list-current-targets
21929 @end smallexample
21930
21931 Describe the current target.
21932
21933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21934
21935 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21936 other things).
21937
21938 @subsubheading Example
21939 N.A.
21940
21941
21942 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21943 @findex -target-list-parameters
21944
21945 @subsubheading Synopsis
21946
21947 @smallexample
21948 -target-list-parameters
21949 @end smallexample
21950
21951 @c ????
21952
21953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21954
21955 No equivalent.
21956
21957 @subsubheading Example
21958 N.A.
21959
21960
21961 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21962 @findex -target-select
21963
21964 @subsubheading Synopsis
21965
21966 @smallexample
21967 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21968 @end smallexample
21969
21970 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21971
21972 @table @samp
21973 @item @var{type}
21974 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
21975 @item @var{parameters}
21976 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21977 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21978 @end table
21979
21980 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21981 which the target program is, in the following form:
21982
21983 @smallexample
21984 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21985 args=[@var{arg list}]
21986 @end smallexample
21987
21988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21989
21990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21991
21992 @subsubheading Example
21993
21994 @smallexample
21995 (gdb)
21996 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
21997 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21998 (gdb)
21999 @end smallexample
22000
22001 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22002 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
22003 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
22004
22005
22006 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
22007 @findex -target-file-put
22008
22009 @subsubheading Synopsis
22010
22011 @smallexample
22012 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
22013 @end smallexample
22014
22015 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
22016 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
22017
22018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22019
22020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
22021
22022 @subsubheading Example
22023
22024 @smallexample
22025 (gdb)
22026 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
22027 ^done
22028 (gdb)
22029 @end smallexample
22030
22031
22032 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
22033 @findex -target-file-get
22034
22035 @subsubheading Synopsis
22036
22037 @smallexample
22038 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
22039 @end smallexample
22040
22041 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
22042 on the host system.
22043
22044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22045
22046 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
22047
22048 @subsubheading Example
22049
22050 @smallexample
22051 (gdb)
22052 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
22053 ^done
22054 (gdb)
22055 @end smallexample
22056
22057
22058 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
22059 @findex -target-file-delete
22060
22061 @subsubheading Synopsis
22062
22063 @smallexample
22064 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
22065 @end smallexample
22066
22067 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
22068
22069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22070
22071 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
22072
22073 @subsubheading Example
22074
22075 @smallexample
22076 (gdb)
22077 -target-file-delete remotefile
22078 ^done
22079 (gdb)
22080 @end smallexample
22081
22082
22083 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22084 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
22085 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
22086
22087 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
22088
22089 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
22090 @findex -gdb-exit
22091
22092 @subsubheading Synopsis
22093
22094 @smallexample
22095 -gdb-exit
22096 @end smallexample
22097
22098 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
22099
22100 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22101
22102 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
22103
22104 @subsubheading Example
22105
22106 @smallexample
22107 (gdb)
22108 -gdb-exit
22109 ^exit
22110 @end smallexample
22111
22112
22113 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
22114 @findex -exec-abort
22115
22116 @subsubheading Synopsis
22117
22118 @smallexample
22119 -exec-abort
22120 @end smallexample
22121
22122 Kill the inferior running program.
22123
22124 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22125
22126 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
22127
22128 @subsubheading Example
22129 N.A.
22130
22131
22132 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
22133 @findex -gdb-set
22134
22135 @subsubheading Synopsis
22136
22137 @smallexample
22138 -gdb-set
22139 @end smallexample
22140
22141 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
22142 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
22143
22144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22145
22146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
22147
22148 @subsubheading Example
22149
22150 @smallexample
22151 (gdb)
22152 -gdb-set $foo=3
22153 ^done
22154 (gdb)
22155 @end smallexample
22156
22157
22158 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
22159 @findex -gdb-show
22160
22161 @subsubheading Synopsis
22162
22163 @smallexample
22164 -gdb-show
22165 @end smallexample
22166
22167 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
22168
22169 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22170
22171 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
22172
22173 @subsubheading Example
22174
22175 @smallexample
22176 (gdb)
22177 -gdb-show annotate
22178 ^done,value="0"
22179 (gdb)
22180 @end smallexample
22181
22182 @c @subheading -gdb-source
22183
22184
22185 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
22186 @findex -gdb-version
22187
22188 @subsubheading Synopsis
22189
22190 @smallexample
22191 -gdb-version
22192 @end smallexample
22193
22194 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
22195
22196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22197
22198 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
22199 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
22200
22201 @subsubheading Example
22202
22203 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
22204 @c box in TeX.
22205 @smallexample
22206 (gdb)
22207 -gdb-version
22208 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
22209 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22210 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
22211 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
22212 ~ certain conditions.
22213 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22214 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
22215 ~ details.
22216 ~This GDB was configured as
22217 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
22218 ^done
22219 (gdb)
22220 @end smallexample
22221
22222 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
22223 @findex -list-features
22224
22225 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
22226 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
22227 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
22228 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
22229 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
22230 startup.
22231
22232 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
22233 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
22234 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
22235 is given below.
22236
22237 Example output:
22238
22239 @smallexample
22240 (gdb) -list-features
22241 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
22242 @end smallexample
22243
22244 The current list of features is:
22245
22246 @itemize @minus
22247 @item
22248 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
22249 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
22250 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
22251 @item
22252 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
22253 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
22254 @item
22255 @samp{thread-info}---indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
22256
22257 @end itemize
22258
22259 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
22260 @findex -interpreter-exec
22261
22262 @subheading Synopsis
22263
22264 @smallexample
22265 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
22266 @end smallexample
22267 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
22268
22269 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
22270
22271 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22272
22273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
22274
22275 @subheading Example
22276
22277 @smallexample
22278 (gdb)
22279 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
22280 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
22281 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
22282 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
22283 ^done
22284 (gdb)
22285 @end smallexample
22286
22287 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
22288 @findex -inferior-tty-set
22289
22290 @subheading Synopsis
22291
22292 @smallexample
22293 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22294 @end smallexample
22295
22296 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
22297
22298 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22299
22300 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
22301
22302 @subheading Example
22303
22304 @smallexample
22305 (gdb)
22306 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22307 ^done
22308 (gdb)
22309 @end smallexample
22310
22311 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
22312 @findex -inferior-tty-show
22313
22314 @subheading Synopsis
22315
22316 @smallexample
22317 -inferior-tty-show
22318 @end smallexample
22319
22320 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
22321
22322 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22323
22324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
22325
22326 @subheading Example
22327
22328 @smallexample
22329 (gdb)
22330 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22331 ^done
22332 (gdb)
22333 -inferior-tty-show
22334 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
22335 (gdb)
22336 @end smallexample
22337
22338 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
22339 @findex -enable-timings
22340
22341 @subheading Synopsis
22342
22343 @smallexample
22344 -enable-timings [yes | no]
22345 @end smallexample
22346
22347 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
22348 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
22349 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
22350 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
22351
22352 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22353
22354 No equivalent.
22355
22356 @subheading Example
22357
22358 @smallexample
22359 (gdb)
22360 -enable-timings
22361 ^done
22362 (gdb)
22363 -break-insert main
22364 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22365 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22366 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
22367 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
22368 (gdb)
22369 -enable-timings no
22370 ^done
22371 (gdb)
22372 -exec-run
22373 ^running
22374 (gdb)
22375 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22376 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
22377 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
22378 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
22379 (gdb)
22380 @end smallexample
22381
22382 @node Annotations
22383 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
22384
22385 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
22386 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
22387 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
22388 relatively high level.
22389
22390 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
22391 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
22392
22393 @ignore
22394 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
22395 @end ignore
22396
22397 @menu
22398 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
22399 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
22400 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
22401 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
22402 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
22403 * Annotations for Running::
22404 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22405 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22406 @end menu
22407
22408 @node Annotations Overview
22409 @section What is an Annotation?
22410 @cindex annotations
22411
22412 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22413 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22414 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22415 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22416 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22417 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22418 cannot contain newline characters.
22419
22420 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22421 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22422 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22423 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22424 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22425 means those three characters as output.
22426
22427 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22428 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22429 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22430 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22431 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22432 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22433 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22434 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22435 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22436
22437 @table @code
22438 @kindex set annotate
22439 @item set annotate @var{level}
22440 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22441 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22442
22443 @item show annotate
22444 @kindex show annotate
22445 Show the current annotation level.
22446 @end table
22447
22448 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22449
22450 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22451
22452 @smallexample
22453 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
22454 GNU gdb 6.0
22455 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22456 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
22457 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
22458 under certain conditions.
22459 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22460 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22461 for details.
22462 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22463
22464 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22465 (@value{GDBP})
22466 ^Z^Zprompt
22467 @kbd{quit}
22468
22469 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22470 $
22471 @end smallexample
22472
22473 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22474 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22475 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22476 output from @value{GDBN}.
22477
22478 @node Server Prefix
22479 @section The Server Prefix
22480 @cindex server prefix
22481
22482 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22483 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22484 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22485 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22486 a transparent manner.
22487
22488 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22489 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22490 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22491
22492 @node Prompting
22493 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22494
22495 @cindex annotations for prompts
22496 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22497 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22498 over, etc.
22499
22500 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22501 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22502 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22503 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22504 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22505 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22506 features the following annotations:
22507
22508 @smallexample
22509 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22510 ^Z^Zprompt
22511 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22512 @end smallexample
22513
22514 The input types are
22515
22516 @table @code
22517 @findex pre-prompt annotation
22518 @findex prompt annotation
22519 @findex post-prompt annotation
22520 @item prompt
22521 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22522
22523 @findex pre-commands annotation
22524 @findex commands annotation
22525 @findex post-commands annotation
22526 @item commands
22527 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22528 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22529
22530 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22531 @findex overload-choice annotation
22532 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
22533 @item overload-choice
22534 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22535
22536 @findex pre-query annotation
22537 @findex query annotation
22538 @findex post-query annotation
22539 @item query
22540 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22541
22542 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22543 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22544 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22545 @item prompt-for-continue
22546 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22547 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22548 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22549 presence of annotations.
22550 @end table
22551
22552 @node Errors
22553 @section Errors
22554 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22555
22556 @findex quit annotation
22557 @smallexample
22558 ^Z^Zquit
22559 @end smallexample
22560
22561 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22562
22563 @findex error annotation
22564 @smallexample
22565 ^Z^Zerror
22566 @end smallexample
22567
22568 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22569
22570 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22571 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22572 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22573 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22574 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22575 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22576 to the top level.
22577
22578 @findex error-begin annotation
22579 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22580
22581 @smallexample
22582 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22583 @end smallexample
22584
22585 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22586 message.
22587
22588 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22589 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22590 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22591
22592 @node Invalidation
22593 @section Invalidation Notices
22594
22595 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22596 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22597 changed.
22598
22599 @table @code
22600 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22601 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22602
22603 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22604 have changed.
22605
22606 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22607 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22608
22609 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22610 deleted a breakpoint.
22611 @end table
22612
22613 @node Annotations for Running
22614 @section Running the Program
22615 @cindex annotations for running programs
22616
22617 @findex starting annotation
22618 @findex stopping annotation
22619 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22620 @code{step} or @code{continue},
22621
22622 @smallexample
22623 ^Z^Zstarting
22624 @end smallexample
22625
22626 is output. When the program stops,
22627
22628 @smallexample
22629 ^Z^Zstopped
22630 @end smallexample
22631
22632 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22633 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22634
22635 @table @code
22636 @findex exited annotation
22637 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22638 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22639 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22640
22641 @findex signalled annotation
22642 @findex signal-name annotation
22643 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22644 @findex signal-string annotation
22645 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22646 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22647 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22648 annotation continues:
22649
22650 @smallexample
22651 @var{intro-text}
22652 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22653 @var{name}
22654 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22655 @var{middle-text}
22656 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22657 @var{string}
22658 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22659 @var{end-text}
22660 @end smallexample
22661
22662 @noindent
22663 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22664 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22665 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22666 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22667 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22668
22669 @findex signal annotation
22670 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22671 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22672 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22673 terminated with it.
22674
22675 @findex breakpoint annotation
22676 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22677 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22678
22679 @findex watchpoint annotation
22680 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22681 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22682 @end table
22683
22684 @node Source Annotations
22685 @section Displaying Source
22686 @cindex annotations for source display
22687
22688 @findex source annotation
22689 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22690
22691 @smallexample
22692 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22693 @end smallexample
22694
22695 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22696 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22697 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22698 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22699 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22700 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22701 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22702 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22703 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22704 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22705 depend on the language).
22706
22707 @node GDB Bugs
22708 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22709 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22710 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22711
22712 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22713
22714 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22715 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22716 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22717 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22718
22719 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22720 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22721
22722 @menu
22723 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22724 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22725 @end menu
22726
22727 @node Bug Criteria
22728 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22729 @cindex bug criteria
22730
22731 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22732
22733 @itemize @bullet
22734 @cindex fatal signal
22735 @cindex debugger crash
22736 @cindex crash of debugger
22737 @item
22738 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22739 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22740
22741 @cindex error on valid input
22742 @item
22743 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22744 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22745 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22746
22747 @cindex invalid input
22748 @item
22749 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22750 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22751 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22752 for traditional practice''.
22753
22754 @item
22755 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22756 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22757 @end itemize
22758
22759 @node Bug Reporting
22760 @section How to Report Bugs
22761 @cindex bug reports
22762 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22763
22764 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22765 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22766 contact that organization first.
22767
22768 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22769 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22770 distribution.
22771 @c should add a web page ref...
22772
22773 @ifset BUGURL
22774 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
22775 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22776 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22777 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22778 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22779 be used.
22780
22781 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22782 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22783 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22784 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22785
22786 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22787 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22788 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22789 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22790 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22791 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22792 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22793 bug reports to the mailing list.
22794 @end ifset
22795 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
22796 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22797 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
22798 @end ifclear
22799 @end ifset
22800
22801 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22802 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22803 fact or leave it out, state it!
22804
22805 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22806 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22807 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22808 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22809 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22810 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22811 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22812 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22813 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22814
22815 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22816 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22817 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22818 self-contained.
22819
22820 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22821 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22822 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22823 bugs properly.
22824
22825 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22826
22827 @itemize @bullet
22828 @item
22829 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22830 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22831 version}.
22832
22833 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22834 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22835
22836 @item
22837 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22838 version number.
22839
22840 @item
22841 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22842 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22843
22844 @item
22845 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22846 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22847 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22848 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22849 those compilers.
22850
22851 @item
22852 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22853 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22854 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22855 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22856
22857 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22858 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22859
22860 @item
22861 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22862 reproduce the bug.
22863
22864 @item
22865 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22866 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22867
22868 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22869 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22870 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22871 a chance to make a mistake.
22872
22873 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22874 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22875 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22876 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22877 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22878 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22879 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22880 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22881
22882 @pindex script
22883 @cindex recording a session script
22884 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22885 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22886 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22887 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22888
22889 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22890 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22891
22892 @item
22893 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22894 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22895 it by context, not by line number.
22896
22897 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22898 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22899
22900 @end itemize
22901
22902 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22903
22904 @itemize @bullet
22905 @item
22906 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22907
22908 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22909 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22910 changes will not affect it.
22911
22912 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22913 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22914 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22915 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22916
22917 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22918 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22919 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22920 less time, and so on.
22921
22922 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22923 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22924
22925 @item
22926 A patch for the bug.
22927
22928 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22929 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22930 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22931 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22932
22933 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22934 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22935 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22936 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22937
22938 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22939 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22940 help us to understand.
22941
22942 @item
22943 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22944
22945 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22946 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22947 @end itemize
22948
22949 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22950 @c and consists of the two following files:
22951 @c rluser.texinfo
22952 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22953 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22954 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22955 @include rluser.texi
22956 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22957
22958
22959 @node Formatting Documentation
22960 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22961
22962 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22963 @cindex reference card
22964 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22965 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22966 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22967 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22968 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22969 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22970
22971 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22972 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22973
22974 @smallexample
22975 make refcard.dvi
22976 @end smallexample
22977
22978 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22979 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22980 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22981 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22982 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22983
22984 @cindex documentation
22985
22986 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22987 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22988 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22989 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22990 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22991 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22992
22993 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22994 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22995 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22996 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22997 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22998 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22999 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
23000 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
23001
23002 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
23003 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
23004 @code{makeinfo}.
23005
23006 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
23007 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
23008 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
23009
23010 @smallexample
23011 cd gdb
23012 make gdb.info
23013 @end smallexample
23014
23015 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
23016 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
23017 Texinfo definitions file.
23018
23019 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
23020 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
23021 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
23022 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
23023 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
23024 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
23025 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
23026
23027 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
23028 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
23029 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
23030 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
23031 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
23032 directory.
23033
23034 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
23035 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
23036 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
23037 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
23038
23039 @smallexample
23040 make gdb.dvi
23041 @end smallexample
23042
23043 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
23044
23045 @node Installing GDB
23046 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
23047 @cindex installation
23048
23049 @menu
23050 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
23051 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
23052 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
23053 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
23054 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
23055 @end menu
23056
23057 @node Requirements
23058 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
23059 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
23060
23061 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
23062 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
23063
23064 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
23065 @table @asis
23066 @item ISO C90 compiler
23067 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
23068 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
23069
23070 @end table
23071
23072 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
23073 @table @asis
23074 @item Expat
23075 @anchor{Expat}
23076 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
23077 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
23078 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
23079 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
23080 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
23081 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
23082
23083 Expat is used for:
23084
23085 @itemize @bullet
23086 @item
23087 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
23088 @item
23089 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
23090 @item
23091 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
23092 @item
23093 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
23094 @end itemize
23095
23096 @item zlib
23097 @cindex compressed debug sections
23098 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
23099 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
23100 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
23101 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
23102 information in such binaries.
23103
23104 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
23105 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
23106 @url{http://zlib.net}.
23107
23108 @end table
23109
23110 @node Running Configure
23111 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
23112 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
23113 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
23114 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
23115 build the @code{gdb} program.
23116 @iftex
23117 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
23118 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
23119 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
23120 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
23121 @end iftex
23122
23123 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
23124 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
23125 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
23126
23127 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
23128 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
23129
23130 @table @code
23131 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
23132 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
23133
23134 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
23135 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
23136
23137 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
23138 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
23139
23140 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
23141 @sc{gnu} include files
23142
23143 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
23144 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
23145
23146 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
23147 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
23148
23149 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
23150 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
23151
23152 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
23153 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
23154
23155 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
23156 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
23157 @end table
23158
23159 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
23160 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
23161 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
23162
23163 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
23164 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
23165 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
23166 argument.
23167
23168 For example:
23169
23170 @smallexample
23171 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23172 ./configure @var{host}
23173 make
23174 @end smallexample
23175
23176 @noindent
23177 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
23178 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
23179 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
23180 correct value by examining your system.)
23181
23182 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
23183 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
23184 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
23185 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
23186
23187 @need 750
23188 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
23189 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
23190 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
23191
23192 @smallexample
23193 sh configure @var{host}
23194 @end smallexample
23195
23196 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
23197 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
23198 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
23199 @file{configure}
23200 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
23201 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
23202
23203 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
23204 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
23205 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
23206 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
23207 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
23208 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
23209 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
23210 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
23211 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23212
23213 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
23214 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
23215 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
23216 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
23217 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
23218
23219 @node Separate Objdir
23220 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
23221
23222 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
23223 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
23224 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
23225 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
23226 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
23227 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
23228 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
23229 program specified there.
23230
23231 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
23232 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
23233 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
23234 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
23235 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
23236 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
23237
23238 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
23239 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
23240
23241 @smallexample
23242 @group
23243 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23244 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
23245 cd ../gdb-sun4
23246 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
23247 make
23248 @end group
23249 @end smallexample
23250
23251 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
23252 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
23253 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
23254 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
23255 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
23256 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
23257
23258 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
23259 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
23260 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
23261 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
23262 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23263
23264 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
23265 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
23266 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
23267 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
23268 You specify a cross-debugging target by
23269 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
23270
23271 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
23272 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
23273 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
23274
23275 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
23276 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
23277 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
23278 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
23279 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
23280
23281 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
23282 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
23283 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
23284 with each other.
23285
23286 @node Config Names
23287 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
23288
23289 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
23290 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
23291 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
23292 of information in the following pattern:
23293
23294 @smallexample
23295 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
23296 @end smallexample
23297
23298 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
23299 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
23300 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
23301
23302 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
23303 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
23304 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
23305 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
23306 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
23307 abbreviations---for example:
23308
23309 @smallexample
23310 % sh config.sub i386-linux
23311 i386-pc-linux-gnu
23312 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
23313 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
23314 % sh config.sub hp9k700
23315 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
23316 % sh config.sub sun4
23317 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
23318 % sh config.sub sun3
23319 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
23320 % sh config.sub i986v
23321 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
23322 @end smallexample
23323
23324 @noindent
23325 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
23326 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
23327
23328 @node Configure Options
23329 @section @file{configure} Options
23330
23331 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
23332 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
23333 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
23334 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
23335
23336 @smallexample
23337 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
23338 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23339 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23340 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
23341 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
23342 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
23343 @var{host}
23344 @end smallexample
23345
23346 @noindent
23347 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
23348 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
23349 @samp{--}.
23350
23351 @table @code
23352 @item --help
23353 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
23354
23355 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
23356 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
23357 @file{@var{dir}}.
23358
23359 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
23360 Configure the source to install programs under directory
23361 @file{@var{dir}}.
23362
23363 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
23364 @need 2000
23365 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
23366 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
23367 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
23368 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
23369 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
23370 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
23371 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
23372 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
23373 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
23374 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
23375 @var{dirname}.
23376
23377 @item --norecursion
23378 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
23379 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
23380
23381 @item --target=@var{target}
23382 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
23383 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
23384 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
23385
23386 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
23387
23388 @item @var{host} @dots{}
23389 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
23390
23391 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
23392 @end table
23393
23394 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
23395 needed for special purposes only.
23396
23397 @node Maintenance Commands
23398 @appendix Maintenance Commands
23399 @cindex maintenance commands
23400 @cindex internal commands
23401
23402 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
23403 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
23404 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
23405 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
23406 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
23407
23408 @table @code
23409 @kindex maint agent
23410 @item maint agent @var{expression}
23411 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
23412 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
23413 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
23414
23415 @kindex maint info breakpoints
23416 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
23417 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
23418 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
23419 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
23420 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
23421 is shown:
23422
23423 @table @code
23424 @item breakpoint
23425 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23426
23427 @item watchpoint
23428 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23429
23430 @item longjmp
23431 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23432 @code{longjmp} calls.
23433
23434 @item longjmp resume
23435 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23436
23437 @item until
23438 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23439
23440 @item finish
23441 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23442
23443 @item shlib events
23444 Shared library events.
23445
23446 @end table
23447
23448 @kindex maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23449 @kindex maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23450 @cindex displaced stepping support
23451 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
23452 @item maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23453 @itemx maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23454 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
23455 if the target supports it. The default is on. Displaced stepping is
23456 a way to single-step over breakpoints without removing them from the
23457 inferior, by executing an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was
23458 originally at the breakpoint location. It is also known as
23459 out-of-line single-stepping.
23460
23461 @kindex maint check-symtabs
23462 @item maint check-symtabs
23463 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
23464
23465 @kindex maint cplus first_component
23466 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
23467 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
23468
23469 @kindex maint cplus namespace
23470 @item maint cplus namespace
23471 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
23472
23473 @kindex maint demangle
23474 @item maint demangle @var{name}
23475 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
23476
23477 @kindex maint deprecate
23478 @kindex maint undeprecate
23479 @cindex deprecated commands
23480 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
23481 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
23482 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
23483 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
23484 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
23485 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
23486 the replacement as part of the warning.
23487
23488 @kindex maint dump-me
23489 @item maint dump-me
23490 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
23491 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
23492 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
23493 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23494
23495 @kindex maint internal-error
23496 @kindex maint internal-warning
23497 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23498 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23499 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23500 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23501 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23502 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23503 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23504 @value{GDBN} session.
23505
23506 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23507 used as the text of the error or warning message.
23508
23509 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23510
23511 @smallexample
23512 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23513 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23514 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23515 debugging may prove unreliable.
23516 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23517 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23518 (@value{GDBP})
23519 @end smallexample
23520
23521 @kindex maint packet
23522 @item maint packet @var{text}
23523 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23524 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23525 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23526 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23527 checksum.
23528
23529 @kindex maint print architecture
23530 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23531 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23532 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23533
23534 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
23535 @item maint print c-tdesc
23536 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23537 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23538 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23539
23540 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
23541 @item maint print dummy-frames
23542 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23543
23544 @smallexample
23545 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23546 @dots{}
23547 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23548 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
23549 58 return (a + b);
23550 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23551 @dots{}
23552 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
23553 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23554 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23555 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23556 (@value{GDBP})
23557 @end smallexample
23558
23559 Takes an optional file parameter.
23560
23561 @kindex maint print registers
23562 @kindex maint print raw-registers
23563 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
23564 @kindex maint print register-groups
23565 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23566 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23567 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23568 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23569 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23570
23571 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23572 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23573 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23574 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23575 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23576 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
23577
23578 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23579 write the information.
23580
23581 @kindex maint print reggroups
23582 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23583 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23584 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23585 information.
23586
23587 The register groups info looks like this:
23588
23589 @smallexample
23590 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23591 Group Type
23592 general user
23593 float user
23594 all user
23595 vector user
23596 system user
23597 save internal
23598 restore internal
23599 @end smallexample
23600
23601 @kindex flushregs
23602 @item flushregs
23603 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23604
23605 @kindex maint print objfiles
23606 @cindex info for known object files
23607 @item maint print objfiles
23608 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23609 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23610 and symtabs.
23611
23612 @kindex maint print statistics
23613 @cindex bcache statistics
23614 @item maint print statistics
23615 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23616 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23617 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23618 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23619 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23620 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23621 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23622 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23623 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23624 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23625 lengths.
23626
23627 @kindex maint print target-stack
23628 @cindex target stack description
23629 @item maint print target-stack
23630 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23631 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23632 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23633 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23634 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23635 address.
23636
23637 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23638 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23639
23640 @kindex maint print type
23641 @cindex type chain of a data type
23642 @item maint print type @var{expr}
23643 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23644 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23645 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23646 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23647 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23648
23649 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23650 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23651 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23652 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23653 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23654
23655 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23656 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23657 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23658 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23659 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23660 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23661 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23662 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23663 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23664
23665 @kindex maint set profile
23666 @kindex maint show profile
23667 @cindex profiling GDB
23668 @item maint set profile
23669 @itemx maint show profile
23670 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23671
23672 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23673 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23674 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23675 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23676 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23677 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23678 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23679
23680 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23681 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23682
23683 @kindex maint set linux-async
23684 @kindex maint show linux-async
23685 @cindex asynchronous support
23686 @item maint set linux-async
23687 @itemx maint show linux-async
23688 Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support of @value{GDBN}.
23689
23690 GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
23691 the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
23692
23693 @kindex maint set remote-async
23694 @kindex maint show remote-async
23695 @cindex asynchronous support
23696 @item maint set remote-async
23697 @itemx maint show remote-async
23698 Control the remote asynchronous support of @value{GDBN}.
23699
23700 Remote asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
23701 the @samp{maint set remote-async} command to enable it.
23702
23703 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23704 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23705 @item maint show-debug-regs
23706 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23707 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23708 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23709 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23710 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23711
23712 @kindex maint space
23713 @cindex memory used by commands
23714 @item maint space
23715 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23716 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23717 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23718 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23719 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23720
23721 @kindex maint time
23722 @cindex time of command execution
23723 @item maint time
23724 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23725 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23726 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23727 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
23728 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
23729 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
23730 it's not possibly currently
23731 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23732 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23733
23734 @kindex maint translate-address
23735 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23736 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23737 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23738 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23739 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23740 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23741 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23742
23743 @end table
23744
23745 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23746 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23747
23748 @table @code
23749 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23750 @kindex set watchdog
23751 @cindex watchdog timer
23752 @cindex timeout for commands
23753 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23754 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23755 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23756
23757 @item show watchdog
23758 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23759 @end table
23760
23761 @node Remote Protocol
23762 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23763
23764 @menu
23765 * Overview::
23766 * Packets::
23767 * Stop Reply Packets::
23768 * General Query Packets::
23769 * Register Packet Format::
23770 * Tracepoint Packets::
23771 * Host I/O Packets::
23772 * Interrupts::
23773 * Examples::
23774 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23775 * Library List Format::
23776 * Memory Map Format::
23777 @end menu
23778
23779 @node Overview
23780 @section Overview
23781
23782 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23783 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23784 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23785 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23786
23787 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23788 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23789
23790 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23791 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23792 @cindex remote serial protocol
23793 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23794 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23795 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23796 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23797
23798 @smallexample
23799 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23800 @end smallexample
23801 @noindent
23802
23803 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23804 @noindent
23805 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23806 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23807 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23808
23809 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23810 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23811
23812 @smallexample
23813 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23814 @end smallexample
23815
23816 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23817 @noindent
23818 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23819 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23820 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23821
23822 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23823 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23824 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23825 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23826 retransmission):
23827
23828 @smallexample
23829 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23830 <- @code{+}
23831 @end smallexample
23832 @noindent
23833
23834 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23835 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23836 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23837 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23838
23839 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23840 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23841 exceptions).
23842
23843 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23844 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23845 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23846 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23847
23848 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23849 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23850 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23851
23852 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23853 @anchor{Binary Data}
23854 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23855 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23856 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23857 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23858 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23859 binary data.
23860
23861 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23862 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23863 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23864 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23865 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23866 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23867 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23868 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23869 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23870 (described next).
23871
23872 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23873 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23874 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23875 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23876 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23877 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23878 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23879 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23880 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23881 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23882 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23883 3}} more times.
23884
23885 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23886 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23887 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23888 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23889 @samp{0*"00}.
23890
23891 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23892 error number. That number is not well defined.
23893
23894 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23895 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23896 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23897 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23898 on that response.
23899
23900 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23901 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23902 optional.
23903
23904 @node Packets
23905 @section Packets
23906
23907 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23908 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23909 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23910 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23911
23912 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23913 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23914 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23915 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23916 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23917 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23918 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23919 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23920 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23921 @var{baz}.
23922
23923 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23924 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23925
23926 Here are the packet descriptions.
23927
23928 @table @samp
23929
23930 @item !
23931 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23932 @anchor{extended mode}
23933 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23934 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23935 debugged.
23936
23937 Reply:
23938 @table @samp
23939 @item OK
23940 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23941 @end table
23942
23943 @item ?
23944 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23945 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23946 step and continue.
23947
23948 Reply:
23949 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23950
23951 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23952 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23953 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23954 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23955 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23956
23957 Reply:
23958 @table @samp
23959 @item OK
23960 The arguments were set.
23961 @item E @var{NN}
23962 An error occurred.
23963 @end table
23964
23965 @item b @var{baud}
23966 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23967 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23968 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23969
23970 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23971 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23972 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23973
23974 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23975 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23976 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23977 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23978 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23979
23980 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23981 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23982 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23983 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23984
23985 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23986 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23987
23988 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23989 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23990 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23991 resume at current address.
23992
23993 Reply:
23994 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23995
23996 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23997 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23998 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23999 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
24000
24001 Reply:
24002 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24003
24004 @item d
24005 @cindex @samp{d} packet
24006 Toggle debug flag.
24007
24008 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
24009 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
24010
24011 @item D
24012 @cindex @samp{D} packet
24013 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
24014 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
24015
24016 Reply:
24017 @table @samp
24018 @item OK
24019 for success
24020 @item E @var{NN}
24021 for an error
24022 @end table
24023
24024 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
24025 @cindex @samp{F} packet
24026 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
24027 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
24028 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
24029
24030 @item g
24031 @anchor{read registers packet}
24032 @cindex @samp{g} packet
24033 Read general registers.
24034
24035 Reply:
24036 @table @samp
24037 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24038 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
24039 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
24040 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
24041 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
24042 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
24043 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
24044 @item E @var{NN}
24045 for an error.
24046 @end table
24047
24048 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
24049 @cindex @samp{G} packet
24050 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
24051 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
24052
24053 Reply:
24054 @table @samp
24055 @item OK
24056 for success
24057 @item E @var{NN}
24058 for an error
24059 @end table
24060
24061 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
24062 @cindex @samp{H} packet
24063 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
24064 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
24065 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
24066 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
24067 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
24068
24069 Reply:
24070 @table @samp
24071 @item OK
24072 for success
24073 @item E @var{NN}
24074 for an error
24075 @end table
24076
24077 @c FIXME: JTC:
24078 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
24079 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
24080 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
24081 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
24082 @c described. For example:
24083 @c
24084 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
24085 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
24086 @c otherwise returns current registers.
24087 @c
24088 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
24089 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
24090 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
24091
24092 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
24093 @anchor{cycle step packet}
24094 @cindex @samp{i} packet
24095 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
24096 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
24097 step starting at that address.
24098
24099 @item I
24100 @cindex @samp{I} packet
24101 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
24102 step packet}.
24103
24104 @item k
24105 @cindex @samp{k} packet
24106 Kill request.
24107
24108 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
24109 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
24110 thread?)}.
24111
24112 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
24113 @cindex @samp{m} packet
24114 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
24115 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
24116
24117 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
24118 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
24119 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
24120 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
24121 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
24122 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
24123 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
24124 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
24125
24126 Reply:
24127 @table @samp
24128 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24129 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
24130 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
24131 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
24132 @item E @var{NN}
24133 @var{NN} is errno
24134 @end table
24135
24136 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24137 @cindex @samp{M} packet
24138 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
24139 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
24140 hexadecimal number.
24141
24142 Reply:
24143 @table @samp
24144 @item OK
24145 for success
24146 @item E @var{NN}
24147 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
24148 written).
24149 @end table
24150
24151 @item p @var{n}
24152 @cindex @samp{p} packet
24153 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
24154 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
24155 register value is encoded.
24156
24157 Reply:
24158 @table @samp
24159 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24160 the register's value
24161 @item E @var{NN}
24162 for an error
24163 @item
24164 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
24165 @end table
24166
24167 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
24168 @anchor{write register packet}
24169 @cindex @samp{P} packet
24170 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
24171 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
24172 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
24173
24174 Reply:
24175 @table @samp
24176 @item OK
24177 for success
24178 @item E @var{NN}
24179 for an error
24180 @end table
24181
24182 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24183 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24184 @cindex @samp{q} packet
24185 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
24186 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
24187 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
24188
24189 @item r
24190 @cindex @samp{r} packet
24191 Reset the entire system.
24192
24193 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
24194
24195 @item R @var{XX}
24196 @cindex @samp{R} packet
24197 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
24198 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24199
24200 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
24201
24202 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24203 @cindex @samp{s} packet
24204 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
24205 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
24206
24207 Reply:
24208 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24209
24210 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24211 @anchor{step with signal packet}
24212 @cindex @samp{S} packet
24213 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
24214 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
24215
24216 Reply:
24217 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24218
24219 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
24220 @cindex @samp{t} packet
24221 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
24222 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
24223 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
24224
24225 @item T @var{XX}
24226 @cindex @samp{T} packet
24227 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
24228
24229 Reply:
24230 @table @samp
24231 @item OK
24232 thread is still alive
24233 @item E @var{NN}
24234 thread is dead
24235 @end table
24236
24237 @item v
24238 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
24239 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
24240
24241 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
24242 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
24243 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
24244 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. The attached process is
24245 stopped.
24246
24247 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24248
24249 Reply:
24250 @table @samp
24251 @item E @var{nn}
24252 for an error
24253 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24254 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24255 @end table
24256
24257 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
24258 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
24259 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
24260 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
24261 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
24262 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
24263 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
24264 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
24265
24266 @table @samp
24267 @item c
24268 Continue.
24269 @item C @var{sig}
24270 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24271 @item s
24272 Step.
24273 @item S @var{sig}
24274 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24275 @end table
24276
24277 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
24278 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
24279
24280 Reply:
24281 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24282
24283 @item vCont?
24284 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
24285 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
24286
24287 Reply:
24288 @table @samp
24289 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
24290 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
24291 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
24292 @item
24293 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
24294 @end table
24295
24296 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
24297 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
24298 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
24299 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
24300
24301 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
24302 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
24303 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
24304 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
24305 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
24306 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
24307 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
24308 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
24309 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24310 packet is received.
24311
24312 Reply:
24313 @table @samp
24314 @item OK
24315 for success
24316 @item E @var{NN}
24317 for an error
24318 @end table
24319
24320 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24321 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
24322 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
24323 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
24324 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
24325 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
24326 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
24327 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
24328 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
24329 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
24330 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
24331 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
24332
24333
24334 Reply:
24335 @table @samp
24336 @item OK
24337 for success
24338 @item E.memtype
24339 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
24340 @item E @var{NN}
24341 for an error
24342 @end table
24343
24344 @item vFlashDone
24345 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
24346 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
24347 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
24348 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
24349 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
24350 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24351 request is completed.
24352
24353 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
24354 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
24355 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
24356 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
24357 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
24358 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
24359 state.
24360
24361 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24362
24363 Reply:
24364 @table @samp
24365 @item E @var{nn}
24366 for an error
24367 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24368 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24369 @end table
24370
24371 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24372 @anchor{X packet}
24373 @cindex @samp{X} packet
24374 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
24375 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
24376 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24377
24378 Reply:
24379 @table @samp
24380 @item OK
24381 for success
24382 @item E @var{NN}
24383 for an error
24384 @end table
24385
24386 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24387 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24388 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
24389 @cindex @samp{z} packet
24390 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
24391 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
24392 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
24393 @var{length} bytes.
24394
24395 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
24396 separately.
24397
24398 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
24399 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
24400 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
24401 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
24402 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
24403 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
24404
24405 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24406 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24407 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
24408 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
24409 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
24410 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24411
24412 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
24413 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
24414 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
24415 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
24416 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
24417
24418 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
24419 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
24420 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
24421 target, is not defined.}
24422
24423 Reply:
24424 @table @samp
24425 @item OK
24426 success
24427 @item
24428 not supported
24429 @item E @var{NN}
24430 for an error
24431 @end table
24432
24433 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24434 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24435 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
24436 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
24437 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
24438 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24439
24440 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
24441 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
24442
24443 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
24444 movement.}
24445
24446 Reply:
24447 @table @samp
24448 @item OK
24449 success
24450 @item
24451 not supported
24452 @item E @var{NN}
24453 for an error
24454 @end table
24455
24456 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24457 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24458 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
24459 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
24460 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
24461
24462 Reply:
24463 @table @samp
24464 @item OK
24465 success
24466 @item
24467 not supported
24468 @item E @var{NN}
24469 for an error
24470 @end table
24471
24472 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24473 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24474 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
24475 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
24476 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
24477
24478 Reply:
24479 @table @samp
24480 @item OK
24481 success
24482 @item
24483 not supported
24484 @item E @var{NN}
24485 for an error
24486 @end table
24487
24488 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24489 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24490 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
24491 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
24492 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
24493
24494 Reply:
24495 @table @samp
24496 @item OK
24497 success
24498 @item
24499 not supported
24500 @item E @var{NN}
24501 for an error
24502 @end table
24503
24504 @end table
24505
24506 @node Stop Reply Packets
24507 @section Stop Reply Packets
24508 @cindex stop reply packets
24509
24510 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
24511 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
24512 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
24513 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
24514 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
24515 @value{GDBN} source code.
24516
24517 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24518 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24519 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24520 components.
24521
24522 @table @samp
24523
24524 @item S @var{AA}
24525 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24526 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24527 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24528
24529 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24530 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24531 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24532 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24533 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24534 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24535 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24536 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24537
24538 @itemize @bullet
24539 @item
24540 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24541 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24542 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24543 two-digit hex number.
24544
24545 @item
24546 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24547 hex.
24548
24549 @item
24550 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24551 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24552 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24553 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24554
24555 @item
24556 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24557 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24558 future.
24559 @end itemize
24560
24561 The currently defined stop reasons are:
24562
24563 @table @samp
24564 @item watch
24565 @itemx rwatch
24566 @itemx awatch
24567 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24568 hex.
24569
24570 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
24571 @item library
24572 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24573 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24574 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24575 @end table
24576
24577 @item W @var{AA}
24578 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24579 applicable to certain targets.
24580
24581 @item X @var{AA}
24582 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24583
24584 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24585 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24586 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24587 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24588 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24589
24590 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24591 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24592 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24593 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24594 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24595 system calls.
24596
24597 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24598 this very system call.
24599
24600 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24601 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24602 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24603 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24604 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24605 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24606
24607 @end table
24608
24609 @node General Query Packets
24610 @section General Query Packets
24611 @cindex remote query requests
24612
24613 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
24614 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
24615 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
24616 sending information to and from the stub.
24617
24618 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
24619 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
24620 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
24621 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
24622 conventions:
24623
24624 @itemize @bullet
24625 @item
24626 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
24627 @item
24628 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
24629 letter.
24630 @item
24631 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
24632 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
24633 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
24634 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
24635 @end itemize
24636
24637 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
24638 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
24639 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
24640 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
24641 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
24642 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
24643 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
24644 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
24645 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
24646 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
24647 packet.}.
24648
24649 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
24650 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
24651 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
24652 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
24653 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
24654
24655 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
24656
24657 @table @samp
24658
24659 @item qC
24660 @cindex current thread, remote request
24661 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
24662 Return the current thread id.
24663
24664 Reply:
24665 @table @samp
24666 @item QC @var{pid}
24667 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
24668 @item @r{(anything else)}
24669 Any other reply implies the old pid.
24670 @end table
24671
24672 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24673 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24674 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24675 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24676 Reply:
24677 @table @samp
24678 @item E @var{NN}
24679 An error (such as memory fault)
24680 @item C @var{crc32}
24681 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24682 @end table
24683
24684 @item qfThreadInfo
24685 @itemx qsThreadInfo
24686 @cindex list active threads, remote request
24687 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24688 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24689 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24690 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24691 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24692 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24693 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24694 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24695
24696 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24697
24698 Reply:
24699 @table @samp
24700 @item m @var{id}
24701 A single thread id
24702 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24703 a comma-separated list of thread ids
24704 @item l
24705 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24706 @end table
24707
24708 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24709 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24710 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24711 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24712 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24713
24714 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24715 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24716 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24717 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24718 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24719
24720 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24721 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24722
24723 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24724 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24725 information associated with the variable.)
24726
24727 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24728 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24729 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24730 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24731 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24732 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24733
24734 Reply:
24735 @table @samp
24736 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24737 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24738 local storage requested.
24739
24740 @item E @var{nn}
24741 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24742
24743 @item
24744 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24745 @end table
24746
24747 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24748 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24749 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24750 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24751 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24752 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24753 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24754
24755 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24756
24757 Reply:
24758 @table @samp
24759 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24760 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24761 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24762 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24763 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24764 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24765 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24766 @end table
24767
24768 @item qOffsets
24769 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24770 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24771 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24772 image.
24773
24774 Reply:
24775 @table @samp
24776 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24777 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24778 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24779 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24780 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24781 segments by the supplied offsets.
24782
24783 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24784 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24785 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24786
24787 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24788 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24789 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24790 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24791 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24792 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24793 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24794 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24795 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24796 @end table
24797
24798 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24799 @cindex thread information, remote request
24800 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24801 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24802 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24803
24804 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24805 (see below).
24806
24807 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24808
24809 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24810 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24811 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24812 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24813 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24814 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24815 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24816 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24817 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24818 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24819 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24820 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24821 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24822
24823 Reply:
24824 @table @samp
24825 @item OK
24826 The request succeeded.
24827
24828 @item E @var{nn}
24829 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24830
24831 @item
24832 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24833 the stub.
24834 @end table
24835
24836 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24837 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24838 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24839 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24840
24841 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24842 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24843 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24844 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24845 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24846 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24847 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24848 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24849 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24850
24851 Reply:
24852 @table @samp
24853 @item OK
24854 A command response with no output.
24855 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24856 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24857 @item E @var{NN}
24858 Indicate a badly formed request.
24859 @item
24860 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24861 @end table
24862
24863 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24864 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24865 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24866 packets.)
24867
24868 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
24869 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
24870 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
24871 @anchor{qSearch memory}
24872 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
24873 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
24874 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
24875
24876 Reply:
24877 @table @samp
24878 @item 0
24879 The pattern was not found.
24880 @item 1,address
24881 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
24882 @item E @var{NN}
24883 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
24884 @item
24885 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
24886 @end table
24887
24888 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24889 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24890 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24891 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24892 @anchor{qSupported}
24893 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24894 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24895 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24896 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24897 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24898 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24899 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24900 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24901 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24902 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24903 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24904 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24905 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24906 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24907
24908 Reply:
24909 @table @samp
24910 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24911 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24912 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24913 possible forms).
24914 @item
24915 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24916 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24917 @end table
24918
24919 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24920 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24921 are:
24922
24923 @table @samp
24924 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24925 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24926 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24927 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24928 @item @var{name}+
24929 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24930 need an associated value.
24931 @item @var{name}-
24932 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24933 @item @var{name}?
24934 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24935 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24936 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24937 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24938 @end table
24939
24940 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24941 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24942 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24943 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24944 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24945
24946 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24947 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24948 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24949 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24950 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24951 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24952 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24953 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24954 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24955 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24956 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24957 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24958 all the features it supports.
24959
24960 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24961 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24962
24963 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24964 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24965 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24966 form response.
24967
24968 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24969 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24970 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24971 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24972
24973 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24974 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24975 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24976 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24977 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24978
24979 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24980
24981 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24982 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24983 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24984 @item Feature Name
24985 @tab Value Required
24986 @tab Default
24987 @tab Probe Allowed
24988
24989 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24990 @tab Yes
24991 @tab @samp{-}
24992 @tab No
24993
24994 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24995 @tab No
24996 @tab @samp{-}
24997 @tab Yes
24998
24999 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
25000 @tab No
25001 @tab @samp{-}
25002 @tab Yes
25003
25004 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
25005 @tab No
25006 @tab @samp{-}
25007 @tab Yes
25008
25009 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25010 @tab No
25011 @tab @samp{-}
25012 @tab Yes
25013
25014 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
25015 @tab No
25016 @tab @samp{-}
25017 @tab Yes
25018
25019 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
25020 @tab No
25021 @tab @samp{-}
25022 @tab Yes
25023
25024 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
25025 @tab No
25026 @tab @samp{-}
25027 @tab Yes
25028
25029 @end multitable
25030
25031 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
25032
25033 @table @samp
25034 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
25035 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
25036 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
25037 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
25038 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
25039 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
25040 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
25041 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
25042 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
25043 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
25044
25045 @item qXfer:auxv:read
25046 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
25047 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
25048
25049 @item qXfer:features:read
25050 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
25051 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
25052
25053 @item qXfer:libraries:read
25054 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
25055 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
25056
25057 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
25058 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
25059 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
25060
25061 @item qXfer:spu:read
25062 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
25063 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
25064
25065 @item qXfer:spu:write
25066 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
25067 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
25068
25069 @item QPassSignals
25070 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
25071 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
25072
25073 @end table
25074
25075 @item qSymbol::
25076 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
25077 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
25078 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
25079 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
25080
25081 Reply:
25082 @table @samp
25083 @item OK
25084 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
25085 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
25086 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
25087 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
25088 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
25089 below.
25090 @end table
25091
25092 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
25093 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
25094
25095 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
25096 target has previously requested.
25097
25098 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
25099 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
25100 will be empty.
25101
25102 Reply:
25103 @table @samp
25104 @item OK
25105 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
25106 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
25107 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
25108 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
25109 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
25110 @end table
25111
25112 @item QTDP
25113 @itemx QTFrame
25114 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
25115
25116 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
25117 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
25118 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
25119 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
25120 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
25121 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
25122 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
25123 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
25124 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
25125 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
25126
25127 Reply:
25128 @table @samp
25129 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
25130 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
25131 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
25132 the thread's attributes.
25133 @end table
25134
25135 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
25136 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
25137 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
25138 packets.)
25139
25140 @item QTStart
25141 @itemx QTStop
25142 @itemx QTinit
25143 @itemx QTro
25144 @itemx qTStatus
25145 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
25146
25147 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25148 @cindex read special object, remote request
25149 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
25150 @anchor{qXfer read}
25151 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
25152 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
25153 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
25154 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
25155 additional details about what data to access.
25156
25157 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25158 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25159 formats, listed below.
25160
25161 @table @samp
25162 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25163 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
25164 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
25165 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
25166
25167 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25168 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25169
25170 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25171 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
25172 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
25173 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
25174 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
25175
25176 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25177 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25178
25179 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25180 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
25181 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
25182 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25183 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
25184
25185 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
25186 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
25187 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
25188
25189 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25190 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25191
25192 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25193 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
25194 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
25195 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25196 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
25197
25198 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25199 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25200
25201 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25202 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
25203 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25204 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
25205 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25206 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25207 in that context to be accessed.
25208
25209 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25210 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25211 @end table
25212
25213 Reply:
25214 @table @samp
25215 @item m @var{data}
25216 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
25217 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
25218 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
25219 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
25220 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
25221 request.
25222
25223 @item l @var{data}
25224 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
25225 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
25226 than the @var{length} in the request.
25227
25228 @item l
25229 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
25230 There is no more data to be read.
25231
25232 @item E00
25233 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25234
25235 @item E @var{nn}
25236 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
25237 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25238
25239 @item
25240 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
25241 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
25242 @end table
25243
25244 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25245 @cindex write data into object, remote request
25246 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
25247 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
25248 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
25249 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
25250 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
25251 to access.
25252
25253 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25254 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25255 formats, listed below.
25256
25257 @table @samp
25258 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25259 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
25260 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25261 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
25262 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25263 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25264 in that context to be accessed.
25265
25266 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25267 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25268 @end table
25269
25270 Reply:
25271 @table @samp
25272 @item @var{nn}
25273 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
25274 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
25275
25276 @item E00
25277 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25278
25279 @item E @var{nn}
25280 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
25281 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25282
25283 @item
25284 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
25285 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
25286 @end table
25287
25288 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
25289 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
25290 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
25291 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
25292 must respond with an empty packet.
25293
25294 @end table
25295
25296 @node Register Packet Format
25297 @section Register Packet Format
25298
25299 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
25300 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
25301 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
25302 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
25303 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
25304 most-significant - least-significant.
25305
25306 @table @r
25307
25308 @item MIPS32
25309
25310 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
25311 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
25312 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
25313
25314 @item MIPS64
25315
25316 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
25317 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
25318 as @code{MIPS32}.
25319
25320 @end table
25321
25322 @node Tracepoint Packets
25323 @section Tracepoint Packets
25324 @cindex tracepoint packets
25325 @cindex packets, tracepoint
25326
25327 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
25328 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
25329
25330 @table @samp
25331
25332 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
25333 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
25334 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
25335 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
25336 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
25337 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
25338 tracepoint's actions.
25339
25340 Replies:
25341 @table @samp
25342 @item OK
25343 The packet was understood and carried out.
25344 @item
25345 The packet was not recognized.
25346 @end table
25347
25348 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
25349 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
25350 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
25351 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
25352 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
25353 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
25354 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
25355
25356 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
25357 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
25358 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
25359 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
25360 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
25361 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
25362 tracepoint actions.
25363
25364 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
25365 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
25366 following forms:
25367
25368 @table @samp
25369
25370 @item R @var{mask}
25371 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
25372 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
25373 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
25374 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
25375 not fit in a 32-bit word.
25376
25377 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
25378 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
25379 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
25380 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
25381 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
25382 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
25383 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
25384
25385 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
25386 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
25387 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
25388 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
25389 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
25390 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
25391 packet).
25392
25393 @end table
25394
25395 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
25396 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
25397 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
25398 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
25399 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
25400 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
25401 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
25402 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
25403
25404 Replies:
25405 @table @samp
25406 @item OK
25407 The packet was understood and carried out.
25408 @item
25409 The packet was not recognized.
25410 @end table
25411
25412 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
25413 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
25414 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
25415 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
25416
25417 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
25418 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
25419 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
25420 one of the following forms:
25421
25422 @table @samp
25423 @item F @var{f}
25424 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
25425 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
25426 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
25427
25428 @item T @var{t}
25429 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
25430 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
25431
25432 @end table
25433
25434 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
25435 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25436 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
25437 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
25438
25439 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
25440 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25441 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
25442 is a hexadecimal number.
25443
25444 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
25445 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25446 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
25447 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
25448 numbers.
25449
25450 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
25451 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
25452 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
25453
25454 @item QTStart
25455 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
25456 hits in the trace frame buffer.
25457
25458 @item QTStop
25459 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
25460
25461 @item QTinit
25462 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
25463
25464 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
25465 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
25466 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
25467 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
25468
25469 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
25470 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
25471 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
25472 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
25473
25474 @item qTStatus
25475 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
25476
25477 Replies:
25478 @table @samp
25479 @item T0
25480 There is no trace experiment running.
25481 @item T1
25482 There is a trace experiment running.
25483 @end table
25484
25485 @end table
25486
25487
25488 @node Host I/O Packets
25489 @section Host I/O Packets
25490 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
25491 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
25492
25493 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
25494 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
25495 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
25496 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
25497 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
25498 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
25499 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
25500 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
25501 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
25502 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
25503
25504 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
25505 its arguments. They have this format:
25506
25507 @table @samp
25508
25509 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
25510 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
25511 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
25512 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
25513 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
25514 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
25515 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
25516 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
25517 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25518
25519 @end table
25520
25521 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
25522
25523 @table @samp
25524
25525 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
25526 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
25527 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
25528 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
25529 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
25530 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
25531 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
25532 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
25533 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
25534 @var{attachment}.
25535
25536 @item
25537 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25538
25539 @end table
25540
25541 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25542
25543 @table @samp
25544 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25545 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25546 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25547 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25548 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25549 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25550 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25551
25552 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25553 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25554 -1 if an error occurs.
25555
25556 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25557 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25558 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25559 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
25560 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
25561 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
25562 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
25563 @var{count} was zero.
25564
25565 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
25566 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
25567 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
25568 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
25569 some characters were escaped.
25570
25571 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
25572 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
25573 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
25574 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
25575 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
25576 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
25577 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
25578 error occurred.
25579
25580 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25581 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25582 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25583
25584 @end table
25585
25586 @node Interrupts
25587 @section Interrupts
25588 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
25589
25590 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
25591 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
25592 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
25593 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
25594
25595 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
25596 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
25597 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
25598 interfaces.
25599
25600 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
25601 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
25602 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
25603 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
25604 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
25605 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
25606 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
25607 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
25608
25609 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
25610 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
25611 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
25612 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
25613 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
25614 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
25615 program is stopped will be discarded.
25616
25617 @node Examples
25618 @section Examples
25619
25620 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
25621 does not get any direct output:
25622
25623 @smallexample
25624 -> @code{R00}
25625 <- @code{+}
25626 @emph{target restarts}
25627 -> @code{?}
25628 <- @code{+}
25629 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25630 -> @code{+}
25631 @end smallexample
25632
25633 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
25634
25635 @smallexample
25636 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
25637 <- @code{+}
25638 -> @code{s}
25639 <- @code{+}
25640 @emph{time passes}
25641 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25642 -> @code{+}
25643 -> @code{g}
25644 <- @code{+}
25645 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
25646 -> @code{+}
25647 @end smallexample
25648
25649 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25650 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25651 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
25652
25653 @menu
25654 * File-I/O Overview::
25655 * Protocol Basics::
25656 * The F Request Packet::
25657 * The F Reply Packet::
25658 * The Ctrl-C Message::
25659 * Console I/O::
25660 * List of Supported Calls::
25661 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
25662 * Constants::
25663 * File-I/O Examples::
25664 @end menu
25665
25666 @node File-I/O Overview
25667 @subsection File-I/O Overview
25668 @cindex file-i/o overview
25669
25670 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
25671 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
25672 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
25673 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
25674 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
25675 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
25676
25677 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
25678 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
25679 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
25680 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
25681 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
25682
25683 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
25684 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25685 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
25686 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
25687 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
25688 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
25689 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
25690
25691 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25692 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25693 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25694 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25695 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25696
25697 @smallexample
25698 (@value{GDBP}) continue
25699 <- target requests 'system call X'
25700 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25701 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25702 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25703 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25704 @end smallexample
25705
25706 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25707 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25708 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25709 system are not supported by this protocol.
25710
25711 @node Protocol Basics
25712 @subsection Protocol Basics
25713 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25714
25715 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25716 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25717 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25718 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25719 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25720 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25721 to call the appropriate host system call:
25722
25723 @itemize @bullet
25724 @item
25725 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25726
25727 @item
25728 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25729 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25730 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25731 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25732
25733 @end itemize
25734
25735 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25736
25737 @itemize @bullet
25738 @item
25739 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25740 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25741 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25742 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25743 packet.
25744
25745 @item
25746 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25747 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25748
25749 @item
25750 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25751
25752 @item
25753 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25754
25755 @item
25756 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25757 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25758 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25759 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25760 packet.
25761
25762 @end itemize
25763
25764 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25765 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25766
25767 @itemize @bullet
25768 @item
25769 Return value.
25770
25771 @item
25772 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25773
25774 @item
25775 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25776
25777 @end itemize
25778
25779 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25780 the latest continue or step action.
25781
25782 @node The F Request Packet
25783 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25784 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25785 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25786
25787 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25788
25789 @table @samp
25790 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25791
25792 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25793 This is just the name of the function.
25794
25795 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25796 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25797 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25798 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25799 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25800 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25801 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25802
25803 @end table
25804
25805
25806
25807 @node The F Reply Packet
25808 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25809 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25810 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25811
25812 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25813
25814 @table @samp
25815
25816 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25817
25818 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25819
25820 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25821 representation.
25822 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25823
25824 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25825 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25826 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25827
25828 @smallexample
25829 F0,0,C
25830 @end smallexample
25831
25832 @noindent
25833 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25834
25835 @smallexample
25836 F-1,4,C
25837 @end smallexample
25838
25839 @noindent
25840 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25841
25842 @end table
25843
25844
25845 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25846 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25847 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25848
25849 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25850 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25851 the target should behave as if it had
25852 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25853 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25854 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25855 packet.
25856
25857 It's important for the target to know in which
25858 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25859
25860 @itemize @bullet
25861 @item
25862 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25863
25864 @item
25865 The system call on the host has been finished.
25866
25867 @end itemize
25868
25869 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25870 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25871 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25872 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25873 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25874 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25875
25876 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25877 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25878 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25879 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25880 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25881 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25882 or the full action has been completed.
25883
25884 @node Console I/O
25885 @subsection Console I/O
25886 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25887
25888 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25889 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25890 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25891 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25892 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25893 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25894 conditions is met:
25895
25896 @itemize @bullet
25897 @item
25898 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25899 @code{read}
25900 system call is treated as finished.
25901
25902 @item
25903 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25904 newline.
25905
25906 @item
25907 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25908 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25909
25910 @end itemize
25911
25912 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25913 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25914 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25915 is stopped at the user's request.
25916
25917
25918 @node List of Supported Calls
25919 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25920 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25921
25922 @menu
25923 * open::
25924 * close::
25925 * read::
25926 * write::
25927 * lseek::
25928 * rename::
25929 * unlink::
25930 * stat/fstat::
25931 * gettimeofday::
25932 * isatty::
25933 * system::
25934 @end menu
25935
25936 @node open
25937 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25938 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25939
25940 @table @asis
25941 @item Synopsis:
25942 @smallexample
25943 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25944 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25945 @end smallexample
25946
25947 @item Request:
25948 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25949
25950 @noindent
25951 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25952
25953 @table @code
25954 @item O_CREAT
25955 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25956 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25957 are concerned.
25958
25959 @item O_EXCL
25960 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25961 an error and open() fails.
25962
25963 @item O_TRUNC
25964 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25965 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25966 truncated to zero length.
25967
25968 @item O_APPEND
25969 The file is opened in append mode.
25970
25971 @item O_RDONLY
25972 The file is opened for reading only.
25973
25974 @item O_WRONLY
25975 The file is opened for writing only.
25976
25977 @item O_RDWR
25978 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25979 @end table
25980
25981 @noindent
25982 Other bits are silently ignored.
25983
25984
25985 @noindent
25986 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25987
25988 @table @code
25989 @item S_IRUSR
25990 User has read permission.
25991
25992 @item S_IWUSR
25993 User has write permission.
25994
25995 @item S_IRGRP
25996 Group has read permission.
25997
25998 @item S_IWGRP
25999 Group has write permission.
26000
26001 @item S_IROTH
26002 Others have read permission.
26003
26004 @item S_IWOTH
26005 Others have write permission.
26006 @end table
26007
26008 @noindent
26009 Other bits are silently ignored.
26010
26011
26012 @item Return value:
26013 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
26014 occurred.
26015
26016 @item Errors:
26017
26018 @table @code
26019 @item EEXIST
26020 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
26021
26022 @item EISDIR
26023 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
26024
26025 @item EACCES
26026 The requested access is not allowed.
26027
26028 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26029 @var{pathname} was too long.
26030
26031 @item ENOENT
26032 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26033
26034 @item ENODEV
26035 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
26036
26037 @item EROFS
26038 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
26039 write access was requested.
26040
26041 @item EFAULT
26042 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
26043
26044 @item ENOSPC
26045 No space on device to create the file.
26046
26047 @item EMFILE
26048 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
26049
26050 @item ENFILE
26051 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
26052 has been reached.
26053
26054 @item EINTR
26055 The call was interrupted by the user.
26056 @end table
26057
26058 @end table
26059
26060 @node close
26061 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
26062 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
26063
26064 @table @asis
26065 @item Synopsis:
26066 @smallexample
26067 int close(int fd);
26068 @end smallexample
26069
26070 @item Request:
26071 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
26072
26073 @item Return value:
26074 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
26075
26076 @item Errors:
26077
26078 @table @code
26079 @item EBADF
26080 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
26081
26082 @item EINTR
26083 The call was interrupted by the user.
26084 @end table
26085
26086 @end table
26087
26088 @node read
26089 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
26090 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
26091
26092 @table @asis
26093 @item Synopsis:
26094 @smallexample
26095 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
26096 @end smallexample
26097
26098 @item Request:
26099 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
26100
26101 @item Return value:
26102 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
26103 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
26104 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
26105
26106 @item Errors:
26107
26108 @table @code
26109 @item EBADF
26110 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
26111 reading.
26112
26113 @item EFAULT
26114 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26115
26116 @item EINTR
26117 The call was interrupted by the user.
26118 @end table
26119
26120 @end table
26121
26122 @node write
26123 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
26124 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
26125
26126 @table @asis
26127 @item Synopsis:
26128 @smallexample
26129 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
26130 @end smallexample
26131
26132 @item Request:
26133 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
26134
26135 @item Return value:
26136 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
26137 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
26138 is returned.
26139
26140 @item Errors:
26141
26142 @table @code
26143 @item EBADF
26144 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
26145 writing.
26146
26147 @item EFAULT
26148 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26149
26150 @item EFBIG
26151 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
26152 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
26153
26154 @item ENOSPC
26155 No space on device to write the data.
26156
26157 @item EINTR
26158 The call was interrupted by the user.
26159 @end table
26160
26161 @end table
26162
26163 @node lseek
26164 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
26165 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
26166
26167 @table @asis
26168 @item Synopsis:
26169 @smallexample
26170 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
26171 @end smallexample
26172
26173 @item Request:
26174 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
26175
26176 @var{flag} is one of:
26177
26178 @table @code
26179 @item SEEK_SET
26180 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
26181
26182 @item SEEK_CUR
26183 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
26184 bytes.
26185
26186 @item SEEK_END
26187 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
26188 bytes.
26189 @end table
26190
26191 @item Return value:
26192 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
26193 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
26194 value of -1 is returned.
26195
26196 @item Errors:
26197
26198 @table @code
26199 @item EBADF
26200 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
26201
26202 @item ESPIPE
26203 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
26204
26205 @item EINVAL
26206 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
26207
26208 @item EINTR
26209 The call was interrupted by the user.
26210 @end table
26211
26212 @end table
26213
26214 @node rename
26215 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
26216 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
26217
26218 @table @asis
26219 @item Synopsis:
26220 @smallexample
26221 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
26222 @end smallexample
26223
26224 @item Request:
26225 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
26226
26227 @item Return value:
26228 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26229
26230 @item Errors:
26231
26232 @table @code
26233 @item EISDIR
26234 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
26235 directory.
26236
26237 @item EEXIST
26238 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
26239
26240 @item EBUSY
26241 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
26242 process.
26243
26244 @item EINVAL
26245 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
26246 of itself.
26247
26248 @item ENOTDIR
26249 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
26250 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
26251 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
26252
26253 @item EFAULT
26254 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
26255
26256 @item EACCES
26257 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26258
26259 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26260
26261 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
26262
26263 @item ENOENT
26264 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
26265
26266 @item EROFS
26267 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26268
26269 @item ENOSPC
26270 The device containing the file has no room for the new
26271 directory entry.
26272
26273 @item EINTR
26274 The call was interrupted by the user.
26275 @end table
26276
26277 @end table
26278
26279 @node unlink
26280 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
26281 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
26282
26283 @table @asis
26284 @item Synopsis:
26285 @smallexample
26286 int unlink(const char *pathname);
26287 @end smallexample
26288
26289 @item Request:
26290 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
26291
26292 @item Return value:
26293 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26294
26295 @item Errors:
26296
26297 @table @code
26298 @item EACCES
26299 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26300
26301 @item EPERM
26302 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
26303
26304 @item EBUSY
26305 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
26306 being used by another process.
26307
26308 @item EFAULT
26309 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26310
26311 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26312 @var{pathname} was too long.
26313
26314 @item ENOENT
26315 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26316
26317 @item ENOTDIR
26318 A component of the path is not a directory.
26319
26320 @item EROFS
26321 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26322
26323 @item EINTR
26324 The call was interrupted by the user.
26325 @end table
26326
26327 @end table
26328
26329 @node stat/fstat
26330 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
26331 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
26332 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
26333
26334 @table @asis
26335 @item Synopsis:
26336 @smallexample
26337 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
26338 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
26339 @end smallexample
26340
26341 @item Request:
26342 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
26343 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
26344
26345 @item Return value:
26346 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26347
26348 @item Errors:
26349
26350 @table @code
26351 @item EBADF
26352 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
26353
26354 @item ENOENT
26355 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
26356 path is an empty string.
26357
26358 @item ENOTDIR
26359 A component of the path is not a directory.
26360
26361 @item EFAULT
26362 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26363
26364 @item EACCES
26365 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26366
26367 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26368 @var{pathname} was too long.
26369
26370 @item EINTR
26371 The call was interrupted by the user.
26372 @end table
26373
26374 @end table
26375
26376 @node gettimeofday
26377 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
26378 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
26379
26380 @table @asis
26381 @item Synopsis:
26382 @smallexample
26383 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
26384 @end smallexample
26385
26386 @item Request:
26387 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
26388
26389 @item Return value:
26390 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
26391
26392 @item Errors:
26393
26394 @table @code
26395 @item EINVAL
26396 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
26397
26398 @item EFAULT
26399 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26400 @end table
26401
26402 @end table
26403
26404 @node isatty
26405 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
26406 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
26407
26408 @table @asis
26409 @item Synopsis:
26410 @smallexample
26411 int isatty(int fd);
26412 @end smallexample
26413
26414 @item Request:
26415 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
26416
26417 @item Return value:
26418 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
26419
26420 @item Errors:
26421
26422 @table @code
26423 @item EINTR
26424 The call was interrupted by the user.
26425 @end table
26426
26427 @end table
26428
26429 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
26430 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
26431 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
26432 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
26433 needed.
26434
26435
26436 @node system
26437 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
26438 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
26439
26440 @table @asis
26441 @item Synopsis:
26442 @smallexample
26443 int system(const char *command);
26444 @end smallexample
26445
26446 @item Request:
26447 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
26448
26449 @item Return value:
26450 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
26451 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
26452 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
26453 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
26454 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
26455 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
26456 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
26457
26458 @item Errors:
26459
26460 @table @code
26461 @item EINTR
26462 The call was interrupted by the user.
26463 @end table
26464
26465 @end table
26466
26467 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
26468 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
26469 the host is simplified before it's returned
26470 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
26471 is discarded, and the return value consists
26472 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
26473
26474 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
26475 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
26476 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
26477
26478 @table @code
26479 @item set remote system-call-allowed
26480 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
26481 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
26482 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
26483
26484 @item show remote system-call-allowed
26485 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
26486 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
26487 protocol.
26488 @end table
26489
26490 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26491 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26492 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26493
26494 @menu
26495 * Integral Datatypes::
26496 * Pointer Values::
26497 * Memory Transfer::
26498 * struct stat::
26499 * struct timeval::
26500 @end menu
26501
26502 @node Integral Datatypes
26503 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
26504 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26505
26506 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
26507 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
26508 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
26509
26510 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
26511 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
26512
26513 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
26514
26515 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
26516 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
26517
26518 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
26519
26520 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
26521 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
26522 byte order.
26523
26524 @node Pointer Values
26525 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
26526 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
26527
26528 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
26529 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
26530 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
26531 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
26532
26533 @smallexample
26534 @code{1aaf/12}
26535 @end smallexample
26536
26537 @noindent
26538 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
26539 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
26540 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
26541 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
26542
26543 @smallexample
26544 @code{123456/d}
26545 @end smallexample
26546
26547 @node Memory Transfer
26548 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
26549 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
26550
26551 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
26552 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
26553 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
26554 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
26555 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
26556 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
26557 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
26558
26559
26560 @node struct stat
26561 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
26562 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
26563
26564 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
26565 is defined as follows:
26566
26567 @smallexample
26568 struct stat @{
26569 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
26570 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
26571 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
26572 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
26573 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
26574 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
26575 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
26576 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
26577 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
26578 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
26579 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
26580 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
26581 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
26582 @};
26583 @end smallexample
26584
26585 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26586 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26587 structure is of size 64 bytes.
26588
26589 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
26590 range of values.
26591
26592 @table @code
26593
26594 @item st_dev
26595 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
26596
26597 @item st_ino
26598 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26599
26600 @item st_mode
26601 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
26602 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
26603
26604 @item st_uid
26605 @itemx st_gid
26606 @itemx st_rdev
26607 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26608
26609 @item st_atime
26610 @itemx st_mtime
26611 @itemx st_ctime
26612 These values have a host and file system dependent
26613 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
26614 support exact timing values.
26615 @end table
26616
26617 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
26618 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
26619 continuing.
26620
26621 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
26622 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
26623 get truncated on the target.
26624
26625 @node struct timeval
26626 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
26627 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
26628
26629 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
26630 is defined as follows:
26631
26632 @smallexample
26633 struct timeval @{
26634 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
26635 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
26636 @};
26637 @end smallexample
26638
26639 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26640 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26641 structure is of size 8 bytes.
26642
26643 @node Constants
26644 @subsection Constants
26645 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
26646
26647 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
26648 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
26649 values before and after the call as needed.
26650
26651 @menu
26652 * Open Flags::
26653 * mode_t Values::
26654 * Errno Values::
26655 * Lseek Flags::
26656 * Limits::
26657 @end menu
26658
26659 @node Open Flags
26660 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
26661 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
26662
26663 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
26664
26665 @smallexample
26666 O_RDONLY 0x0
26667 O_WRONLY 0x1
26668 O_RDWR 0x2
26669 O_APPEND 0x8
26670 O_CREAT 0x200
26671 O_TRUNC 0x400
26672 O_EXCL 0x800
26673 @end smallexample
26674
26675 @node mode_t Values
26676 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
26677 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
26678
26679 All values are given in octal representation.
26680
26681 @smallexample
26682 S_IFREG 0100000
26683 S_IFDIR 040000
26684 S_IRUSR 0400
26685 S_IWUSR 0200
26686 S_IXUSR 0100
26687 S_IRGRP 040
26688 S_IWGRP 020
26689 S_IXGRP 010
26690 S_IROTH 04
26691 S_IWOTH 02
26692 S_IXOTH 01
26693 @end smallexample
26694
26695 @node Errno Values
26696 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26697 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26698
26699 All values are given in decimal representation.
26700
26701 @smallexample
26702 EPERM 1
26703 ENOENT 2
26704 EINTR 4
26705 EBADF 9
26706 EACCES 13
26707 EFAULT 14
26708 EBUSY 16
26709 EEXIST 17
26710 ENODEV 19
26711 ENOTDIR 20
26712 EISDIR 21
26713 EINVAL 22
26714 ENFILE 23
26715 EMFILE 24
26716 EFBIG 27
26717 ENOSPC 28
26718 ESPIPE 29
26719 EROFS 30
26720 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26721 EUNKNOWN 9999
26722 @end smallexample
26723
26724 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26725 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26726
26727 @node Lseek Flags
26728 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26729 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26730
26731 @smallexample
26732 SEEK_SET 0
26733 SEEK_CUR 1
26734 SEEK_END 2
26735 @end smallexample
26736
26737 @node Limits
26738 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26739 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26740
26741 All values are given in decimal representation.
26742
26743 @smallexample
26744 INT_MIN -2147483648
26745 INT_MAX 2147483647
26746 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26747 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26748 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26749 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26750 @end smallexample
26751
26752 @node File-I/O Examples
26753 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26754 @cindex file-i/o examples
26755
26756 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26757 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26758
26759 @smallexample
26760 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26761 @emph{request memory read from target}
26762 -> @code{m1234,6}
26763 <- XXXXXX
26764 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26765 -> @code{F6}
26766 @end smallexample
26767
26768 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26769 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26770
26771 @smallexample
26772 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26773 @emph{request memory write to target}
26774 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26775 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26776 -> @code{F6}
26777 @end smallexample
26778
26779 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26780 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26781
26782 @smallexample
26783 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26784 -> @code{F-1,9}
26785 @end smallexample
26786
26787 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26788 host is called:
26789
26790 @smallexample
26791 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26792 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26793 <- @code{T02}
26794 @end smallexample
26795
26796 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26797 host is called:
26798
26799 @smallexample
26800 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26801 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26802 <- @code{T02}
26803 @end smallexample
26804
26805 @node Library List Format
26806 @section Library List Format
26807 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26808
26809 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26810 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26811 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26812 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26813 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26814 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26815 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26816 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26817 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26818 are loaded.
26819
26820 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26821 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26822 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
26823 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
26824
26825 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
26826 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
26827 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
26828 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
26829 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
26830 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
26831
26832 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26833 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26834
26835 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26836 offset, looks like this:
26837
26838 @smallexample
26839 <library-list>
26840 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26841 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26842 </library>
26843 </library-list>
26844 @end smallexample
26845
26846 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
26847 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
26848
26849 @smallexample
26850 <library-list>
26851 <library name="sharedlib.o">
26852 <section address="0x10000000"/>
26853 <section address="0x20000000"/>
26854 <section address="0x30000000"/>
26855 </library>
26856 </library-list>
26857 @end smallexample
26858
26859 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26860
26861 @smallexample
26862 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26863 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26864 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26865 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
26866 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26867 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26868 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26869 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
26870 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26871 @end smallexample
26872
26873 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
26874 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
26875 section for each library.
26876
26877 @node Memory Map Format
26878 @section Memory Map Format
26879 @cindex memory map format
26880
26881 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26882 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26883 memory map.
26884
26885 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26886 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26887 lists memory regions.
26888
26889 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26890 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26891
26892 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26893
26894 @smallexample
26895 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26896 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26897 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26898 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26899 <memory-map>
26900 region...
26901 </memory-map>
26902 @end smallexample
26903
26904 Each region can be either:
26905
26906 @itemize
26907
26908 @item
26909 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26910 bytes from there:
26911
26912 @smallexample
26913 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26914 @end smallexample
26915
26916
26917 @item
26918 A region of read-only memory:
26919
26920 @smallexample
26921 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26922 @end smallexample
26923
26924
26925 @item
26926 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26927 bytes in length:
26928
26929 @smallexample
26930 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26931 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26932 </memory>
26933 @end smallexample
26934
26935 @end itemize
26936
26937 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26938 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26939 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26940
26941 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26942
26943 @smallexample
26944 <!-- ................................................... -->
26945 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26946 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26947 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26948 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26949 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26950 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26951 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26952 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26953 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26954 and its type, or device. -->
26955 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26956 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26957 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26958 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26959 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26960 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26961 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26962 @end smallexample
26963
26964 @include agentexpr.texi
26965
26966 @node Target Descriptions
26967 @appendix Target Descriptions
26968 @cindex target descriptions
26969
26970 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26971 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26972 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26973
26974 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26975 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26976 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26977 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26978 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26979 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26980 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26981
26982 @itemize @bullet
26983 @item
26984 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26985 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26986 @item
26987 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26988 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26989 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26990 @item
26991 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26992 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26993 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26994 @end itemize
26995
26996 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26997 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26998 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26999 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
27000 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
27001
27002 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27003 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
27004
27005 @menu
27006 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
27007 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
27008 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
27009 descriptions.
27010 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
27011 @end menu
27012
27013 @node Retrieving Descriptions
27014 @section Retrieving Descriptions
27015
27016 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
27017 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
27018 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
27019 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
27020 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
27021 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
27022 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
27023 Format}.
27024
27025 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
27026 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
27027 specify a file are:
27028
27029 @table @code
27030 @cindex set tdesc filename
27031 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
27032 Read the target description from @var{path}.
27033
27034 @cindex unset tdesc filename
27035 @item unset tdesc filename
27036 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
27037 will use the description supplied by the current target.
27038
27039 @cindex show tdesc filename
27040 @item show tdesc filename
27041 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
27042 @end table
27043
27044
27045 @node Target Description Format
27046 @section Target Description Format
27047 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
27048
27049 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
27050 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
27051 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
27052 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
27053 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
27054 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
27055 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
27056
27057 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
27058 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
27059 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
27060 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
27061
27062 Here is a simple target description:
27063
27064 @smallexample
27065 <target version="1.0">
27066 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
27067 </target>
27068 @end smallexample
27069
27070 @noindent
27071 This minimal description only says that the target uses
27072 the x86-64 architecture.
27073
27074 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
27075 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
27076 are explained further below.
27077
27078 @smallexample
27079 <?xml version="1.0"?>
27080 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
27081 <target version="1.0">
27082 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
27083 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
27084 </target>
27085 @end smallexample
27086
27087 @noindent
27088 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
27089 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
27090 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
27091 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
27092 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
27093 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
27094 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
27095 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
27096 the version mismatch.
27097
27098 @subsection Inclusion
27099 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
27100 @cindex XInclude
27101 @ifnotinfo
27102 @cindex <xi:include>
27103 @end ifnotinfo
27104
27105 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
27106 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
27107 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
27108 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
27109 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
27110
27111 @smallexample
27112 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
27113 @end smallexample
27114
27115 @noindent
27116 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
27117 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
27118 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
27119 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
27120 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
27121 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
27122 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
27123 original description.
27124
27125 @subsection Architecture
27126 @cindex <architecture>
27127
27128 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
27129
27130 @smallexample
27131 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
27132 @end smallexample
27133
27134 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
27135 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
27136 Debugging Target}).
27137
27138 @subsection Features
27139 @cindex <feature>
27140
27141 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
27142 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
27143 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
27144 has this form:
27145
27146 @smallexample
27147 <feature name="@var{name}">
27148 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
27149 @var{reg}@dots{}
27150 </feature>
27151 @end smallexample
27152
27153 @noindent
27154 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
27155 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
27156 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
27157 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
27158
27159 @subsection Types
27160
27161 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
27162 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
27163 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
27164 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
27165 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
27166
27167 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
27168 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
27169 Types must be defined before they are used.
27170
27171 @cindex <vector>
27172 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
27173 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
27174 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
27175 @var{count}:
27176
27177 @smallexample
27178 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
27179 @end smallexample
27180
27181 @cindex <union>
27182 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
27183 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
27184 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
27185 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
27186
27187 @smallexample
27188 <union id="@var{id}">
27189 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
27190 @dots{}
27191 </union>
27192 @end smallexample
27193
27194 @subsection Registers
27195 @cindex <reg>
27196
27197 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
27198
27199 @smallexample
27200 <reg name="@var{name}"
27201 bitsize="@var{size}"
27202 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
27203 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
27204 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
27205 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
27206 @end smallexample
27207
27208 @noindent
27209 The components are as follows:
27210
27211 @table @var
27212
27213 @item name
27214 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
27215
27216 @item bitsize
27217 The register's size, in bits.
27218
27219 @item regnum
27220 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
27221 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
27222 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
27223 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
27224 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
27225 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
27226 in order of increasing register number.
27227
27228 @item save-restore
27229 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
27230 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
27231 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
27232 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
27233 ABI.
27234
27235 @item type
27236 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
27237 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
27238 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
27239 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
27240 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
27241 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
27242
27243 @item group
27244 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
27245 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
27246 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
27247 in @code{info registers}.
27248
27249 @end table
27250
27251 @node Predefined Target Types
27252 @section Predefined Target Types
27253 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
27254
27255 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
27256 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
27257 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
27258 types. The currently supported types are:
27259
27260 @table @code
27261
27262 @item int8
27263 @itemx int16
27264 @itemx int32
27265 @itemx int64
27266 @itemx int128
27267 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27268
27269 @item uint8
27270 @itemx uint16
27271 @itemx uint32
27272 @itemx uint64
27273 @itemx uint128
27274 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27275
27276 @item code_ptr
27277 @itemx data_ptr
27278 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
27279 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
27280 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
27281 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
27282 may be marked as data pointers.
27283
27284 @item ieee_single
27285 Single precision IEEE floating point.
27286
27287 @item ieee_double
27288 Double precision IEEE floating point.
27289
27290 @item arm_fpa_ext
27291 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
27292
27293 @end table
27294
27295 @node Standard Target Features
27296 @section Standard Target Features
27297 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
27298
27299 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
27300 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
27301 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
27302 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
27303 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
27304 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
27305 can recognize them.
27306
27307 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
27308 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
27309 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
27310 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
27311 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
27312 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
27313 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
27314 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
27315
27316 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
27317 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
27318 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
27319
27320 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
27321 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
27322 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
27323 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
27324
27325 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
27326 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
27327 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
27328
27329 @menu
27330 * ARM Features::
27331 * MIPS Features::
27332 * M68K Features::
27333 * PowerPC Features::
27334 @end menu
27335
27336
27337 @node ARM Features
27338 @subsection ARM Features
27339 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
27340
27341 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
27342 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
27343 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
27344
27345 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
27346 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
27347
27348 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
27349 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
27350 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
27351 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
27352
27353 @node MIPS Features
27354 @subsection MIPS Features
27355 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
27356
27357 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
27358 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
27359 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
27360 on the target.
27361
27362 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
27363 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
27364 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27365
27366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
27367 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
27368 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
27369 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27370
27371 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
27372 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
27373 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
27374
27375 @node M68K Features
27376 @subsection M68K Features
27377 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
27378
27379 @table @code
27380 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
27381 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
27382 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
27383 One of those features must be always present.
27384 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
27385 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
27386 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
27387 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
27388
27389 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
27390 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
27391 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
27392 @samp{fpiaddr}.
27393 @end table
27394
27395 @node PowerPC Features
27396 @subsection PowerPC Features
27397 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
27398
27399 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
27400 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
27401 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
27402 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27403
27404 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
27405 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
27406
27407 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
27408 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
27409 and @samp{vrsave}.
27410
27411 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
27412 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
27413 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
27414 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
27415 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
27416 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
27417 user.
27418
27419 @include gpl.texi
27420
27421 @raisesections
27422 @include fdl.texi
27423 @lowersections
27424
27425 @node Index
27426 @unnumbered Index
27427
27428 @printindex cp
27429
27430 @tex
27431 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
27432 % meantime:
27433 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
27434 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
27435 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
27436 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
27437 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
27438 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
27439 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
27440 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
27441 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
27442 \page\colophon
27443 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
27444 @end tex
27445
27446 @bye
This page took 0.980268 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.